Ut:'iiA'i Cornell University Library MT 40.M39 1854 3 1924 022 480 267 Stlfata, BJem fork BENNO LOEWY LIBRARY COLLECTED BY BENNO LOEWY 1854.1919 BEQUEATHED TO CORNELL UNIVERSITY Cornell University Library The original of tliis book is in tlie Cornell University Library. There are no known copyright restrictions in the United States on the use of the text. http://www.archive.org/details/cu31924022480267 THEORY AND PRACTICE MUSICAL COMPOSITION BY ADOLPH BERNHARD MARX, DOCTOB OF MUSIC, MUSICAL DIBECIOB Or THE tTHITEBSITT OF BERLIN, ETC. TRANSLATED FEOM THE THIRD GERMAN EDITION, AND EDITED BY HEERMAlSr S. SAKONI. FIFTH AMEEIOAN EDJTION, WITH AN APPENDIX AND NOTES, BY EMILIUS GIEAC, OP THE CONSERVATORY OP PARIS. NEW YOEK: PUBLISHED BY MASON BROTHEES. 23 PARK ROW. Entered, according to Act of Congress, in the year 1851, by MASON & LAW, In the Clerk's Offlce of the District Court for the Southern Distiict of New York. '' Entered, according to Act of Congress, in the year 1854, bf MASON BROTHERS, In the Clerk's Office of the District Court for the Southern District of New York, PUBLISHERS' ADVERTISEMENT. A. B. Marx holds such high rank in Gennany as a writer upon the subject of Musical Composition, that any recommendation of his great work to those who are at all acquainted with the musical lite- rature of the land which is emphatically the home of music, would be superfluous. It is without a rival as a treatise upon this subject, thoroughly scientific, and yet adapted to popular comprehension. A work of this character in the English language has been so much sought after in vain, as to lead to the present translation, which em- braces two books, viz. : — Book I. The Elements of Musical Composition. Book II. The Accompaniment of a given Melody ; with especial reference to Chorals and People's Songs. (Volkslied.) The translation has been made from the third improved German edition, and great care has been taken to follow the original as closely as possible, securing, at the same time, the necessary adapta- tion to the American student, — and an Introduction has been pre- pared by the Editor. Ilxtraot of a Letter recevoed from JiB.. A. B. Maex, ly the PiibUshers. Berlin, June 23, 1852. Gentlemen, Your polite communication, and the copy of a translation of my work on Mubical Composition, have been received through Messrs.T- Edwards, Sandford, & Co., for which accept my warmest thanks. ***** I find that your translator (as far as I am able to judge from a somewhat imperfect acquaintance with the English language) has done his work very ^jrac&aWy and successfully; and I beg you to express to him, as also to the eminent men who have honored my work with their approval, my sincerest thanks, and also yourselves to accept the same, for the very elegant style of the edition. AUTHOR'S PREFACE. The true problem of a treatise on Art may be thus expressed : TJiat it should transmute the most thorough and comprehensive knowledge of Art into the consciousness and sensibilities of the pu- pil, and immediately incite him to artistic activity. Neither abstract knowledge nor technioaHnstruotion can ever secure artistic culture, or even prepare the way for it ; both are opposed to the essence of Art ; and it is the fault of the old teachers, as I have elsewhere proved, that they have not risen above this unartistie tendency, or been willing to depart from it. As the achievement of the artist, bom' of his own free, truth-per- vaded mind, is not an abstract thougHt, but an embodied spirit, united in as intimate and inseparable a unity as the soul and body of man, so must the science of Art continually strive after the most living and impressive truths, from which it should lead the way to bolder and more joyous achievements. Both, however, should be accompanied with that certainty, reposing on the con- victions of experience, and that ardent desire for new achieve- ments and progress, which, in my opinion, are the conditions and characteristics of a true artistic life. This principle, in connection with contemplation on the essence of Art, matured by observation and artistic activity from an early period of youth, strengthened by a view of the historical deve- lopment of art, and by the growing approbation of the most in- telligent and continually enlarging experience, — this principle, as in my first and second treatises, is still my law. That the inter- 6 author's preface. change of theory and practice, of law and liberty, of form and es- sence, of melody and harmony — still, as formerly, called con- traries, though in reality united, — may become more living, ani- mated, and fertile of results, was my principal aim in the present work. In this view, notwithstanding the gap in the formal, or rather merely nominal separation of the Elements from their ac- companiments, I consider it an essential improvement to have placed the further development of passes and harmonic figu- ration after the choral, where they are immediately applied, for the freer and more copious treatment of the secular melodies, and not before it, where they are not needed. This, however, and all further improvements are to be tested by the intelligence of the professor, and the experience of teachers and pupils. I would gladly ofiFer to younger teachers, or to such as have not yet had opportunity for extensive experience, an intimation of my method of teaching ; certainly not with the presumption of being able to say any thing new or important, but, as a duty, un- assumingly to impart what I have to others. Precisely here, however, is the insuflSciency of all writing to supply the place of immediate intuition most strongly felt. Not books, but life, edu- cates ; and only when life is quickened and wrought on by life, can books perform their mightiest and most beneficent office, namely, to unite the experience and intelligence of many lives ; to give support and a rallying-point, so that every isolated existence — always most limited in its immediate activity in relation to the whole — may not forever perish ; that every worker, unadvised and unquestioned by the mute Past and Present, may not be forced either to begin his task anew, or follow in the gloomy path of transmitted usage, in order to be not wholly without support. Often and long enough has the want of this reciprocal action of doctrine and life in our artistic science made itself most painfully felt. Even in our own times have we been obliged to see teach- ers attempting with words and books to form artists or connois- seurs, while their own examples proved them to be wanting in the least skill for composition ; and, on the other hand, there are able composers who venture to neglect, if not to treat with dis- dain, every pedagogic, psychological, or other assistance, even to explain the science of their own skill in execution. The former are easily recognized by their deficiency ; not so the latter. The prejudice is only too widely diffused, that an able or even a dis- tinguished composer, must of necessity, and without further pains, be also an able teacher ; while yet the indispensableness of fur- ther qualifications in a teacher is so easily seen, that pedagogic science long since offered to explain, and experience has often proved, (as in the cases of W. A. Mozart and L. V. Beethoven,) that artistic ability and the capacity to teach are not so often or so necessarily united, that the one may be safely inferred from the greatness of the other. The teacher should, indeed, possess the cultivation, the spirit, and the soul of an artist, — should be himself an artist, — but, besides this, he should not be wanting in the full vocation, the dexterity, the experience, and the capacity of the pedagogue. Seldom as this many-sided fitness is either found or attained, reflection will not fail to make us confess its necessity. My method of teaching, both in theory and practice, has from the first been directed in conformity with these views. Of pure verbal instruction only so much is at first premised as is necessary to acquaint the scholar with the method of instruction, and direct him to the point of artistic effort. From the first series of notes, (the major diatonic scale,) the instruction assumes its peculiar and permanent character. While the scholar who is familiar with his teacher, perceives what to observe and what to miss in the form of the tune, the more able and diligent scholars — thus pre- pared among the less gifted — will almost of themselves grasp the next necessary, or next possible point, or understand it with- out diflaculty from the course of lectures. The scholar is thus kept from the beginning in artistic activity, — in the atmosphere of his future life. The teacher also remains fresh and active, and has no longer cause, either in his work or his meditations, to fear' the old disheartening dissension between Art and Science. With single scholars, or even with two or more, who sit at the teacher's side, and watch the movements of his pen, or who often 8 author's preface. unexpectedly take the pen into their own hands,-^-to whom the teacher must give advice, or instruct them how to proceed with a work already begun ; how to explain, to improve, or to avoid such and such a dubious point, — for all these purposes this sys- tem of instruction has been proved most agreeable and fertile of results. The more the scholar can anticipate the teacher, — the sooner he is able of himself to discover an explanation or an ex- pedient-^to accelerate his progress — the more successful, in my opinion, is the teacher's work. The mistakes of the scholar, es- pecially in the greater tasks of the fugue and sonata forms, pro- vided they have but one tenable position, may be taken up and corrected at leisure, thus enabling him at once to perceive the discrepancy of his error with some part of his work. In artistic science, where individuality and its subjective sensation and voli- tion give the last decision in the moment of artistic creation, I do not hold it advisable that the scholar should wholly avoid errors. He should be thoroughly tried and tested, and have opportunity to conquer himself by his own might. A vanquished error is a progress ; an error merely suppressed threatens a return. TABLE OF CONTENTS. MUSICAL NOTATION". PAOa IHTRODUCTIOK . . 15 PAKT FIRST.— TONES AND NOTES. Chaptee I. The Tone System 18 Chaptee II. The Note System 19 Chapter III. Abbreviations and other accidental Characters in Music . . 24 Chapter IV. Elevation and Depression 38 Chapter V. The Measuring of Tone- relations .36 Chapter VI. The Tone Species, Sexes, or Modes . .... 41 Chapter VII. The Keys 44 Chapter VIII. Relation of Keys . . .... 46 BOOK FIRST. ELEMENTS OF MtTSICAL COMPOSITION. PART FIRST.— COMPOSITION FOR SINGLE PARTS (MONOPHONIC COMPOSITION), 63. Chapter I. The first Formations : 1. The Tone-chain, with its Species, 63 ; Tone Reg- ulation, 54 ; The Major Scale, ih. ; Analysis of the Scale, 66 ; 3. Rhythmical form- ation of the Tone-chain, 66 ; Retrospection, 59. Chapter II. Invention of Monophonic Phrases, 61; 1. The Design and its Efficacy, iS.^ 3. Formation of Passages, 63 ; 3. Formation of Phrases, 64 ; 4. Periods, 66. Chapter III. Discovery of New Means, 67. PART SECOND.— COMPOSITION FOR TWO PARTS CDUOPHONIC COMPOSITION). Chapter I. The Duophonic Composition, derived from the Monophonic, 73. Chapter II. The Duophonic Composition, derived from Natural Harmony, 74 ; I. Man- ner of arriving at it, ii. ; 3. Application, 77; Melodic Application, ii. ; Harmonic Application, ib. ; 3. Harmonic Designs, 78 ; 4. The Cadmce, 79 ; 6. The Half-Ca- dence, ib. Chapter III. The Duophonic Composition, 81. 10 TABLE OF COin^KTS; Chapter IV. Compositions of two and three parts, 84 ; Retrospection, 87 ; Compo^ tiona of threo parts, 89. Chapter V. The Double Duophonic Composition, 90 ; Application, 93. PART THIKD.— HARMONY OF THE. MAJOR SCALE. Chapter I. Discovery of the necessary Harmonies, 94, Chapter H. Examination and Justification of the Harmony, 99 ; A. The Four Voices*, ifi. ; B. The Connection of Chords, 100; C. Harmonic Besi^ns^ ib: ;~ D. Faulty Pro-- gressions, 101; 1. Octave Succession (Consecutive Octaves), ib. ; 2. Quint or Fifth Succession (Consecutive Fifths), 102 ; E. The Dominant Chord, 103 ; F. The Triad of the Dominant, 105. Chapter TIL The Accompaniment of given Melodies, 107 j A. Limitation to those means which were found in the Ascending Scale, ib.] B. The Descending Scale, 109. PART FOXJRTH.— THE FREER USE OF THE CHORDS IN OUR POSSESSION, 113. Chapter I. Harmonic Designs, 114 ; A. Development of a Single Chord, ib. ; H, Com- bination of Major Triads, 115 ; 1. Designs of Nearest Connection, ib. ; 3. Designs Of Remote Connection, ib. ; C. The Combination of Minor Triads, and of Minor and Major Triads, 116 ; D. Harmonic Designs froiA adding the Dominant Chords 117; 1. The Dominant Chord preparing the end, ib. ; 2. Other Chords in connection with the Dominant Chord, 118; E. Extension of the Harmonic Designs by means of Rhythm, 118 ; F. Formation of Harmonic Passages or Sequences, 119 ; Prelude, 120. Chapter II. Freer Harmonization of given Melodies, 122 ; A. Freer use of Triads ib. ; B. Free introduction of the Donunant Chord, 125 ; Freer Treatment of the Dominant Chord, 127 ; Doubling of intervals in the Dominant Chord, 128 ; Covered Octaves and Fifths, 129. PART FIFTH.— INVERSION OF CHORDS, 131. Chapter I. Enumeration and Appellation of the Inversions, 132 ; Figuring, 134. Chapter II. Free use of the Inversions, 136 ; A. New Designs and Passages, t&. ; B. Combination of Inversions with Fundamental Chords, 133 ; C. Preludes and Final Cadences, 140; D, Avoiding faulty progressions, 141; E. The Diminished Triads, ib. Chapter III. Employment of Inversions, &c., 143. Chapter IV. Close and dispersed Harmony, 144 ; Retrospection — Modulation, 147 PART SIXTH.— HAHMONT OF THE MINOR SCALE. Chapter I. Formation of the Minor Scale, 149. Chapter II. Harmonization of the Minor Scale, 151 ; Nona-Chord (Chord of the Ninth), 152. Chapter HI. Nona-Chord, continVfed, 154; Inversions of the Nona-Chord, 155 ; Dimin- ished Septime Chord, ib. Chapter IV. Freer use of the New Chords, 157 ; 1. Major Melodies, 158 ; 3. Minor Melodies, i5. ; 3. Licenses of the Dominant Chord, 160. PART SEVENTH.— MODULATION INTO FOREIGN KEYS, 161. Chapter I. Modulation from one Key into another, 162 ; 1. The Dominant Chord, 163 ; 2. The Nona-Chords, 168 ; 3. The Septime Chord, ib. ; 4. The Diminished TABLE OF CONTENTS. 11 Septimo Chord, 169; 5. The Diminished Triad, tft. ; 6. The Dominant Triad, 170 ; 7. The Minor Triad, 171. Cmaftek II. Introduction of new means to the Harmonization of Melodies, 173 ; A. Ascertainment of Digressive Melody, ib. ; 1. External Characteristics, t£. ; 2. In ternal Characteristics, 174 ; B. Discovery of all eligihle Chords, 175 ; C. Application of these means to Indigenous or Digressive Melodies, 177. Chapter III. Formation of new passages with the aid of Foreign Chords, 186 ; 1. Pas- sages of Dominant Chords, 189 ; 2. Indigenous Passage, 190 ; 3. Successions of Nona- Chords, 191; 4. Indigenous Passage of Nona-Chords, 192 ; 5. Successions of derived Septime Chords, 192. Chapter IV. Variable modulations, 196 ; A. The Diminished Septime. Chord, ib. ; B. The Dominant Chord, 199. Chapter V. General Order of Construction, 201 ; A. The first perfect Construction of a two-part Composition, ib, ; B. Second two-part Construction, 303 ; C. Further ex- tension of Modulation, 304 ; D. The Interrupted Cadence, 305. Chapter VI. Abrhpt Modulation, 207. Chapter VII. Order of Modulation for more extended Compositions, 21Ij Passages of Phrases, 313. Chapter VIII. The Pedal-point, 215. Chapter IX. Hetrospection, 220 ; A. Development of Harmony, ib. PART EIGHTH. -DISPLACEMENT OF CHORDS, 228. Chapter I. Suspensions from above, 228 ; Suspensions of fundamental Tones, 334. Chapter II. Suspensions from below, 236 ; A means of Connection, 238 ; Fifths niiti gated by Suspensions, 244 ; Octaves covered by Suspensions, 245. Chapter III. Anticipated Tones, 346. PART NINTH.— THE PASS, 248. Chapter I. The Diatonic Pass, 249 ; Participant Tone, 360. Chapter II. Chromatic Passes and Assistant-tones, 263; A. The Chromatic Pass, I'A. ; B. The Assistant-tone, 256. Chapter III. The results of Passes, 358 ; The Superfluous Triad, 260. PART TENTH.— THE TREATMENT OF MORE OR LESS THAN" FOUR VOICES, 266. Chapter I.^ Triphonic, Duophonic, and Monophonic Compositions, 366. Chapter II. More-than-tetraphonic Compositions, 271; A. The Polyphonic Composi- tion, ib. ; B. The Double-choired, or Poly-choired Composition, 376. BOOK SECOND. THE ACCOMPANIMENT OF GIVEN MELODIES. iNTRODUCTIOIf, 381. PART FIRST.— THE ACCOMPANIMENT OF THE CHORAL, 283. Chapter I. General Conception of the Melody, 285 ; A. Confirmation of the Key and the principal points of Modulation, ib. ; B. Summary of Cadences, 390. Chapter It. Disposition of the Harmony, 297. 12 TABLE OF CONTENTS. Chapter III. Simple treatment of the Choral, 305. Chapteu IV. Higher treatment of the Choral, 310 ; A. Character of the Toicei, 311 j B. Application to the Choral, 314 ; 1. Technical Difficulties, 318 ; A. Tone-repeti- tion, ib. ; B. Fhrase-repetition, ib. ; 3. Artistic aim of Choral treatment, 310. Chapter V. The Canlus Firmua in other Voices, 831 ; A. The Cantus Firmua in the Alto, 322 ; B. The Cantus Firmus in the Tenor, 333 ; G. The Cantus Firmus in the Bass, 334. Chapter VI. More and less voiced treatment of the Choral, 327 ; A. The Choral with less than four Voices, i6. j 1. The Duophonic treatment, ii. ; 2. The fTriphonio treatment, 328 ; B. The Choral with more than four Voices, 330. Chapter VII. How to acquire facility in the Harmonization of the Choral, 331. PART SECOND.— CHORALS IN THK ECCLESIASTICAL KEYS, 338. r.HAPTER I. The Ecclesiastical Keys, 341; A. The Melodic Point, a.; B. The Har- monic Point, 342 ; C. The Essential Tones of every Key, 344 ; D. Admissibility ot foreign Tones, ib. ; £. Transposition and Signature, i&. ; F. Modulation into other Keys, 346. Chapter II. The Ionian Key, 34T. Chapter IIL The Mixolydian Key, 349. Chapter IV. The Dorian Key, 350. Chapter V. The aiolian Key, 352. Chapter VI. The Phrygian Key, 354. Chapter VIL The Lydian Key, 35S. PART THIRD.— THE SECULAR NATIONAL SONG, 358. Chapter I. General Conception of the Melody, SdO ; 1. Consideration of Voice-region, ib, ; 2. Character of Keys, ib. Chapter II. Plan of the Harmony, 381; 1. The Measure or the Quantity of the Har- mony, ib. ; 2. Number of accompanying Voices, 364 ; 3. The Form of the Har- mony, 366. Chapter III. Harmonic Figuration, 367 ; Discovery of its Designs, t&. ;1. Monophonic Designs, ib. ; 3. Duophonic and Polyphonic Designs, 363. Chapter IV. Execution of the Harmonic Figuration, 370 ; A. The Harmonic Point of View, ib. ; 1. Retarded Resolution, ib. ; 3. Octave and Quint-Succession, 371; 3. Passing-tones, 373 ; B. The Melodic Point of View, ib. ; 1. Consistency of Execu- tion, 373 I 2. Firm Connection, ib. Chapter V. The Exercise of Harmonic Figuration in Passages and given Melodies, 375 ; 1. Passages rediiced to Harmonic Figuration, t&. ; 2. Accompaniment of given Melodies, 377. Chapter VI. Passing-Tone and Bye-Tone, 379 ; Help Tones, 381; Trills, Turns, 8ic., 382 ; Passing or Transient Chords, 384. Chapter VII. Introduction of Passes and Help-tones into Figuration, 385 ; A. Figura- tion of the Upper Voice, ib. ; B. Figuration of the Bass, 387 ; C. Figuration of a Middle Voice, 389 ; Application, 390. Chapter VIII. Application of these means to Artistic Accompaniments, 392. APPBITDIX, The Figural Prelude, 401. ELEMENTS OE MUSICAL NOTATION. Br THE TRANSLATOB. PREFACE TO THE ELEMENTARY PART. The indefiniteness of the English language, in everything concerning Music, makes it a task of extreme difficulty to write an Elementary Treatise, corresponding to a theoretical work of any foreign, and particularly German author. The German musicians have made Music so thorough a study, that it is absolutely impossible to do them justice in trans- lating their works with general terms, which at every step are subject to modifications and contradictions. It is this consideration which has induced the Translator of this work to prepare the student by an Elementary Trea- tise, the chief object of which is to give exact definitions of such terms as may occur in this or other works of the same author, and the exact meaning of which it is absolutely ne- cessary for the student to know. In order to avoid the introduction of indefinite terms, or arguments upon them, as much as possible, the Translator has thought it best to convey the necessary information in regu- lar didactic form ; and if comparisons and arguments cannot be absolutely avoided, they will be made at least as brief as possible. INTRODUCTION. " Music is the art of combining sounds agreeable to tbe ear," is the general definition given of the word. Not every sound, however agreeable to the ear, is a musi- cal sound ; nor is a combination of such sounds always Mu- sic. It follows, then, that our first task must be to distin- guish musical sounds, or sounds agreeable to the ear, from such sounds as constitute Music. We know that the ear is the organ which is most directly afiected by Music. Every vibration of air caused by a col- lision of bodies, or other means, sufficient to affect the ear, we designate by the general name of SOUND. We know, also, that Music is produced by the human voice, as well as by instruments of various kinds — Flutes, Trumpets, Violins, &c. These instruments distinguish themselves from each other by the quality of their sounds. Finally, we perceive on one and the same instrument, that the sounds produced upon it vary in regard to pitch. Thus, for instance, are the sounds produced on the shorter strings of a Harp more acute than those produced on a longer string. When we consider a sound in this respect, we must call it 16 TONE. We have, therefore, many different tones. The tones of the longer or thicker strings are called low ; those of the shorter or thinner strings are called high. Thus of human voices, we say that the tones of a man's voice, in general, are lower than those of a boy's or girl's voice ; the tones of the Flute, Violin, Trumpet, we say, are higher than those of the Bassoon, Double-bass, and Horn. We say " in ge- neral ;" for since every voice and every instrument can pro- duce many tones, it can occur that the highest tones of a man's voice, for instance, are higher than the lowest tones of a girl's voice, &c. Every tone or sound to be produced, must be produced within a certain time, therefore must fill a certain space of time,— ^a longer or shorter space, definite or indefinite. This time, or space of time, accorded to a tone or sound, is called its DURATION. We say, therefore, of a tone : it has a definite or inde . finite duration. If we cause the gradual production of a series of tones or sounds of certain duration, according to some regulating law, in any fixed and continued, i.e. repeated, time-mo- ments, we call this regulation of time-succession, RHYTHM. Where such regulation does not take place, the tones have either no certain duration, or follow in no regular succes- sion ; we say that such tone-succession is unrhythmical. A succession of toneS; which is formed according to any 17 particular plan, and at the same time rhythmically regulated, (whether agreeably, expressively, &c., or not,) is called a MELODY.* A piece of Music can consist of a single tone-series, — it is then called Monophonic, (for one voice.) Or it can consist of two, three, four, or more, simulta- neously progressing tone-series ; it is then called Duophonic (for two voices) ; Triphonic (for three voices) ; Tetraphonic (for four voices) ; or Polyphonic (for many voices.) Each series of tones, however, whether sung or produced upon some instrument, is called a TOICE . The simultaneously-meeting tones of different voices must stand to each other in some reasonable, corresponding rela- tion. This relation is called HARMONY . And of all these essentials : tones and sounds, tone-suc- cession and rhythm, melody and harmony, does MUSIC consist. * A mve concise definition of Melody will be given at a later porioc'. FIRST PAET. TONES AND NOTES. CHAPTEE I. THE TONE SYSTEM. Tone is a sound of certain height or depth, (pitch.) We know already that there are many tones ; the mass of the various tone-gradations is absolutely innumerable. In Music, however, not all these tone-gradations are made use of. A part merely of these tones are actually and fixedly employed. These tones constitute what is called the TONE SYSTEM. This tone-system contains above one hundred tones. It would have occasioned much difficulty to fix a particular name for each of them ; and this has been the cause of the classification of these tones under seven DEGREES. These degrees have been named C— D— E— F— G— A— B. And all tones have one of these names, or one derived from them. CHAPTEE II. THE NOTE SYSTEM. For the designation of tones, we make use of a series of characters, called NOTES. It would be tedious for us to enter into the history of Mu- eical Notation. We must content ourselves with communi- cating the facts, that after many changes and modifications, five lines have been fixed upon, on which, or between which, the tones are indicated by open or filled circles, or ovals, ac- cording to their pitch and duration. 1. Where these five lines are not sufiBcient, additional lines, called LEGER LINES are introduced, which, not being continuous, are easily dis- tinguished from the lines of the stave. Here 2. ^=1=1=4 ^ 4 j 4 - w« have introduced the leger lines, in order to designate 20 those high or low tones, which are above the highest or the lowest tones capable of being designated within the stave. We might now read and write all notes, if we only knew what meaning to attach to any particular note. In other words, we must fix upon some point, or some note corre- sponding to a certain tone, by which we can be guided in the designation of the others. For this purpose we have certain characters, called CtEF s, which indicate the tone represented by them. Of such clefs there are three in use : — The G-clef, or Treble-clef ; The C-clef, and The F-clef, or Bass-clef. 1. — THE G-CLEF has this form, fc and indicates that upon the line inclosed by its lower circle, the tonei g, (the lowest g of the Oboe, or the fourth /f of a six-octave Piano-forte, counting from the left to the right,) shall be represented. French composers of former times, placed this clef upon the first line of the stave, thus making it imperative to consider the note upon it as the representa- tive of the tone g. At present the G-clef is invariably placed upon the second line of the stave, and the notes pre- ceded by it would accordingly be named thus : — il s^s m FGAB CDEFGAB CDEFG ■gab 21 By means of additional leger-lines, we migtt designate many additional tones upon this stave ; but since the read- ing of such notes would be a very troublesome task, another character has been invented, in the shape of a wave, or dot- ted line : — 8- which, with the figure 8 before it, and the S succeeding it, indicates that the passage thus marked is to be played or sung an octave higher than it is written- The leger lines below the stave can be avoided, if neces- sary, by substituting another cM. More of this, however, anon. 2- THE C-CLEF, Its most usual form is this B , and its use is a three- fold one. Indicatiag the tone '(jj^) :, it is used — A, as Soprano-clef; in which case it is placed upon the first line of the stave, and the names of the notes succeeding it are fixed accordingly : ' * A B DEFGAB CDEFGABC B, as Alto- clef. As such it is placed upon the third line of the stave, and the notes succeeding it are called : — 3 ^^B ,jmm. V -i- z ^ « ^ = D E CDEFGAB CDE 22 C, as Tenor-clef. As sueli it IS placed apbn the fourth line of the stave, and the notes succeeding it are called : — 6." .^wi-it^ m ^ m ^-f? 1^ A B DEFGAB CDEFGAB It is hardly necessary to add, that additional leger-lines can be employed in the C-clef, as -well as in the G or i^-clef. 3 . — T HE F-CLEF. It has generally this ^f;, or some other similar form, . It is now placed and indicates the tone f$ exclusively upon the fourth line of the stave, and thus gives to the notes succeeding it the following names : — F •^-J-f- "5AB CDEFGAB ODE ~2~l ■ "!r „ E F The attentive student will have divined, ere this, what these different clefs are used for. Bass and Treble clefs even are not sufficiently convenient for all tone-series and voices. The F-clef, for instance, would be too low for a Tenor or Alto voice, while the Treble, or G-clef, would be just as mnch too high. The former would require, at least, four leger-lines above the stave, and the latter just as many be- low the stave. How much more convenient in this respect is the Alto and the Tenor clef : — 23 8. 3: ^ =£ The above passage, if written in the Treble-clef, would appear 6hus — :&=r T— — J— — « — =P=: -*- and in the Bass-clef thus— 10. -*- 1- -t .B. *4.- h- P> 1 +- ^ These different clefs are also used in passages of exten- sive compass, for which a single clef would not be sufficient. Here, for instance, 11. ei ^ i Bi ^ -* 1—^ ^^. 9 i is a passage, ■which, by means of changing the clefs, has been made readable ; while the use of a single clef would have made it almost unintelligible. When several voices combine in one composition, they are written upon separate, parallel staves, and each voice is pre- ceded by its proper clef ; for instance, the G-clef for the higher voices, the f -clef for the lower ones. In such case each clef is valid until replaced by another. CHAPTEE m. ABBBETEATIONS AOT) OTHER ACCrDEIITAL CHAEACTEES rw MUSIC. We have already mentioned the character which trans- poses a tone-series to the octave above. The same charac- ter is used for the transposition of a passage into a lower oc- tave. In such case the wave-line is placed below the notes to be transposed. For single notes the figure 8 will be suffi- cient. A similar facilitation consists in employing the words alV-ott«va, or aZZ'S^*, which, if placed above the notes, in- dicates that the higher octave is to be added to the notes thus marked ; if placed below the notes, the lower octave ia intended. Thus the following passages. 12. m m -$ $ :c :•: might be expressed in this manner : — 13. m all'Sya. , m all'Sva. fcti: 25 Other abbreviations, like alia 3za (ter^£), alia 6S {sista), &c., will need no further explanation. Finally, there are certain characters intended to save the notation of a passage partly. If a passage is to be repeated two, three, or four timeSj it is written but once, and the words — his, — ter, — quater, are placed above it. In addition to the above, the passages to be repeated are often inclosed by curves, or dots : — X4.^ n Bis. Bis. J r ^ m 1 ./ ■ W 1 < - » f 8-5 * - jfi X'-A 1 ' A * p - Si- ■ 1 t • 1 1 If a more extensive passage, or perhaps a distinct part of a composition, is to be repeated, the repeat, consisting of two perpendicular lines, with dots on one or both sides, is made use of : — If the dots are placed on both sides, the repeat refers to the part just played, as well as to the succeeding part, which latter must be terminated by another repeat with dots on one side. If a part is to be repeated from the beginning of a com- position, a repeat with dots on one side only is necessary : — ,15. i 26 If a passage is to be repeated, the end of which expe- riences an alteration in its repeat, the part to be altered is enclosed by a curve, and the words 1= (prima volta), are placed above it. In the repetition of such part, the passage marked 1^ is omitted, and the player has to pass on beyond the repeat, where the words 2S (seconda), should be placed to guide him. The words prima volta, and seconda volta, stand here for 1st and 2d, time, and thus explain the mys- tery. The words Da capo, (D. C, or B. c, or d. c.,) have a similar meaning, — i. e., " to repeat." If the repetition goes merely to a certain point, where the piece is to be ended, the point is marked by the word — Fine, (end,) and for the sake of clearness a pause : is placed above the end note ; and instead of the simple D. C, the words D. C. aljine (from the commencement to the end), are placed at the point where the repetition is to take place. If the repetition is to begin at a certain point in the mid- dle of the piece, that point is marked thus : and instead of d. c, the words d. s., (dal segno,) from the sign, are used. 27 There are in use still more characters of abbreviation and facilitation, we might say, but these not being absolutely ne- cessary for our immediate purpose, vre shall give their mean- ing -ffhen they occur. CHAPTER IV. ELEVATION Aim) DEPEESSION. When we compare our notes and tones, as far as we know them at present, with the key-board of a Piano-forte, we find that we do not know yet all the tones of our system, and that consequently we cannot represent them by notes. We have reference to the upper keys, or black keys of the Piano-forte. We have permitted this temporary incom- pleteness, in order to obtain a basis from which we can ea- sily arrive at the wanting tones and characters. Our tones, thus far, if succeeding each other in regular rotation, are by no means equidistant from each other. Beginning from c, for instance, we arrive at the next tone d ; between the two, however, there is room for another tone. The same relation exists between d and c,/ and g, g and a, a and b. A diagram of these relations will aid us materially in achieving our object. We have here accidentally mentioned c as the first tone ; and on examination the series from c to its octave, will be found so satisfactory to the ear, that we shall adopt it at once as the normal tone-series for our ana- lysis, being, in addition to the above, the only one of the seven tone-series at present within our reach, which is com- pletely satisfactory. Here, then, is a diagram in which the possible intermediate tones are marked by a mere dot, for 29 the simple reason that, at present, we have no other means of designating them : C — d — ef — g — a — b c We repeat, again, that this succession of tones is perfectly satisfactory to the ear ; and since we ascend, as it were, from one c to the other, we will call the whole diagram a lad- der, or to use a technical expression derived from the Latin word for " Ladder," (^scala,) we will call it A SCALE . Having once adopted the term " scale," it is but natural that we should call the intermediate tones DEGREES, and the distances from tone to tone, or from degree to de- gree, STEPS . When we now compare the different steps, we find that those admitting of an intermediate tone are larger, must be larger, than those which do not admit of an intermediate tone. We will distinguish these different species of steps by the terms " whole steps," or " steps," and " half steps." We find, further, that our scale contains five steps, and two half steps, distributed in such a manner, that from the first to the second, from the second to the third, from the fourth to the fifth, from the fifth to the sixth, and from the sixth to the seventh degree, are steps ; and from the third to the fourth, and from the seventh to the eighth degree, are half steps, as in the following diagram : 1 1 i 1 1 1 J 16, c — d — e-f — g — a — h-c. 30 We stated In a former paragraph that ottr taking c as the basis of a scale, was merely accidental. We will remember that a succession of tones, in order to be a scale, must be a regular succession, in which the steps and half steps are distributed according to the above diagram. And now we will attempt to form a scale from any other tone. We take g-, which the student may again consider merely accidental ; the reason, whereof, however, will soon become apparent to him. The regular succession is attended to when we take the degrees, as they follow from g to g, thus : g—a, 6, c, d, e,/, g ; or thus, ,17. i but on striking these notes on the Piano, and comparing them with our last diagram (No. 16), we soon discover that the steps from the sixth to the seventh, and from the seventh to the eighth degree, are different from our diagram. The e and g are correct, but the/ is not what we want. Yet the / degree is necessary to make our scale complete. And now we return to those intermediate tones, for which we could find no name. There is the very tone we need between the/ and g-. The/ degree being absolutely indis- pensable, we place this new tone upon it ; and in order to distinguish it from the original/", we place this mark — # before it. This character is called a " sharp," and conveys the idea, that the tone before the representative of which it 31 is placed, has been made more acute, elevated — sharpened, as it were. The scale of G, with this amendment, would present the following appearance : 18. i It is now a correct scale in every particular, differing from the scale of C in but one point, that of pitch. It is time now to give the reasons for taking the tone g to experiment upon. The student will perceive that one tone only required an alteration. G was the fifth tone of our ori- ginal scale, and in taking again the fifth tone of our new scale, d, one more sharp will be all that is requisite to make the scale of D correspond with that of G. Thus the stu- dent may pursue his course, adding sharp to sharp, while we begin at a different point, probably to meet him at some point where we can explain his doubts, or remove his indeci- sion. We have simply to add, that in the course of his la- bors, if he pursues the plan we indicated, — i. e., always re- suming his task from the fifth tone of the last scale, he will soon discover tones which are not in our original scale; but in following the above directions, he cannot fail in com- pleting his scale. We have succeeded so well in constructing a scale up- on g, the fifth tone above c, that we are warranted by it, at least, in attempting the formation of a scale upon f, the fifth tone below c. Let us again write our degrees in regular succession, be- ginning with^ 32 19. rf; ^ J J r f-r^ Comparing the steps of this tone-succession with our dia- gram No. 16, we find that while in the scale of G, it was the seventh tone which required being replaced by another, it is now the fourth tone which demands a modification. We bear again in mind, that we must preserve the regular sue cession of the degrees, and b being too high, we have re- course to the intermediate tone below it, and in order to dis- tinguish it from the original h, we place a b before it. This character is called a " flat," and conveys the idea, that the tone before the representative of which it is placed has been lowered, depressed— ^aWewed, as it were. With it the scale of F would present the following ap- pearance : 20. m *= g The elevated tones have the word " sharp" afiSxed to them, as/ sharp, g sharp, &c. The depressed tones have the name "flat" affixed to them, as h flat, a flat, &c. Taking fifth above fifth tone to construct our scales upon, would give us the scales of C, G,D,^,E,B,Fi, Cit,&c. Taking fifth below fifth, would give us the scales of C,F,Bi>,E\>,Jl\>,Di, Gk 33 That some of these scales should be alike in sound, yet different in appearance, need not trouble us. Enough that we know when to use the one or the other, and enough to remember that we issued from the same point in two differ- ent directions, and that our impulse has carried us over ground previously gone over from the other point. ai. il FfaT. iFLaTi §FILOTini3 .l.fHfiilSI'.i In order to avoid the unnecessary accumulation of charac- ters in the notation of a piece of music, the sharps or flats incident to the scale or key in which a composition has been written, are merely placed at the beginning of the piece, or at the beginning of each stave, and are called the signature of a scale or key. This signature is valid until it is recalled by certain characters, (of which we shall speak directly,) or until another signature occurs. During the course of a piece of music, we have then to remember how many sharps or flats its key requires, and what tones have been thus modi- fied. 34 The fact of there being in existence incidental flats and sharps, leads us to suppose that there are also accidental flats and sharps. These occur in almost every piece of mu- sic, and arise when the composer leaves the key in •which the piece is written, either temporarily or permanently, without changing the signature, or when a tone of a foreign scale is introduced without afiecting the regular key. In such case the sharp or flat is always placed before the tone, and holds good imtil it is recalled — i. e,', until the modified tone ia re- placed by the original one, or until the end of the measure ia which the accidental occurs. The character used for neutralizing a sharp or flat is called a " natural," and has this form : H It is placed before the note to be neutralized, and holds good to the end of the measure* in which it occurs. There are also instances in which the incident elevation or depression of a tone is not sufficient to reach the desired point of pitch. Double sharps (X) and double flats, {hh,) have been introduced in such cases. The former elevates the tone an additional half step, the latter depresses it in the same ratio. We need hardly naention that a double na- tural (tlfc^) is required to neutralize the efiect of either. If the intermediate tones of which we have spoken, can occur in the course of a composition, they can also occur in a scale. Here * The word measure signifies a musical division marked by perpendicular lines, called " bars." More of thi» in the chapter on Rhythm. 35 22. ^^^^^ ^^^p^^ m is the scale of C, with all its intermediate tones. We have written the ascending scale with sharps, and the descending scale with flats, in order to avoid the introduction of natu- rals. A better reason for it, however, will be given in the " Theory of Music." A scale, in which the intermediate tones are introduced, is called a Chromatic Scale. In contradistinction to it the original scale is called the Diatonic Scale. Tones which differ in name but not in sound, like 6 and c l" , c t and d b , c I and/, &c., are called Enharmomc, More cf this hereafter. CHAPTBE V. THE MEASUEING OP TONE-EELATIOKS. Since Music is a combination of tones, it is necessary to know the relations of these tones to each other. We can designate it superficially, by merely stating that one tone is higher than another, for instance, ^ or a is higher than the d of the same octave. But since under and above each tone there are many lower and higher ones, this statement is by no means as exact as we should desire it. Counting the degrees would be already much more exact. Beginning from any one which we call the first degree, we call the next above it the second, third, &c. Frequently the Latin numerals are used for this purpose ; and since they will occur even in our work, we will give both the Latin and English names. There are then — The first degree, or First, or Prima. The second — " Second, or Secunda. The third, — " Third, or Tertia. The fourth, — " Fourth, or Qunrta. The fifth, — " Fifth, or Quinta. The sixth, — " Sixth, or Sexta. The seventh, — " Seventh, op Septima. And in some .instances it is necessary to go even further. Thus we have — 37 The eighth degree, or Octave, or Octava. The ninth degree, " Ninth, or Nona. The tenth degree, " Tenth, or Decima. The eleventh degree, " Eleventh, or Undecima. The twelfth degree, " Twelfth, or Duodecima. The thirteenth degree, " Thirteenth, or Decima tertia. The fourteenth degree, " Fourteenth, or Decima quarta. We perceive at once that Octave, Nintli, Tenth, &c., are nothing but the first, second, third, and fourth degree, in a higher octave. Yet, at a later period^ we shall discover that there is a difference, sometimes, between these degrees. When we now compare two tones in regard to their re- spective pitch, we place them in a relation to each other. This relation is called — INTERVAL. We say, therefore, C and D form together the interval of a second, G and D the interval of a fifth, &c. But even this designation is not sufficiently exact, for we know that each of our degrees embraces j/?De different tones. Which of those five is now in reality intended ? If we de- mand, for instance, the fifth of C, it may be g,ov g'i , or ^X, or ^1" , or g^^. They all stand upon the fifth degree from C, and consequently are all fifths. We require, therefore, a more exact tone-measure, and for it we take the smallest measures of our tone-system, the HALF-STEP, and the STEP. We are now enabled to give an exact statement of the tone-relations of any possible interval, by merely counting the steps and half-steps therein contained. Thus the second 38 c — d, for instance, contains two half-steps, c — c S and c 4 — d, or c — d b and (i b — d " . The third c — e contains two steps, c — d and d — e, or four half-steps, c — c S , c I — d, rf — d it , and dit — e. But it would be too troublesome always to give the exact measure of an interval in so many steps and half-steps, and for this reason there have been distinguished four classes of intervals, which in themselves at once express the exact measure of the relation. Each interval can be — Major, or Minor, or Diminished, or Superfluous. Each minor interval arises from the diminution of a ma- jor one, or in other words, it is a half-step smaller than the same major interval. Each diminished interval is a half-step smaller than the minor interval, or two half-steps smaller than the same ma- jor interval. Each superfluous interval is a half-step larger than the major interval. When we once know, therefore, how large the major in- tervals are, it will be easy to make of them minor, dimin- ished, or superfluous intervals. And the best representa- tion of the major intervals is — ouK SCALE itself; for each tone in it forms with the fundamental tone a major interval. Consequently — 39 c — d is a major second, c — e " a major third, c—f « a major fourth, c — g " a major fifth, c — a " a major sixth, c — b " a major seTenth, c — c " an octave, c — d " a major ninth;* When we remember now that — The major second contains 1 step, — — third — 2 steps, — — fourth, — 2 steps, and 1 half-step, — — fifth, — 3 steps, and 1 half-step, — — sixth, — 4 steps, and 1 half-step, — — seventh, — 5 stops, and 1 half-step, — — octave, — 5 steps, and 2 half-steps, — — ninth, — 6 steps, and 2 half-steps, it will be easy to measure the other intervals. Having once obtained a major interval, it will be easy to make of it a minor, diminished, or superfluous one, by add- ing or subtracting as many half-steps (by depression or ele- vation) as are requisite. If, for instance, we wish to change the major fifth c — g into a minor one, we must subtract a half-step, i. e., change the g to g^ . C — g^ is a minor fifth. The minor intervals from c are therefore — c — d b, the minor second, c — e i, — — third, c—f b, — — fourth, c—g b, — — fifth, c—a b, — — sixth, c — b b, — — seventh. * We must bear in mind that these intervals are merely major, as related to the fundamental tone of the scale (c) . The other degrees amongst them- selves form various intervals ; thus d—f and e — g are not major thirds ; f—b is no* a major fourth, &c. 40 In order to change c — g into a superfluous fifth, the g must be elevated a half-step. In order to make of the ma- jor seventh c I — 6 S a minor seventh, b i must be depressed a half-step, and must become 6 " . In order to make of the minor seventh c t — h a diminished seventh, b must be de- pressed an additional half-step ; c It — b ^ is a diminished se- venth. In this manner it is very easy to represent any mi- nor, diminished, or superfluous interval. In the last chapter we made mention of enharmonic tones ; we find now intervals, which though of equal height in re- gard to the tones constituting them, have different names, and which, therefore, are called — Enharmonic Intervals. Thus, for instance, the minor third c — e ^ is enharmonic with the superfluous second c — d i ; the superfluous fifth c — g S is enharmonic with the minor sixth c — a t , &c. CHAPTER VI. THE TONE SPECIES, SEXES, OE MODES. We have seen that Music has at its command seven de- grees, upon which, however, can be constructed a great num- ber of tones and tone-relations. It is possible that all these tones and relations can occur in one composition. But since every work of art has certain limits of design and tendency, since it expresses a certain round of ideas and sensations, it is natural that the tones and tone-relations should be limited in the same manner ; that for each composi- tion there should be a certain circle of tones and relations, ■within which the composition should exclusively or principally move. This circumstance facilitates the task of intr^ucing the student into the empire of tone-formations, without the risk of his losing himself in the infinity of manifold forms. The seven degrees, so lately mentioned, form the basis' of every composition. But each degree can be represented in five different manners, and thus there are innumerable pos- sibilities of combination. But of all these possibilities, the system of modern Music has selected two as the only essential ones. They are called — Tone Species, or Modes, and are either major or minor. 42 In both are the seven degrees, and they are distinguished from each other by the relation of the degrees to each other and by the size of the interval which each degree iorms -with the first tone. THE MAJOR MODE has exclusively major intervals. Consequently all the scales we formed in the fourth chapter are major scales, and belong to the major mode. THE MINOR MODE contains also major intervals, with the exception of the Third and Sixth, which are mmor. Since we know how to change major intervals into minor, it will be easy for us to change a major mode into a minor. We have but to depress the third and sixth to change C-major, c — d — e—f—g — a — 6 — c, for instance, into C-minor, c — d — e t —f — g — fit b — b — c. Thus we find that the minor scale has the following steps c — d — e I" — f—g — a ^ — b — c. 1 i 1" 1 i n i The most conspicuous step in this scale, is the one from a •> to 6, a step of a superfluous second. Like all other super- fluous intervals, this progression in the course of the scale, afiects us disagreeably. ,aa. -S^ ^^^^ 43 This, however, is not the case in every tone-succession ; for instance, not in the following : 23. P ±> >!. V. !fe n w •where the superfluous second has been avoided, and it is not our object to obtain a mild tone-succession, but a firm basis for our compositions. CHAPTEE Vn. THE KEYS. In the fourth chapter we have been taught the number of the major scales or keys, and how they can be formed. We can now form as many minor scales or keys. In the same chapter we hare also learned what signature to give to each major scale or key. The signatures of the minor keys follow a different law. Their signature is not as the scale demands it, but each minor key has the signature of that major key which lies a minor third above it. The signature of .^-minor is npt, as one would expect, a sharp before g, nor does that of D-minor consist of a c t and h l" ; but ./2-minor has the signature of C-major, and D-minor has the signature of 2^-major. Here — D, G, C, y, Bb, Eb. are the signatures of the most usual minor keys. Two keys, (a major and a minor key,) which have the same signature, are called — PARALLEL KEYS, Or PARALLEL TONES. The parallel-tone of a minor key, as we have seen, lies a 45 minor third above it, and, vice versa, the parallel-tone of a major key lies a minor third below it. We can now more fully understand the object of the sig- nature. It tells us — 1, what degrees are to be depressed or elevated ; 2, it serves us as the token of the key in which the composition has been written. But we know also that such signature can belong to two different keys ; and in or- der to ascertain exactly in what key a piece is written, we must turn to its harmony. But until we arrive at that point, we will remember that generally THE LAST TONE of a picCe, and if it ends with a chord, THE LOWEST TONE of that chord, in connection with the signature, will be a sure indicator of the key. If, for instance, the signature consisted of two sharps, and the lowest tone of the last chord were p, we would know at once that the piece is composed in B-minor, the parallel tone of D-major. But what of those degrees in the minor keys for which the signature is not suitable 1 The t or i" belonging to them is placed before the respective notes as often as they occur, thus making these elevations or depressions almost acci- dental. CHAPTER Vni. RELATION OP KEYS. When we compare the different keys with each other, we find that each deviates from the other to a greater or less degree. Thus C-major and G-major deviate but in one tonej/and/S . Comparing, however, the scale of C-major with U-major, we find that the two scales differ in four tones from each other ; C-major has _/", c, g, d j J5J-major has_/lt, c'i , gi, di . Two keys which have several tones in common are said to be RELATED. We have just now seen that this relationship can take place in a greater or less degree, according to the number of tones which the two have in common. There are, conse- quently, different DEGREES OF RELATIONSHIP. Finally, we have already seen several manners of connec- tion between different keys ; the major keys were connected in the form of the Quint-circle ; the minor keys, with the parallel major keys, and with their own major keys. There are, therefore, three kinds of relationship. 47 1. Relation of Major Keys. Here the Quint-Sircle indicates the relationship with its degrees. The keys lying close together in the Quint-circle, deviate from each other in but one tone, and stand in the f,rst degree of relationship to each other. When we spread the Quint-circle before us thus : b » 6 6 4 3 310133466 Q^^Dh—A\,—E\>—B\,—F—C—G—D-~A—E-'B—F!i we find that each key has its two nearest relations as neigh- bors to the right and to the left. Relatives of the second degree are those which differ in two tones. Thus X>-major on one side, and B !> -major on the other, stand in the second degree of relationship to C-major. 2. Relationship of Parallel Keys. The parallel keys are related to each other in the first degree, for they differ from each other in but one tone. Thus C-major and ./2-minor, C-minor and E b -major, are relatives of the first degree. When we combine this kind of relationship with the other, we perceive a new kind of relationship between the keys. We have found that each major key stands in relationship of the first degree — 1, with its neighboring major keys ; 2, with its Parallel key, — ^for instance, C-major with G-major, JP-major, and .;2-minor. But now the major keys G and F stand again in the first degree of relationship with their Paral lei tones, E-minor and D-minor. Consequently we can con sider these minor tones as relatives of the second degree to the first major key (C-major.) The following diagram ex- hibits to us : 43 0-major, » Ji'-major, A-miaoi, G-major, as relatives of the first degree. l)-ininor, jK-minor, as relatives of the second degree. We might pursue these degrees of relationship much far- ther, but this Tvould be but an unnecessary waste of time and paper. 3. Relationship of Minor Keys with their Major Keys, and amongst themselves. We know already that each minor key deviates in two de- grees from its major key, in Third and Sixth. Consequently we should consider them as relatives of the second degree. But a singular coincidence draws this bond of union closer together. The Tonic, (the first tone,) the Dominant, (the fifth tone,) and the Sub-dominant, (the fourth tone,) of each scale are its principal moments, and these three moments be- long to the major scale as well as to the minor ; and this communism of tones is so influential, (as we shall see at a later period,) that we can consider the two modes of the same tone as relatives of the first degree. And finally we consider those minor tones which stand in the relation of Tonic, Dominant, and Sub-dominant to each other, as relatives of the first degree. Thus we consider £-minor and D-minor as relatives of the first degree to .>3-minor, though their scales deviate in two and three points : D—e—f—g—a—bh—4—d—e—f — g a a—h c d — e—f — gl — a — h — c — d e e—fi—g a~-b—c—di—e When we combine these relationships with those found 49 under 2, we can form a similar diagram of relationships of first and second degree. ^-minoi, iJ-minor, C-major, E-nunor. F-major, Gr-inajor. It remains now for the student to form similar diagrams «f other major and minor keys. FIRST BOOK. ELEMENTS OF MUSICAL COMPOSITION. First Part. Composition for Single Farts, {Monophonic Composition). CHAPTER I. THE FIRST FORMATIONS. 1. THE TONE-CHAIN, WITH ITS SPECIES. "i A Musical composition consists of one or more successions of tones (tone-chains) which progress simultaneously, and which are intended for one or more instruments ; for one or more voices ; or for instruments and voices together. Beginning with the most simple — the single tone-chain — we have already to make a distinction. Por a tone-chain does not contain merely sounds, which succeed each other, but that sue cession is regulated hy certain laws (Rhythm), which indicate when one sound should succeed the other, and how long each sound is to continue. But regardless of all rhythmical laws, we will, for the present, analyze the mere tonical contents of a tone-chain. These tones can succeed each other in various manners. They can progress from low to high, from high to low, or these two directions can be mixed. We distinguish therefore ascending (a), and descending (b), tone-chains, and those, which both ascend and descend, and which we will designate as vague (c). The repeti- tion of one and the same tone, too, might inappropriately be called a tone-chain (n) ; and finally the tones can succeed each other by regular degrees, as in a, b, and c, or by irregular degrees as in B. A B C ■ ^^ -•— #- 54 It is easily perceived that ascending tone-chains produce the effect of exaltation, elevation, tension, while, on the contrary, de- scending ones produce the effect of relaxation, or return to repose. Vague tone-chains awalce neither the one nor the other sensation distinctly, but with a certain indecision remain between the two knd have a share of either. Yet with all their deviation in detail they can, in general, belong to one of the two principal species, — -»^J^ i ^=='^iir'ir7Z i 3c: We have now only to add that the motion of " step by step' is more quiet and even, while the skipping irregular motion i» restless, unsteady, and nervous. But more of that anon. Tone Eegulation. The vast resources which music has at its command make it absolutely necessary that, in our attempts to produce or invent tone-chains, we should observe a certain order and limit, in ordei to find our way amidst the enormous mass of tone-formations. We require s, foundation upon which we can construct our forma tions, and from which we can derive them. We will select the diatonic scald- as our first foundation. But since even this scale has its different species, we will select from them the original and most satisfactory one : The Major Scale. The reasons for this choice will in a future chapter become ap- parent of themselves. The major scale, from its Tonic to its octave, rests upon the i -gs: =i=«= Tonic, moves thence through the remaining degrees {d to b), and closes, satisfactorily, again upon the Tonic, or its octave. Al] this is perfectly agreeable to our feelings, and the more so -when we compare it to other tone-chains ; for instance, with 55 i ir^r or with imperfect tone-chains (not beginning, or not ending with the Tonic). m w - .0. m - We recognize the Tonic, therefore, as the heginning and end of the scale. The latter originates from the Tonic and returns to it. In juxtar-position to the Tonic — the moment of repose, — the scale — the moment of motion, — is formed. Here we have discovered at last an antithesis which runs through the whole science of musi& — Repose and Motion, Tonic and Scale. Analysis of the Scale. When we examine the scale in its smgle progressions we find that it contains Steps and half-steps, and that it consists of two halves, exactly alike in steps ; i. e. each half containing two steps and one half-step. G B E F G A B C* one one half one one half * We suppose that every student of composition is familiar with tin major scales ; but in case of the student's not being able to represent to him- self such a scale at once, we refer him to the above measurement of th« scale for assistance. We know that on every tone of our tone-system we can construct a major scale, and that all major scales have like proportions ; they all progress like the above c major : 1 step, 1 step, -J step, 1 step, 1 step, 1 st«p, -J step. In order then to construct a major Scale on any particular tone, we have but to write the seven degrees from it to the octave, and justify it after- wards, by means of flats or sharps, according to the above diagi-am. In constructing the scale on a, for instance, we first write the seven degrees : ABGDEFGA and measure each step. A to b, a whole step, agrees with the diagram : 6 to c ought to be a whole step, and consequently will have to be enlarged by changing c into cj| ; c^io d is now a half -step, dto e a whole step ; both in accordance with our model : eiof, however, is merely a half-step when it ought to be a whole one ; consequently /has to be changed into/|, and, for the same reason, g into g^. In constructing the scale oid\> major, we would first write the degrees thus: — Dh E F G A B G Dh and then regulate the distances from one degree to the other by means of sharps or flats, whichever is wanted. 56 The one of these tone-chains originates in c, the Tonic; the other leads to c, the Tonic ; both find in c their centre and juno tional point. G A £ O _^ C B JS F Even in this formation of the scale we find the Tonic the chief point from which the other tones advance, to which they return, and around which they move. 2. — ^Rhtthmioal Formation of the Tone-Chain. We have until now considered the ionical contents only of the tone-chain and scale, and we have tacitly admitted that one tone after another should resound. This resounding, however, can happen at equal and unequal intervals of time ; and the latter particularly, in a most infinitely varied manner. We will there- fore begin again with the most simple, and imagine a regular suc- cession, each tone of equal value; for instance, the scale in crotchets (quarter-notes) : i? But this form does not satisfy us, because one tone like the other passes by, without distinction. The longer we would continue this chain of equi-long sounds, the more fatiguing and confusing would it be to us. Our feeling urges us to distinguish and to regulate ; we must divide this chain to make it easier of conception. Admitting the division by two as the easiest, we would begin perhaps in this manner : A « ry r^ f\ and thus arrive at the simplest regulation of time. Simple Measure. This regulation, at present, exists only in our imagination, or on paper ; but to make it reality we distinguish every first note of a measure (marked '^) by a stronger accentuation. This accent makes every beginning of a measure perceptible, and by these 57 means we have introduced into our scale a variety to -which de- cided and absolute necessity has led us. Our tone-chain appears now well regulated in regard to time, and this regulation has been made perceptible by the alternate change of strong and weak intonation ; in short, it has been made rhythmical ; it has received the Rhythm. A Rhythmical Tone-Chain is called a Melody, and a melody is the first and simplest creation of art. Already in our first attempt we found it necessary to begin and end with the Tonic as the most important tone, and its com- pleteness and perfection was in fact owing to this beginning and ending thus. But now we have learned also to distiuguish rhythmically important and unimportant tones. If our melodies shall now be round and perfect, rhythmically as well as tonically, we will find it desirable that they should have rhythmical chief notes for the beginning and for the end. We experience an unsatisfactory feeling in the above melody, because, though beginning on a principal part it ends on an unim- portant one ; and the melody is lost, as it were, because the end- note has no weight. We will therefore re-form our scale in this manner : 3. The beginning has lost its emphasis, but the succeeding notes and the satisfactory end remunerate us for it. But perhaps we prefer not being tied to this particular form of beginning ; it may be possible to have a beginning and ending alike satisfactory. And here is the time to remember a principle which should accompany us through all our labors. " Whenever a formation appears to us imperfect in its parts, or not clear and comprehen- sible, we should always retain of it whatever we have found good or necessary — ^let it be found wherever it may — and afterwards try to supply what is wanting." In this instance we know, that it is our object to place the be- ginning and ending of our melody on an accented part of the measure. We also know, that the eight notes of our scale have n A /\ '^1 A J . '(( "] a ' r V- ) J a - i • *J -#- • 58 to appear in four measures — at least we know at present of no other form. Finally, if the last tone has to fall on an accented part it must be either in the shape of a half-note, or a quarter- note, succeeded by a quarter-rest. This noted down would give us a figure something like the fol- lowing: m and we see at once clearly what has to be done. The three wanting notes have to enter the vacant measure. The first of these can do so in the form of a quarter note; the other two have to become eighth notes. i w s We have now arrived at a formation which ccarresponds with all our demands. It is — 1. In regard to tone-succession, beginning and ending on the Tonic. 2. It is rhythmically well regulated, 3. In regard to accentuation of beginning and end-note, it is distinct and well closed off, and thus satisfactory. But at the same time we have obtained — 4. A variety of rhythm — three species of notes ; half-notes, quarter-notes, and eighth-notes — and this variety proves itself at the same titne-, 5. A means of promoting our object: for, the end-note, the aim of the whole, has the longest duration; and the eighth-notes, immediately before it, serve to accelerate the movement towards it, and to make the end-note more characteristic. We have now a gradation of rhythm as well as of melody. Thus far we have inadvertently represented all our tone-chains as ascending. Nothing prevents us now from attempting a descending one: 6. P s -&- 59 It exhibits a steady and satisfactory return to repose — the begin- ning of all our tone movements. But both formations have a very one-sided character. The one is all elevation ; the other is exclusively relaxation. Only the combination of the two in a larger whole can in every respect satisfy us. m ^ m mm We have now arrived at a tone formation which, issuing from the Tonic, rises in pitch and rhythm to the Tonic of a higher oc- tave, marks this point by a rhythmical pause, and then returns in the same steady manner to the repose of the first tone. We per- ceive also that this formation is composed of two halves (a and b) which, each by itself perfect, combine to make the perfect whole, a whole consisting of two subordinate wholes. But though each of these parts or phrases resembles the other in rhythmical form- ation and tone-contents, the direction in the tone succession of each is exactly opposite ; the one forming the reversed counterpart of the other. Such formation, consisting of two perfect phrases, thesis and antithesis, is called a Period. Formations which lack the satisfactory ending of a period or 8. m phrase are called passages. Retrospection. We have now conceived the first ideas of composition, and realized them in tones. They were — 1. The tone-chain, with its different directions and progres- sions. The first foundation of all tone succession — the diatonic scale. The distinction between repose and motion in the scale. The first and simplest rhythmical order, by the aid of which a mere tone-chain became a melody. 60 5. The fixed and manifold valuation of sounds, mensural division, and accent. 6. The melody strove to acquire a rhythmical marked point of beginning and ending and became a phrase. 7. This brought ns to a variety of rhythmical motion. 8. The invented phrase (thesis) demanded a counterpart (antithesis), and the two together formed a Period. 9. A formation of a new nature — the passage — ^was indi- cated. And thus we have arrived at the three fundamental formations of all musical constructions : Phrase — Period — ^Passage — and have recognized the characteristics of their construction. 61 CHAPTER II. INTENTION OF MONOPHONIO PHRASES. 1. THE DESIGN AND ITS EFFICACr. In order to arrive at new progressions we wiU return now to our first satisfactory phrase (No. 5). We see it constructed of different parts ; in the first measures a series of quarter-notes ; in the latter quarter and eighth-notes, which lead to the final note. Thus we can distinguish various tone-groups ; for instance, a tone- chain of quarter-notes. 'i w A group ending more satisfactorily is in the latter measures. 10. ». ^ If we are willing to resign a satisfactory ending, we can select still more groups. "•^ w g Such forms which contain the germ and the impulse of longer phrases are called designs. Each junction of two or more notes can serve as a design. Every composition consists of such de- signs, and it is for us to consider how we are to nurse these germs, how to apply them, and how to multiply them, in order to arrive continually at new phrases, passages, and periods. The invention of these designs is already sufficiently prepared. The simple scale has given us six, and every new formation adds to that number. Every design can be applied by itself — fi2 1. By repetition on the same degrees, 12. ^^^a 2. By repetition in a higher or lower range, i p^ 3. By repetition in opposite direction. i 5 4. By repetition in notes of longer or shorter duration (aug mentation and diminution). Original design. Augmented. DiminiBhcd. 13. ^ j-jS 5. By changing of i^esis (weak, unaccented part of a measure) into arsis (accented part of a measure), or vice versa. f P^3 6. By expanding or contracting the design ; i. e., by changing a smaller for a larger interval, or vice versa. '%- -&- ^ ".^^^^^ 7. By combining one design with another, or more to a phrase ; 1^ i w We need not mention that these different manners of applica^ tion can change with each other, or combine to a greater whole. We can already see how inexhaustible the field of musical formation is. We need therefore only show a few of these de- signs, and leave it to the industry of the student to invent others. 63 But to return again to our actual task, we will begin this time with the most subordinate of our formations — the passages. We say most subordinUte, because they do not even end within themselves. 2, FOKMATION OF PASSAGES. Each repetition of a design produces a passage. Thus the repetition of the third design, in No. 11, gives us the following ffi •#-l- In the one we have ascended above the Tonic, in the other we have descended below it, and in thus starting from and returning to the Tonic, deviations from the general direction have appeared. This can take place at any other point as well, A 26. ^P^g^ and since we have here, at a, gone back one note, we might as well go back two or three. 27. i D -#- 5 But here, in No. 27, we have already filled four measures with- out arriving at the Tonic. We find it necessary to enlarge our phrases ; we take four more measures and continue, perhaps in this manner: 28. ^S^^^^g^^ We need not defend the slight variation in the sixth measure. A strict adherence to the design would have led us beyond the proposed number of measures. The dragging of the above might be corrected by the substitution of a short note for a long one, 29. —p -^ 1- and this would lead us to end the above phrase perhaps like this . 30. ^i^^ss^^ We have now arrived at a greater liberty of foi-mation. The different parts need no longer be of the same length, but require merely being balanced ; two sections of two measures each are succeeded by a third one which has four measures and deviates in its form by being more animated. Since we have now abandoned the division by 2, we might at- tempt slow phrases of three equal sections or divisions. 31. ^ :zz t 3± We have introdu6ed this merely in order to show how unten- able the common law is : that each phrase or period ought to consist of two or more measures. We shall give more instances in future ; for with the same right with which we have introduced the figure 3 here, we shall introduce other deviations from the primitive proportions. 4. PERIODS. We have formed our first period of thesis and antithesis, and both parts were perfectly corresponding with each other, only that the tone-chains were conducted into opposite directions. This is the simplest formation ; but No. 30 teaches us to give to the anti- thesis a more animated, different formation. Thus we might form No. 23 into a period by enlarging it thus : 32. ^ 3 It will be advisable to observe at first, in these important parts — the thesis and antithesis — equality in the number of measures, and to accustom the mind to order and symmetry, before attempt- ing other, more free formations. 67 CHAPTER III. DISCOVERY OF NEW MEANS. We have now discovered all the fundamental forms of musical construction, together with their characteristics. The forms were : the Design, the Section, the Phrase, the Passage, the Period— ^with thesis and antithesis. We will now again return to the third design of No. 11, and analyze its contents. It consists of three notes — one quarter note and twx) eighth notes, or together, a 2-4 measure. But the three notes might also have equal value, and in that case we would be led to a new design which would give us the following phrase, 33. Ep=lEj £ and with it " the Triple Time." The difference between this and former designs is, that in the former ones every first note was longer than the following. The same proportions can be represented in Triple time, and by this means we obtain a new formation. 34. ^m^- s ^- :?2= In our first design the first note was as long as the two fallow- ing together. Here it is of twice the length. To give it thrice the length would lead us from Triple time to Common time, or from 4. to X- 35. fe^a^^^ e,8 We might have obtained the same result in ■^ time, if we had doubled the length of the firs^ note or contracted two measures into one. In the latter case we should have obtained period? of twice two measures, 36. ABA BAB A B E closing with what was once a chief part, but otherwise regularly built. But, little as the difference between No. 36 and Na 7 may ap- pear, it reveals to us what in fiiture wjll be very important. 1. We perceivfe that No. 36 not merely originated in No. 7, but has also the same tonical content and the same rhythm of notes. The notes here marked with a have beea chief notes or accented notes in No. 7, and have remained so in No. 36. Those marked b, have at least been chief notes, and have here less ac- cent than those marked a, but more than all the remaining notes. We can, therefore, unhesitatingly change a a phrase into 4-4 2 a A one, and a a one into a a one. Even if the end note of a small phrase should fall upon a former chief part, as in No. 36, it will still be sufficiently marked. 2. We perceive in the prolongation of the No. 33 — 35, a strengthening of the accent in one and the same design, by en largement of the time species, — 37. i^ 3^^^ Sk means of expression which will become particularly important in vocal composition. It is clear that by means of ties and dot- ted notes many more gradations can be obtained. 38. ^m -&■ m When we now return to No. 34, and analyze the design, we perceive that the first note contains, or is equal to, two quarters, consequently could be reduced into two quarter-notes ; 69 39. i^i il 3; SiiEt ^ir^-^ m^ or we might continue the division still further, and reduce eacih quarter-note into two eightb-notes. «-pg^#j.^^;E^ =p=f= Here we arrive at a class of new designs which consist of the repetition of one note, 41. Such designs are, of course, of rhythmical nature, and serve to animate a phrase when we are limited to few tones. But we return to No. 40. If we are not pleased with the frequent repetition of one and the same tone, we can easily ex- change it for a neighboring one ; either the higher one, 42. m P -a^*-al- Q m zpi :J_/-# or the lower one, 43.' ^^m^^^^H 1^ ~^- Why have we taken a\ intead of a ? Because in all the former measures the interval from the third to the fourth note was only a half-step, and because this smaller interval of a half-step leads more flowingly upward. Here, for the first time, have we introduced a foreign tone, and we have perceived at the same time that with the aid of such a one we can ascend more flowingly than with the whole step. We can now introduce the neighboring tone much sooner, and introduce the assistant-note still later : 44. i ^S m^ m. ± ¥-- We have to jepeat the b in the third measure, because there is no room for an intermediate tone between b and c. Perhaps the continual motion in quarter-notes might appear 70 monotonous and trifling to us. We can avoid it by leaving out the second assistant note : 45. '^m^' ^^^m^^ If we were inclined to make this interruption still more con- spicuous, we might change it into 2: time. 46. ^ ^ =K- ^^^^m In the two last phrases we arrive at a new conspicuous forma tion. The tone-chain is divided by rests into small tone-groups. They are not as important as the sections, but nevertheless of some consequence. We will call them Links. Such links might have been obtained much sooner by the prolonging of notes. And thus a period might be divided, 1, into thesis and antithesis (a, b.) 2, the thesis into two sections (a, b). 3, each section into two links, (c, d, e, f, g, h, and i.) Small as the results of Part I. may appear in comparison with the works of our great masters, it will be still advisable for the 71 student not to disdain or neglect these first attempts. The ad- vantages to be derived from them are many. First of all, the student -will acquire that systematic and ana^ logical mode of proceeding which is so absolutely necessary to the mastering of any subject. He will learn to limit himself, and to derive from any given subject the most manifold developments and results. To show how important such faculties are to the composer, we need but refer to the first Allegro of Beethoven's Symphony in C minor, which grows almost entirely from a design of four notes, — four notes which do not even distinctly indicate any particular key. ^^^^^ and yet these few notes have given rise to a composition which will claim the admiration of centuries to come. But these simple formations serve also to facilitate the indis- pensable acquirement of composing without the aid of any instru- ment. It is here where the student can learn to represent to himself, by force of imagination only, tone-formations of more or less completeness. At a later point, it is impossible. We warn the pupil, however, to guard against two faults. The one is the deserting of the analogous proceeding, so strenuously recommended, and the other, the losing sight of his object. If we had produced No. 46 immediately after No. 31 or No. 5, we should probably have obtained a good phraSe ; but the conscious- ness of the how and wherefore, and the inexhaustible source of analogous and legitimate formations would have been lost to us. The second fault exhibits itself generally in the fact, that the pupil, in consequence of impatience, or under the impression of having exhausted the scale, proceeds to harmonic formations ; for instance : A-ix. i^^^^^ We finally advise the pupil not to confine his exercises to the key of c major, but to attempt them in every major key ; and if he has once seized a design; never to rest until he has formed a Period or Phrase. 72 Second Part. Composition for Two Parts, (Duophonic Composition). CHAPTEE I. THE DUOPHONIC COMPOSITION, DEKITED FEOM THE MONOPHONIC. The more we extend our monophonic tone-chains, the more baseless must they appear ; not alone because, however interest- ing their contents, they are a mere tone-thread without volume, but because the Tonic, as the first and last note, offers too little weight against the more richly developed scale. Let us attempt, therefore, the duophonic composition. It lies nearest to add a similar tone-chain in a higher or lowei octave. No. 5 treated in this manner would give us the follow ing: 49. ^P^ It is not to be denied that this phrase is duophonic, it employs two voices in different tone-regions. The consequence of this is a larger, broader tone-volume — particularly appropriate for massive effects. But two such voices are mentally equal to one only ; for, thougL in different tone-regions, they both have the same rhythm and tone-succession. Yet this proceeding can form the basis of many monophonic phrases. We can transfer the tone-chain of two voices to a single one. Thus No. 49 would give us the following phrase : 50. m ^m We divided the last half-note into eighths and quarter-notes, 73 because the transition from the sixteenth notes to quarter notes would have heen too abrupt and violent. When we now apply our first proceeding to this new basis for melody : i. e., combine the former designs with the octave-designs (as we might call the present ones), we open again a new and in- exhaustible source of formations. Without entering into any further details or gradual development we will give a few as models, and leave it to the student to practice others. Three or four tone-chains in different regions might be treated in the same manner, and give rise to many new designs. But such phrases would partake of such vagueness of character that they could only be used in extraordinary cases, and do not require any special practising. Finally, we might attempt to gain a species of pseudo-dTiophomc composition by means of embellishing or circumscribing the one, or the other. P^^^^fc ^ J 52 ^ Such apparent polyphony will be particularly useful in orches- tral composition and in the accompaniment of vocal music, but will not benefit us much at present. 74 CHAPTER II. THE DUOPHONIC COMPOSITION, DERIVED FROM NATURAL HARMONY. 1. MANNER OF ARRIVINO AT IT. HowEVKE much or little we develope from these octave de- signs, our actual object, a real Duophony, in which each voice has a different fundamental melody, cannot be obtained from them. We require for this another basis showing-us what sounds of two different voices, according to the nature of the tone-world, ac- tually belong together. Let our ear be the first judge of a tone which agrees with an- other ;• say, for instance, with the tonic c. It is certainly not d. But the following, e, answers our purpose. To these, again, we can only add g, and after that none will answer but the octave c. W- What we have here accidentally discovered is fully confirmed by the science of acoustics. The latter tells us that the following sounds belong together : 54. The Tonic is the basis, fandamental tone, of the whole mass. The ear acknowledges in this combination the most perfect con- cord. We will call such tone-mass " Harmony," or " Harmonic mass," and its lowest tone we wUl call the fundamental tone. The above combination is therefore our first harmonic mass. Following the sounds which acoustics designate as the next succeeding, we meet with a sound not exactly belonging to oui 75 scale ; we shall speak of it in future — and immediately aftei- it, a part of the scale makes its appearance. 55. P Of these, c, e, and g belong to the first mass ; d and f, howev- er, do not agree with its fundamental tone. The two latter, exiled as they are from the first mass, unite very well with one tone at least of it — g — and form with it a second harmonic mass. 56. J^ E ^ I Our ear tells us that these belong together, and in the course of our investigations it will be proved in another way. When we now consider our present tone-group "we find : 111 1111 1 1 A — m 57. BE 3= i -&- w^ ^ t3H 2 2 1. That only the five last tones are in the regular succession of the scale ; a and b and the higher c, are wanting ; for the six preceding notes have neither the form nor connec- tion of the scale. 2. That nine notes (those marked 1) belong to the first har- monic mass, but passing all repetitions, the latter consists only of the notes c, e, and g ; the same which our ear has already chosen for us. These notes are placed very reg- ularly — *aoh one a third from the others. The Tonic is the fundamental note. 3. Five other notes (marked 2) form the second harmonic mass, which is not alone inferior in number of sounds con- stituting it, but is also formed less regularly. The fun- damental note of this mass is the thrice-repeated g ; n tone which we have discovered in our first mass. Add- ing to this fundamental tone the highest tone, /, we discov- er the boundary -tones (p. 56) of the scale which move around the Tonic, and of which we know already that they are related to it. • 76 We have long designated the fundamental tone of the first mass by the word Tonic. We will now distinguish the funda- mental tone of the second mass by the word Dominant. The why of calling this tone the Dominant will be shown at some future time. For the present it deserves that name, if for nothing else, at least for the fact that it is the basis of the second mass, and is the junctional point of the two masses. This tone, the " Dominant," is the fifth note of every scale, or in other words, the Tifth of the Tonic Formerly we placed Tonic and Scale m juxtaposition, because the former was the origin of the latter, and was the beginning and end of the scale. Here we find the Tonic again in the same capacity ; but this time it is supported not only by octaves, but by the whole first mass, which latter we shall therefore call " tonical mass," or " tonical harmony." Opposed to this tonical mass we find, now, the second mass, which latter returns to the first, whence it originated. And this is done in the most simple manner. The fundamental note of the second mass goes to that of the first (the tonic) ; if an oc- tave of the dominant is existing it remains as the fifth of the to nical mass ; /proceeds into the nearest tone of the first mass, e, and d can do nothing better than to follow this direction, and, consequently, goes to c. 58. -^-^i=t^ m T r rt r This inclination of the second mass towards the first becomes the most prominent when the tone /is in existence. It is less prominent when the two others only, g, d, are used. For these two form a fifth exactly like one in the first mass (c — g), and can partake, as it were, of the nature of the first mass, and form a momentary point of repose. The same/ as we have seen, is also quite distant from the first harmonic combination which nature has given us (No. 57), and in which the interval of the seventh (^ — /) is not contained. n 2. APPLICATION. \ We can apply our present tone-group. 1. Melodically, for new tone-ohains.* 2. Harmonically in the two masses, and upon the two together we can base the composition of duophonic phrases. Melodic Application. It is not merely the still imperfect scale, c, rf, e,f, g, which can serve as a basis for our melody, but we can also use the succession of all tones belonging to one and the same mass. 59 m ^ r- ^= It is plain that the first mass, on account of its regular con- struction and its number of tones, is much more productive and appropriate for a melodic foundation, than the second mass. But in reality the melody of either mass consists of only three tones, with their repetitions. In No. 59 these masses have been used in their regular order, i. e., either ascending or descending. This leads us to attempt them in vague directions ; for instance, the first mass : 60. Ml ^^ But the limitedness of our tone-group is always in our way, and we find that repetition of tone or design and the development of Rhythm will be necessary to produce variety of invention froir such insufficient means. Harmonic Application. Having achieved thus much, for the proper estimation of our means, nothing remains but to apply them in the formation of duophonic phrases. In this we must consider the upper voice as the principal, and the lower as subordinate voice, or accompani- * Our first foundation for melody was the MajorScale ; here we have dis- covered tine second foundation, the harmony, or the harmonic masses. 78 ment ; for, the higher sounds are, agreeably to their nature, more prominent, and are melodically much better connected (No. 57.). It is therefore our present object to accompany each tone of our tone-chain by a second, lower tone, which agrees with the first, i. e., belongs to the same mass. But since in either mass we have a choice of several notes, we will always choose the nearest for accompaniment ; reserving, however, the right to make excep- tions whenever necessary. Below is the fundamental form of Duophony. 61. M: ^ f?* ei i-j- r ~i^ In the first eight accompaniments we see the alternate change of first and second mass, and after this they belong exclusively to the first mass — though the y at the end might belong also to the second mass. Why at A have we not taken y, the nearest tone, instead of e ? Firstly, because g had but just been used, and the repetition of it would have caused an unnecessary stoppage in the second voice ; secondly, because e in connection with c designate the first mass much more distinctly than the g, which belongs to both masses. The repetition does take place in the very next mo- ment, but then it happens at places where the first mass, under any circumstances, remains stationary, and where it can be done without injuring that change of masses which we had in view. Why have we commenced our accompaniment only with the eighth tone ? Because then only we could safely decide upon it, and because we have made it our principle, always in doubtful cases, to retain that which is undoubted, and from this certainty it was easy afterwards, (from a to the end) to regulate whatever was uncertain. 3. HARMONIC DESIGNS. We recognize now more distinctly what we can ofTert w i'h (uir 79 present material. Until now we have only known two classesi of designs and formations, viz., tonical and rhythmical designs. We can add now a third class, viz., harmonic designs, which we can produce : (a) from the first mass exclusively. (b) from the second mass exclusively. (c) from the alternate use, or from the mixture of the two. 62. -rrr 4. THE CADENCE. We have discovered already that the first mass has taken the place of the Tonic, or the Moment of Repose. The Tonic is the principal tone of this mass, and is most effective in the upper voice. We shall effect our cadences, therefore, with the first mass, and most appropriately in the position of a. 63. ^ r r- --^ T ^ unless we resign the harmony and lead both voices into the Tonic, as at b. We have, further, placed the second mass in juxtaposition to the first ; exactly as we formerly placed Tonic and Scale in jux- taposition ; and as formerly the scale moved into the Tonic to effect an ending (cadence), thus will the second mass move now into the first (c), in order to accomplish the same object. The third tone only is thereby inadmissible, because (d) it would pre- vent the resolving of the upper voice into the Tonic, in order to end there. 5. THE HALF CADENCE. Simultaneously with the former we have, however, discovered that the second mass without its third tone is appropriate to serve as a temporary point of repose. We are, therefore, no longer limited to the single point of repose — the Tonic — but we 80 have a second one, however imperfect, ply in the ending of the thesis, This latter we will ap- 64. i ^ r g and call it a Half-cadence, while the first will be appropriately designated by Whole cadence, Full Cadence, or simply " Cadence." 81 CHAPTER III. THE DUOPHONIC COMPOSmOlf. Now, at last,- we can resume our actual work. It is our ob- ject to form tone-chains of the most perfect form at present known to us — in the form of a Period. First of all, let us regulate our two masses into a Period. 65. E d -f- -& — -■ ^ -=F The beginning with the first mass lies probably nearest. The thesis (a) makes its cadence from the firsj into the second mass. The antithesis (b) makes its cadence from the second mass into the first. The vacant space can be filled out according to the general laws of Tone-succession, Progression, Harmony, and Phraseology which we have learned. And here begins again the practice, and with it the industry of the student. We might fill the thesis with the notes with which it began, 66. m if=x^y-x^x=^- f-r r but that would be insupportable monotony. Therefore we will retain for the present the first mass, but not the -same notes ; perhaps in this manner : 67. E^ S r-i r-r ^ This attempt is an improveriient upon, the first ; but the char- acter of the melody is vague, and the rhythm is very monotonous. We intend to animate the 1 itter, and the melody ought to have 82 a more decided direction, as we have been taught in our first formations of Phrases and Periods. In order, then, to produce again the melodic gradations of thesis and antithesis, we should probably form the following : 68. ^ ; ■--- ^ i^§--^g=^F"=^^~"~' — i-^r-^CTt: Here the thesis ascends, but descends again to make the half cadence more satisfactory. The antithesis takes the opposite direction ; and the Rhythm corresponds with the gradation of the melody. In order to retain the characteristic movement of the tl^esis even in the second voice, we have given to the c of the second voice a ^r as accompaniment. But in the antithesis we find that the second mass is but little appropriate to form a phrase by itself. This leads us now to a mixture of the two masses. The antithesis might be formed in this manner : 69. ^ ::i=^ ^=^ I It would nevertheless consist principally of the second mass, and the first would be merely passing. But with this we have re- turned from the emptiness of what we might call harmonic melodies, to the more closely-connected diatonic tone-succession. The mixture of the two masses offers us, also, new means for the thesis. We need not remain so long in the first mass, we can touch the second: j=T:^,bJT:^Tiir-id=A-^ SSB pF=*i=f=f±afct^ttt=rp±ptf The ascending of the thesis is here already exhausted with the third measure, and the second mass is touched, immediately be- fore the half-cadence. At the same time, by means of rhythmi- cal division, the two first measures of the thesis appear as two separate links; the antithesis, without such links, ends more flowingly. We perceive how the first design originated from 83 No. 68, and is repeated in. the second measure. We perceive, also how the design of the third measure is repeated in the fifth, (at least rhythmically). Were we in possession of the tone b, the melody of the seventh measure would probably be, d, c, b. The further development and practice is left to the student, but he will perceive more and more distinctly, that with our present poverty of tones, a careful employment of rhythm and a clear distribution of it, will lead him to an animated and effective ar- rangement of the whole. Thus No. 68 led to the last phrase, which, again, might lead to the following : Andante. 71. ^^Sfy^i^^gfef We perceive here, that the thesis falls into two sections, of which the first (a) belongs entirely to the first mass, merely touches the second mass, and thus melodically and rhythmically forms an imperfect cadence, because the end note does not fall upon a rhythmical chief-part. The same cadence appears at the end of the phrase ; but this time it is perfect. 84 CHAPTEE IV. COMPOSITIONS OF TWO AM) THREE PAETS.* When we now consider how distinctly, in our previous forma- tions, the thesis separated from the antithesis, by means of entering the second mass on a rhythmical chief-part, and how much more satisfactory a whole it forms, it leads us to form from Thesis and Antithesis, a Jf'irst and Second part, which parts for the present, are distinguished from, a single Period, merely by the even more distant separation, and by the fact that each strives to be considered as a different whole. This leads us, then, to the simplest TWO-PART FORM. of composition, as we find it in many Marches, Songs, Dances, &c. We have formerly already found phrases of a greater number of measures (No. 30). Let us employ them for the two-part form. Each part strives to be an independent whole ; each ought to have, therefore, at least the length of a Period — eight measures. These are the regular dimensions, but we know already that they can be larger or smaller. If the first part is intended to be an independent whole, it ought to have the most perfect form — the form of the Period, with thesis and antithesis. But nevertheless, the part is merely part of a larger whole, and, therefore, cannot have a perfect ca- dence, but must let us expect the second part. It ends, therefore, * We draw the attention of the student to a diatinction which we have made here, and the lack of which, in other theoretical works, has been the source of ranch confusion. We refer to the use of the word " part." If using it in relation to number of voices, we speak of compositions /or one, two, or more parts. _ If using it in relation to Rhythm, or form in general, we speak of compositions of one, two, or more parts. As we advance further we shall employ the words monophonio, duophonic, triphonic, tetraphonie, penta- phonie, &o., &a., to designate compositions for one, two, three, four, five, &c., (fee, parts, and endeavor to ccnfine the word "part" exclusively to Ehythm and form. 85 as formerly the thesis, with a half-oadence. Were we now to end the thesis of the first part in the same manner, the same ending would appear twice in succession ; consequently, the half- cadence of the Part would lose its strength, and the formation of the whole part would be monotonous. The thesis can therefore only be marked by a step from the second into the first mass. This is a full cadence, but in order to make it less important, it is advisable to represent this cadence imperfectly^ — either by trans- position to a former chief-tone (a) or by placing the Tonic into the lower voice (b) or by an insignificant touching of the second mass (c) which leads to the actual cadence. 72. ^^m^^^ If the first part has now become a perfectly-closed phrase, the second part has the same right, only that the latter makes a full and perfect cadence from the second mass into the first. If we in- tend to give to this second part also a perfect thesis, we can do so by means of a half-oadence, which can now be succeeded by the full cadence, without deducting from the strength of either. But this perfect thesis is not absolutely necessary, because the first part has already had so distinct an organization. The plan of a two-part piece wonld therefore be like this : 73. -9-^ — —n- — — -^_ ^^- — — — 1 , ty"^ — ■fd- — — _£2_ ~^=^ — — -CL^ — — -JZ W-^- — — -^- — -e- — — -©-Ll The further practice of this can again be left to the student. But why can the second part continue any longer without in- terruption than the first part, and why is the thesis of the first part a fitter place for Sections than the antithesis % Because at the commencement the contents ought to be given distinctly and decisively, and because in proceeding towards the end, the motion ought to be accelerated, and therefore progress more connectedly. No. 71 would be an example of a two-part phrase, of twice four (instead of twice eight) measures. But we can also go beyond the original dimensions of twice eight measures, and in that case •we would again have to depend upon the rhythm for our means. It become? then our objeot to multiply our tonical meaus, aS it were, by means of rhythmical tone-repetitions, tone-figuration, &c., &c. The following fl: mj3 m ^_p=^fl iW ?^ phrase may serve as example of a first part of three times four measures, which has chiefly made use of tone-repetition. Only the variety of the Ehythm makes such extension possible and bearable. It is easily seen that the first eight measures contain in reality nothing but the steps of the melody, from g up to c, e, and g. It is only a decided and distinct grouping which can make so numerous a tone-repetition comprehensible. We see that the whole phrase falls into sections of three times four measures, a and B, c and d, and e, f, and g. i Judging this phrase according to the acknowledged fundamental form of a periodically-constructed first part, we would have to consider the ending of d as the end of the thesis, and e, f, and a as antithesis. In that case the thesis would have double the length of the antithesis. But its two halves with their subdi- visions are so well separated, and so regular, that exactly in conse- quence of this, no misproportion is experienced in the unequal length of the two parts. In like manner we might prolong the antithesis, by either composing it of equal sections, or, by giving it an Appendix (Coda), «. e., repeating the last section. The fol- lowing little phrase — in which, by the bye, we have not observed the original melodical direction of the thesis, and have made use of a gentle relaxation — may sowp as example. 87 75. m m pii^S^S^ ^m^^^^mw-. The thesis closes at a in the fourth measure. The whole ought/ to close in the eighth measure at b. Instead of this, the voices proceed immediately, without giving the end-note its proper rest, and with the ninth measure begins a repetition of the whole an- tithesis. The final link, merely, might have been repeated ; 76. S a figured re-formation of the repetitions would also have been ad- missible, — finally, the junctiou of the two or more repetitions might also be possible. To favor such Codas, it is advisable to make the preceding cadence imperfect, — either by means of tone-position, or by vari- ation or abridgment of rhythmical quantity ; the latter has been made use of in the above. The oomprehensibility and simplicity of the whole has permitted us to deviate from the strict propor- tions. We have also introduced a kind of " leader" to the Coda. Such Coda, however, premising the good proportions of all parts, is not alone admissible at the end of the antithesis, or sec- ond part, but it can also be employed at the end of a thesis. This requires neither example nor instruction. Retrospection. At the very beginning of monophonic composition we have rep- resented the fundamental form of all tone-formations : Beginning, Progress, End, by Eepose, Tonic, Motion, Scale, Eepose, Tonic. 88 Our monophonic phrases corresponded perfectly 'vrith these ideas. The form of the Period oheyed the same laws. But when we now examine our former (monophonic) Periods, we see that but a feeble tie connected thesis and antithesis. For generally, each was sufficient in itself, because thesis and antithesis led from the Tonic through the scale, back to the Tonic ; and only the ascend- ing or descending direction marked the one or the other. With the aid of the two harmonic masses and the two different cadences we have perfected the periodic form. The fiindamental forms Eepose, Motion, Repose, Tonic, Scale, Tonic, might thus be represented in the harmonic Period : Repose, Motion, Reposei t . r \ Repose, Motion, Repose, Motion, Repose, Tonic, Tonic Scale, Topic 8va. Scale, Tonic. Tonic Mass, Motion, Half-cadence, Motion, Full Cadence. Repose, Motion, Repose. This more perfect periodical construction led us to the two- part form, which again corresponds with the same conceptions and fundamental features — Tonic Mass, Motion, Half Cadence, Motion, Full Cadence. If we represent its external construction of two parts of twice eight measures, with periodical formation of each part into thesis and antithesis : First Part. 8 measures. Thesis, Antithesis. 4 measures. 4 measures. Second Part. 8 measures. Thegis, Antithesis. 4 measures. 4 measures. we find, that the first thesis belongs chiefly to the tonic mass, and ends regularly in the same mass. It is the beginning of the whole tone-development ; therefore the place where the design of the Period, or its designs, are settled ; the moment which we have called Repose. The first antithesis, with the half-cadence of the first part, together with the thesis of the second part, form the Motion. In the antithesis of the second pai-t, the first 89 mass ought now again to be predominant ; but since the foil ca dence of this part is of itself decisive enough, w& need not follow this rule strictly. We have permitted ourselves even to solder, as it "Were, the thesis and antithesis of the second part. If after this the end should still be unsatisfactory, we can prolong it by codas, and thus strengthen the tonic mass. Compositions of Three Parts, The last view we have taken of the two parts in one mass, shows us, that in spite of the separation of the first part by means of a cadence, there are in reality three principal moments in ex- istence. We might therefore easily divide the two parts into three : Repose, Motion, Eepose. First Part. Second Part. Thesis, Antithesis, Thesis, Antithesis. 4 measures. 4 measures. 4 measures. 4 measures. First Part. Second Part. Third Part. 8 measures. 8 or 16 measures. 8 measures Repose. Mc tion. Repose. Here we have again formed a Part from a mere thesis (belong- ing to the first part of a two-part composition), which part can have a thesis and antithesis, and end most properly with a full cadence ; we have given it, .also, double dimensions. The second part begins with the second mass and ends with a half-cadence. The third part is an exact, or similar — a complete or abridged repetition of the first part, ending, probably, with a coda. There is an imperfection in this three-part form : in the full ca- dence of the first part, which in reality is in itself perfectly satis- factory, instead of leading us to expect a continuation. It is of importance that we should clearly comprehend these proportions ; for they guard us against confusion, and direct and facilitate our own invention — exhibiting to us continually the object, and breaking the way to it. When we have once seized a design and do not lose sight of these proportions, a safe progress will never be wanting. On the contrary, we shall rather see too many ways, and require quick decision and determination to 'ireak through our hindering doubts. 90 CHAPTEK V. THE DOUBLE DTJOPHONIC COMPOSmOir. We cannot, with our natural notes as means, extend the due phonic composition any further, without falling into undue repe tition and losing sight of perspicuity. We can conclude this from the fact that we have only two masses, and only two essentially different cadences, which latter had to he repeated once already in a composition of merely two parts ; when with codas, still oflener. We experienced this imperfection in the three part form, and in stni more extended forms there woidd certainly be too much repetition. But the question is ; whether we could not obtain an intrinsic increase of onr means ? As soon as we add new notes, our pres-' ent system will no longer be suflBcient. Such acquisition re- mains, therefore, for a later chapter. For the present we have nothing but the increase of the mimber cf voices. Since the two voices which we have used until now agree so well with each other, the double duophonic composition seems to be much more convenient than the trlphonic. But in order to double our voices without confusioii, we will give to each of them a different tone-region. Here, then, are our present means • 77. r i ^^^ J. .d. e ^m f^ What do we gain by it 1 First of all, a larger and broader volume of tone, if our voice-couples move in paraUel directions. This certainly makes our whole tone-mass less susceptible of light motion, and besides this, we h^ve gained nothing absolntely new ; 91 for the two couples move in equal intervals and direction ; but this leads us to attempt 1, opposite directions, 2, different intervals of the volce-oouples. "Wherever the masses change regularly, our voice-couples can unhesitatingly move in opposite directions. 78. m ^8 u tmm frf ^? We will call this kind of motion. Contrary/ Motion.^' This and the former application of the double duophonio man- ner are the most natural, because they are based upon the gen- erally most natural form of accompaniment (No. 61) of the duo- phonio composition. In sincfle instances, however, the two voice- couples might combine together in arbitrary intervals. 79. P - i s - i — * — ^ — 4 1=r ei=F m Since we have further discovered that the fundamental note of the second mass belongs to the first, two voices might sustain this mutual tone in various manners, while the others might move in the two masses at pleasure. We will call such tones, which continue throughout the move- ment of the other voices, " Sustaining tones" for they give to the whole tone-movement a material and bodily connection. But since all our tones and masses originate in the Tonic, we can bodily realize this intellectual unity by leading our upper 92 voices through the two masses and their different intervals, while the lower voices sustain the mutual fundamental tone, " the Tonic." 81. These sustaining-tones can be animated by rhy thmization of va- rious kinds, which either strengthens the rhythm of other voices, or enters into a juxtaposition to it ; remaining stationary where the other moves, or moving where the other remains stationary. m mu Ld I L=rrLd ri &|-^-^ > 'Hi> 8v'a . . . \J ^^ When we add to these new formations : 1. The doubled voices (No. 77). 2. The contrary motion (No. 78). 3. The arbitrarily-composed masses (No. 79), and, 4. The sustaining^iotes (Nos. 80 and 81) — the double duo- phonic and the single duophonic compost, we have our whole material before us. It gives us a new juxtaposition of greater and lesser mass, and with it a third class of gradation, which until now could only ob- tain by the direction of tone-succession, and by the rhythm. In this new juxtaposition we find, also, the means of more character- istically representing the more animated or light, and the more firm or heavier character, than by mere rhythmical accent. But even our former means of gradation find a new sphere in the as- cending of our voice-couples. 83. 93 Tliese are the nearest formations of the double duophonio com- position ; they give sufficient material for the exercise of the fun- damental forms of all musical construction. They only require a few directions in regard to Application. Formerly we had only two voices at our command, which we never separated, in order to have always Harmony. We have now twice two voices, but can get along with a single voice-couple, out of which we gained the just-mentioned juxtaposition. But it is advisable that we employ our means in a clear order, and ac- cording to a consistent plan. The former requires that we do not arbitrarily cause the be- ginning and ceasing of a voice-couple, but rather follow the idea of the whole, as we have seen it indicated in our rhythmical con- struction. The change, therefore, ought invariably to take place at a rhythmical section, as in No. 83, or at least with a rhythmi- cal link, as in No. 82, The consistency permits no general rule ; it can only arise from the contents of every phrase. With the following Part begins a series of analyzations and exercises which will exclude, for a time at least, all free forma- tion. But we advise the student to keep up the practice of the duophonic, or double duophonic composition, in order to preserve the susceptibility of his mind to melody and rhythm, which will have their turn in future. 94 Third Part. The Harmony of ike Major Scale. However diversified our tone-world has been thus far devei oped, we can clearly see the insuificiency of everything discov ered. At first we had the complete diatonic scale, with the license, even, of admitting foreign tones, but we could only move in it monophonically. Afterwards we gained the harmonic mass- es, and the possibility of combining simultaneously two or four voice-parts ; but they were insuificient for the complete scale. The next step is obvious : We must learn to use the complete scale in the polyphonous combination of the harmonic masses. We resume at once, therefore, the polyphonous composition, and begin with the Tetraphonic composition. CHAPTER I. DISCOVERY OF THE NECESSAET HARMONIES. OnR first object is now to find harmonies for the complete scale. Here we are directed at once to the first hannonic mass, the importance and regularity of which we have already seen. This regularity consists in the position of its three tones (c, e, g), which are placed in thirds, one above the other. The combination of three or more tones to a Harmony is called a " Chord." The lowest tone in such chord (c) is called " Fundamental tone." It is the most important tone of the chord, because it serves as basis for the whole construction. Therefore the proportions of 95 tlie other tones of the chord are regulated and designated by it. The next note (e) is called the " Third" and the next one is called the " Fifth" i. «., of the fundamental tone. Already in No. 79 we have perceived that the tones of a, chord do not always appear in their original position. Tlie very fu-st mass showed itself in No. 54 in the following manner : first the fundamental note, then the Octave, then the Fifth, then again the Octave, and after that only came the Third, and again the Fifth. Doubling of the Chord-tones. At the same time we see that every note of the chord can be applied more than once ; either in different octaves (as in No. 54), or (as can easily be imagined) by different voices on the same place. Both proceedings are called '■'■Doubling" of the chord- notes. We shall require this doubling of chord notes immediately • for we intend to write tetraphonic, and have but three tones in the chord. Which of these three- tones shall now be doubled 1 We are at liberty to double either, and shall make use of this license. But, if no other reason prevent us, we shall double the fundamental tone first, because it is the most important tone of the chord, and Nature itself has used it oftenest (No. 54). After this we shall double the Fifth, because it appeared originally twice. The Third, which originally appears but once, is the least appropriate to be doubled. We have based this rule upon imitation of our natural formation. Our ear confirms this as the most beautiful and reg- ular concord, and the Third as the most piercing and perspicuous interval of the chord, which in doubling, for instance, 84. i r r easily drowns the other intervals. Transposition of the Chord Tones. We have already seen that the tones of a chord appear by no means always in their regular position., In No. 79 we have even voluntarily resigned it. But these transpositions require, for the 96 present, no particular consideration. We will now place our tones as near as possible to the upper voice, unless particular reasons lead us to a different formation ; but the fundamental tone shall always retain its original position as the lowest tone, be- cause it is always the basis of the chord, and by it we can easiest recognize and designate the chord. But since we can place all our other tones at pleasure, the Octave, Third, or Fifth are placed occasionally in the upper voice. 85. r r r -F '- — T T / ^ rj \ HT ^^ fD '—' \\ ) .-, o ■=< v^ 1 fj -o- O -^ s- ' \' "TS ! t }. a o G. J We will call these different placements of the Harmony, " the position of the chord.'''' Thus much of the first harmonic mass. The second harmonic mass contains also three tones, but not in regular succession ; it can, therefore, in its present form, give us no chwd. Let us now see what application this one chord permits us, to which tones of the scale it can be used as harmonic. 86. Only to those tones which are contained in it : to c, e, g, and c. We place the fundamental tone always on the lowest place, and the other tones as near as possible to the upper voice ; thus doubling the fundamental tone always by its octave. Where do we find new harmonies for the other tones of the scale ? Let us return to our second mass. This second mass was not 3s regular as the first, yet we have already used it as a first mass, viz. : in the half-cadence of a thesis, or a first part, by leaving out its third tone. We will add now to that formation ((/, d) a Third, viz., h, which exists under any circumstances in our present material — the Scale — and we have a regular chord of three tones, g, h, d, resembling that of the first mass, and assisting js to accompany again a part of the scale. 97 -f . - tfl" , s !s2:_ ■ O tj -l9- 25 £2 -^- S3 S7 ^■ O m 1 ri- 1 1 — ©— — ©— 1 87. Here, too, we have placed our chord tones as near as possible to the upper voice. The same chord naight also have accompanied the fifth tone of the scale, if this tone had not already received a chord of the first mass as accompaniment. F and A are now the only unaccompa- nied tones remaining. Let us merely attempt an accompaniment as we did in the discovery of the second harmonic mass. We unite /and a, and add to it the third tone, c, and thus gain a third chord, which is formed like the former chords, and can serve us as accompaniment to the tones / and a of the scale. 9- , -. — --, o , y in ^^ 1 a o %J -&- o -&- -&■ ^• «~" 1 r>- - 1 1 1- 1 We might also use this chord as accompaniment of the first tone, c, if it had not been occupied already by the first chord. We have now achieved our nearest object : all the tones of the scale are provided with harmony. 89. Before we enter, however, any further upon these results, we must examine our three chords more closely. It is still the ques- tion whether the chords g-l-d and /a-c, are as apt and useful as the chord of the first mass. The three chords are exactly alike in all their proportions. They consist each of three tones : the fundamental tone, its third. A - 1 / % ^ (J \ (l ^ __c g V ) (O ^a fj -&- IS -^ -&- "' -©- a t\. o ^a 22 ^~ a ti. o ^^ o a a. a ^ s 1 — 98 and its fifth. The third in each is a major third, and the fifth in each is a perfect fifth, Tlte chords on /and ff are therefore per- fectly like the one on «. But we know already, from the Introduction, that we can buUd a major scale upon every tone of our whole system, and that all major scales have like proportions. Consequently the chords upon the Tonic of every major scale must be exactly alike. We can therefore find our chords /a-c, and g-b-d on the Tonic of i''and G major, though they are also domesticated, as it were, in C ma- jor. We can consider these two- chords as reminiscences of i^ and G major, or as borrowed from those keys. These keys stand to the one in which we actually are (C major) in the first degree of relationship*; and thus we come to the conviction that the harmony of the major scale consists of the tonic chord of the same, and of the tonic chords of the two nearest related- major scales. Therefore : as every major scale has its nearest related major scales on the nearest fifth above and below the Tonic ; thus has each major scale , also, besides its own tonic chords, the tonic chords of the nearest related major scales within it. This double point of view which we have taken of our second and third chords : 1, as harmonies constructed from domestic tones (tones be- longing to the scale) ; 2, as Tonic chords of the two nearest related major scales,, which we have borrowed from these, and which remind us of them ; will, in future, be of the greatest importance. We must compre- hend it clearly, therefore, and retain it. * Nearest related or related in the first degree, are stioh major keys as d-mate in but one tone from each other. major and Cf major ; for in- stance: 1^ 0, d, e, f, g, a, b, c. Cf, a, b, c, d, e, /j), g. differ from each other merely in the / and/{(. major and jP major : c, d, e, f, g, a, b, c. f,g,a, bh, c, d, e, f, are distinguished merely by one b, consequently they are nearest related. In the quint-circle, Gb, Ih, Ah, M, Bb, P, O, 1 J — 101 take into consideration the harmonic designs which we have dis- covered thus far. There are two : A, the progression from one position of a chord to another ; B, tire combination of two chords which stand to eacli other in the relation of tonic and dominant harmonies. 91. nm rTfT^ r The cliords of the Dominant and the Subdominant (/) have no connection with each other. This cannot well be otherwise, for we know that these two chords have been borrowed from keys which, though each related to the principal key, C, have no connection with each other, D. — Faulty Progressions. Examining the deficient progression from the sixth to the sev- enth degree, we find still more undesirable proportions. 1. OCTAVE-SUCCESSION". Firstly : each of our four voices takes throughout an independ ent path ; in the -beginning, the first goes from c to <^ and e ; the second from g to b and c ; the third from e to g, which latter is repeated ; the fourth goes from c to g, and back to c. Only from the sixth to the seventh degree, bass and alto proceed from / to g. 92. m Ht The alto says nothing different from the bass. Neither is it a mere doubling or strengthening, as we have seen it in our first attempts at duophonic composition (No. 49) ; for it is right in the midst of the other parts, and, like them, claims to be a separate voice. In this very ambiguity lies the fiiult ; the alto is neither 102 a separate voice nor a mere doubling, as, for instance, in the fol- lowing : 93. W: BE r r r Progressions like those of alto and bass in No. 92, are called false oT consecutive octaves ; they give to the phrase an ambigu- ous appearance, sound hollow from the tone-web, and rob it of its full variety of voices. For the present we will absolutely avoid them, though the time will come when we learn to make the right use of them. But how can we obviate the consecutive octaves in No. 92 ? The bass was indispensable : we had for a and b no other har- inonies than the chords of/ and ff. The fault, then, lies in the alto, because the alto, Hke the bass, proceeds from /to g ; this must not be. We now remember that the chord ff-b-d, is in reality nothing else than our former second mass, g-d-f. We might therefore retain the /of the first chord in the second chord; 94. Tlae alto progresses no longer in octaves with the bass, and these two chords have now a mutual connecting-note, / (7f= ^^ — ¥^ — t. ^ Y tf~ U. u r)— — « — C2 1- — 2. QUINT OB FIPTH-SUCCESSION (cONSBCUTIVB riFTHS.) But there is another misproportion in this place. Two voices progress simultaneously in fifths, i. e., make consecutive fifths. We see that tenor and bass form a fifth in the first chord, as well as in the second, and we experience from it the same hollowness of sound which we discovered in the consecutive octaves. This mis- 103 proportion is particularly obnoxions wlieii it is unhidden by other voices ; as, for instance, in No. 94, with alto or treble left out. In future we shall find these successions sometimes admissible ; for the present we will avoid them. In the above case the fault consists in the progression of bass and tenor. The bass goes from y to g, while the tenor goes from c to d. In the octaves we avoided tliis fault by letting the first note of the tenor remain ; here, it is clear that the c cannot remain, for it forms no part of the succeed- ing harmony. But if it can neither ascend nor remain, it must ab- solutely go down into the nearest note of the next harmony (J). But the note d is now wantmg ! let us distribute, therefore, the time-space of the chord between h and d. 95. w -JSZ ei -^A We have now avoided the fifths, and gained, besides, the com- plete harmony. The former we have gained by contrary motion, the latter has given us opportunity to give to one voice two notes of the same chord, and thus to obtain greater animation. We will call such notes, which enter after the other notes of a chord, " harmonic bye-notes.'''' There are many other ways of obviating the above difficulty, as, for instance, at a and b ; 96. m s f^^^g - :^-. ^ but for the present we will adopt the one illustrated in No. 95, because it is within bounds of our present knowledge. E. — The Dominant Chord. This has involuntarily led us to a new chord, consisting o?fov.r 104 notes ; ff, b, d, f. The fdurth note is the seventh of the funda- mental tone. We -will call our former chords, consisting of three Botes, " Triads," of which we have at present three ; viz., Triad of the Tonic, c-e-ff ; " " Dominant, g-i-d ; " " Subdominant, f-a-c. The chords of four notes will he called chords of the Seventh, or "Septime chords," because the added seventh distinguishes them from the triads. The one we have just now discovered upon the Dommant, will be of special importance, and to distin- guish it from others, less important, we will call it the '■^■Dominant Chord:' This Dominant Chord requires a more particular explanation. 1. It exists on the Dominant of each key, and at no other place. 2. The dominant chord of each key exists in no other key Consequently, this chord is the one which most distinctly marks a key. Thus the chord g-h-d-f, indicates at once the key of C. In the key of i''it would be c-e-g-b\t, in the key of G it would be d-f'^-a-c. 3. This chord reminds us of the second mass, and with it, the Tonic and the around-it-moving scale. It is the completion of that which was merely indicated in former formations : Q, a, b, C, d, e, F. O, I),-F. G, — B, — B,— F. Its destination is ; to resolve into, the first mass, and all its notes follow this current. Its fundamental note goes to the Tonic, its third leads to the Tonic ; its seventh leads towards the Tonic, and enters upon the note of the tonic harmony in its way ; 97. its fifth goes most naturally to the Tonic, though the tonic third is quite as near. But we prefer the^ former, because we do not 105 like to double the third. No. 98 a is therefore better than No. 98 B. 9a W: ^ This proceeding of the dominant chord is called its " resolution,'" and of any chord that absolutely draws after it another harmony , we say, " it resolves into" such chord or harmony. With this we have at last accomplished the faultless harmoni- zing of the scale. 99. It is a natural consequence of the regular resolution of the dom- inant chord, that the last chord remains incomplete ; it lacks the fifth. We will submit, for the present, to this imperfection ; it is not disagreeable, and will soon be justified or avoided. It seems, further, as if there were now no connection between the two last chords, g-b-d-f and c-e, they have in No. 99 no mu- tual tone. But this is only because the last chord was incom- plete; the connective-tone i^g) exists, but we have not been able to introduce it, because each of our voices had to follow a certain prescribed direction. — j 9 — ^ ^-^ f^ li i_ __ c? T: r - fD o fD „ fJ -&- o -&- -e- s- -&- A ^ '&- Bt-S- _!2_ _Q g —& — o o^g_ (^ f^ rO — — © — J F. — Tlie Triad of the Dominant submitting to the rules of the Dominant Chord. We have given, above, the most natural progressions of the dominant chord. Their current, and particularly that of the third, is so strong, that it actually drags the dominant-triad along with it. Whenever the latter is succeeded by the tonic triad, we pre- fer leading the third up into the Tonic (a) to leading it down into some other tone (b). 106 100. ii ":22r" ^ ^- 1=5 T 1 We involuntarily consider the dominant triad as dominant chord, and, feel in a. degree the effects of the seventh, though it is not heard. We have the same sensation when the tonic triad with its third as the highest note goes into the Subdominant triad (c). An exception will illustrate this rule still better. Handel often leads the third of the dominant triad downwards ; for in- stance, in a chorus from -" Israel in Egypt :" 101. ^S ^■ -4-W^ ■-U4- ^^^ ^aiiii rr" f- f- and thus obtains a strange, piercing expression, which makes it perceptible that he departs from the natural way. This is by no means the only instance of great masters deviating from any given rules. Music as an art would be fettered indeed if her de- votees were confined to the rules laid down for the guidance of the student. The master knows well when a deviation is admis- sible or inadmissible ; and his taste and intelligence are the only judges whom he has to consult. Thus can we see numerous illus- trations of the above in the works of Haydn, Mozart, Beethoven, Mendelssohn Bartholdy, and a hundred others. But they are the masters ; we, the students, tnie to our principle, without calling this deviation wrong, wiU at present abstain from using it. 107 CHAPTEE III. THE ACCOMPANIMENT OF GIVEN MELODIES. A. — Limitation to those means which were found in the Ascending Scale. Our melodies, for the present, will have to be very simple and contain the notes of but one major scale. To each note of the melody we give that chord which we have found for it in No. 89, viz., to the first, third, and fifth tones of the scale we shall always give the tonic triad ; to the second and seventh that of the dominant ; and to the fourth and sixth the triad of the sub- dominant. But when the sixth note is succeeded by the seventh, we shall avoid the threatening faults by the introduction of the dominant chord. In order to facilitate the finding of the chords, we shall indicate by figures how far below the fundamental note of the chord is to be found. We have seen in Nos. 89 and 99, that the Tonic has for a fundamental note the lower octave, and mark it therefore by 8, above the melody. The second note of the scale {d ) has its fundamental notes five degrees below ; we mark it by 5. Ac- cording to this proceeding the scale of G major would be marked thus : 102.^ IS2Z tj -a- ^ - We see that the figures 8, 5, 3 are regularly repeated, with the exception of the sixth and seventh degrees, which are both marked by 3. It is the same point where we have discovered the differ ent misproportions iji the progressions of our chords. We will, for the present, mark it by f, in order to remember the avoiding of consecutive octaves and fifths, and the strengthening of the con- nection. 108 After this we find and place the fundamental notes, and then the middle voices. As example we give the following : This melody : 5 3+3 83 5 83 55 3 + 3 8 ^ 3 3 zai -&—e>- has fii-st been provided with figures. We have also remembered the dangers by placing a f where we are likely to encounter them. Then we write the fundamental tones ; 104. -e- -e- -G- ' V 1 1 n ^ ^ o »i./i 1 1 ^^ 1 I / r. r. _i^ ^- 1 Why does the bass in the first measure descend an octave in- stead of remaining on the same c? Partly in order to animate the somewhat monotonous movement of the whole, and partly in order to obtain a more decisive direction from the lower c, past / and r^ O '3^ fo o / ^ ^ n (n ^ o o (( Y ft ro ® .«- _— ^ -«- o tL Each design can he the germ of greater formations. The com- bination of the tonic and dominant triads, for instance (119), can be continued through all positions ; it can be repeated ; it presents to us the appearance of two triads whose fundamental tones are a fourth distant from each other. Are there not other triads of this kind ? We will attempt it ascending (i.) or descending (b), 1 as we have already done in No. 136. Let us continue each de- sign through all positions, and it will make us more at home in our harmonic means. The number of such designs is great, and the practice recommended of the greatest use in our future exer- cises. * TVe must remark that here, and in most of the following illustrations ■we have contracted our examples on one stave, thus impairing their effect. But the pupil should practice and write them with lower basses, or in lower tone-regions, and double the former; for instance, instead of No. 138 he should write thus : 139. O ^ -e- V r^ O S S 1 f^ n n A ^ rs » 1 &< ^ S r-> r~i ^-^ (dV <-^ ^ 1 \\) \ CJ ^ c^ e & e i) ^ a a d o o '- o. a -^ / \. ir> 1 a (5 € J. rj r^ f13 (n <^ 1 r^ ^ -—&- o 1 S L _ -&- 122 CHAPTER II. THE FREER HARMONIZATION OF GIVEN MELODIES. We have formerly said that the third, fifth, octave, or seventh of any chord can be laid in the upper voice. Let us now reverse it, and say that Each tone of a melody can be either thirdj' fifth, octave, or sev- enth of a chord. Until now we have had a choice of harmony for but two de- grees. In descending the scale, for instance, C major, we could take for b the triad of either g ot e ; or for a the triads of eithei /or a (108 and 110). But it is our object now to choose oui chords. In order to secure safety -we will divide our material. A. — Freer use of the Triads. We ascertain first of every tone of the scale whether it can be third, fiilh, or octave of any of our triads. The first tone, C, can be : 1. Octave ; in that case the fundamental tone would be c, and the chord would be c-e-g. 2. Third; in that case we have to seek the fundamental tone three degrees below. This would make it a, and the chord would be a-c-e. 3. Fifth ; we have now to seek the fundamental tone five degrees below ; consequently it isf, and the chord /a-c. Thus we can take to C, which was formerly always accompa uied by c-e-g, three different chords. 140. m ^ ^ The second tone, d, can be 1. Octave ; which would make the chord d-f-a. 2. Fifth ; and the chord would be g-b-d. 123 We camiot consider it as Third, because tMs would give us the fundamental tone b, and the chord i-d-f. But until now we have had no such chord, for all our chords have major fifths, while this has a minor fifth. A continued examination gives us the entire tones of the scale, with their respective harmonies at present known to us. 141. ^S W-. BE: Each tone has received three chords as accompaniment. D only could not be used as third, nor /as fifth, nor b as fundamental note, because this would have given us the chord b-d-f, which, for the present, we.do not know. Accidentally, this phrase, gives us a new design. We see at a four, at B and c six triads whose fimdamental tones form a design like the following : CI '^V 1 r~F r ■?'»'• J 1 r ^ J , • J r * J 1 — =^=^ -4^-^ L_i 1 Li_l4_JL But to return to our work. Let us attempt the second, kind of harmonization. We are no longer tied to those chords which were formerly indicated by figures above the melody, but at ev- ery note we asR : " what chord agrees with it ?" But with every chord we introduce we have to ascertain wheth- er in relation with the preceding or succeeding chords it does not cause faulty progressions. It will be best to write now every chord at once complete, in order to have the progression of every single voice in view. We will also, as much as possible, give the same notes to the same voice if they shonld happen to occur in two successive chords ; whUe we shall give every new tone to that voice which can reach it most conveniently. 1?4 By this the movement of our voices will be surer and more quiet. The advantage of this new mode of treatment is most percep- tible in those melodies in which many tone-repetitions occur. These (as in a) cause repetitions of chords, and make the accom- paniment monotonous, whUe the new mode (b) gives variety to it. Below we give some melodies on which this new mode can be practiced. 144. n m m . f"i 1 ■ ) i\ . » f r T1^ ^ f « / '> PPP p 1 1 i ' 1 ' J J -«-PCC ' r ■ .f2- .. {{ v-f r r 1 \ 1 i mJL V\\ 1 1 lU 4- _ _ _ 1 1 1 i i _ v^A-r|.|.|_ ,. 145. - ") , \>ft » -«-*«- - 1 — _ .. 11 ' 1 [ '({ \ Y \ 1 ' d^ 4?-ff P^ :^ ■' VU 4- 1 1 T ^ 1 1 h ■- 146. n'ift , > • - . ■ ^W'> a • wr fj 1 ' ^ 9 1 ■ / »*' J 1 ^ -ffJ—U I 1 ^t«. ^ «^ ii \ ''f A s r ' 1 t t « ^ 1 ± "' VU 4- 1 - 1 ■ -ii_r But the student's object ought not to be so much to intro- duce as many chords as possible, as to avoid troublesome repetition. He should first think of the neairest-related chords. After this, such successions as carry a harmonic or melodic dc- 125 sign consistently through, deserve the most consideration; for instance, 147. ^N^ -f- m g e; -j—j- Finally, he must take particular care that these novelties do not destroy the forms of phrases or periods. '- In this respect we know " that every phrase and every period has to end with a perfect full cadence ; for instance, in C major, with 148.^ ^^ ^S= ^^^^-^ r , r further : that every thesis has to end with a half-cadence, like or perhaps | 149. M: -&- or with 150. W- --^z. -J C3 g -&&-^ These rules must still be respected, and in No. 143 we find them attended to in a as well as in b. After the harmonization is thus completed, it will be well to ascertain whether, with the introduction of the new chords, faulty progressions have not found their way into it, and after this, the whole should be played through. B. — The free introduction of the Dominant Chord. But little remains to be said. Like every triad, the dominant 126 chord can be used for every note contained in it ; but care naust be taken not to cause faulty progressions by it. We know that the dominant chord must resolve into the tonic triad ; that the third ascends one step, and that the seventh de- scends one step. We can therefore introduce it only -where all these conditions can be fulfilled. Thus it would be wrong, in the following phrase, to consider the h of the first measure as third, or the /of the second measure as seventh, or the g of the third measure as octave of the dominant chord. 151. ^ BE r .^ Let us now attempt another haiTQonization of No. 111. 152. The three chords at a have little or no connection ; they have only been selected in order to have the dominant chord succeed the triad of d. The two are related through d and/; at e we see it succeed the triad of the subdominant, with which it is related through/. At c it is introduced to d. The melody ascends from d to e, and the seventh of the dominant chord descends to e. Thus the succeeding triad has two thirds which are very perspic- uous, and lacks the fifth. The latter is not of much importance, and against the double third we have at present no help. We could have avoided this if it had not been our object to introduce the dominant chord as often as possible. At d we see the advan- tage of our new principle. We have not placed the middle voi- ces in closest proximity to the upper voice, but have preferred to give them the nearest interval of the next chord, because the for- 127 mer proceeding would have caused an inconvenient progression of the voices (a). 153.; B^ ■Mski r r r 'I " r Still more convenient would have been the progression of b, though by it we should have lost the fifth of the dominant chord. Thus much of the dominant chord. We will make it a rule to effect our full cadence by it. M-eer treatment of the Dominant Chord. Until now we have always treated the dominant chord strictly according to rule. The consequence was, that the tonic triad after it, invariably lost the fifth. Now, when we have to use it more frequently, and particularly for our cadences, we can permit some slight, imperceptible deviations from our rules. Formerly we have insisted upon the seventh descending one step; we will now occasionally permit ourselves (particularly when the seventh is in one of the middle voices, and another voice takes the tone into which the seventh ought to resolve), to let the seventh ascend. 154. m m r Here the seventh,/, goes to g, but the tenor has the e which ought to have succeeded the seventh in the alto ; this deviation, however, is hidden, and we have gained by it a complete final cho;-d. , The third ascends one degree. Here we see it descend two degrees ; 155. m but the tone c, into which the third would have led, is alreadv 128 taken by the treble, and we gain, by this slight deviation, the completeness of the second chord. 156. E ^^ 4= r T r r 1 r I T This deviation, however, is not so admissible when the tone into which an interval of the dominant chord properly resolves lies not alone in another voice, but in another octave also. 157. i 4 r Here the seventh in a middle voice ascends also. But the de- viation is not hidden, because the voices are too far apart, and the e which we expect in the alto is given to another octave. DOUBLING OF INTERVALS IN THE DOMINANT CHORD. The intervals of the dominant chord most proper for doubling are, 1, the fundamental tone, and 2, the fifth ; but, the third and seventh cannot be doubled without falling into faulty progressions. For we know that both intervals have a regular progression ; the third ascends a degree, the seventh des- cends a degree. , If, now, two voices take the third or seventh, both will have to resolve in octaves (or unison). 158. unless we proceed against the nature of the chord and have it thus : 129 n i -0- -,,-n ' '-' ■■'? 159 7 r5 iuc. ./ , a \U, n -s- We have to mention here a relation which, in the old school, has created much confusion and trouble. We refer to the pro- gressions which as COVBKED FIFTHS COVBBED OCTAVES, &C., were more or less strictly forbidden. Two voices can progress in such manner, that without actually making consecutive fifths or octaves, they stiU produce the same effect ; for instance. ■&- 31221 _£Si ■ss-e- =§=EE "='^^ 3!: ^3= ^ It is undeniable that at a, b, b, and c, the fifths '/— c, d — a, and c — g are somewhat conspicuous ; likewise at d and f the octaves f—f, and e — e. Whenever such fifths or octaves appeared in voices which pro- ceeded in the same direction, they were called "covered fifths or octaves," and the misfortune was said to consist in the fact, that the faults were not in those tones which were actually bounded, but in those which were merely passed. The above instances would be understood in this mamier : — i _^_ -&- ±t *ii zssr. * "ST" r it was said that (a) not the sounded note d with h made the fifth, but the tone «, which is between d and/, and which, though not audible, could be imagined. If the voices led in opposite directions to a fifth or octave, as at E and f, the above explanation would not answer, and another name was invented. 5 130 Here was material enough to puzzle the student with the ques'-' tion if all, or any, and which of these cases were allowed or for- bidden : for some of these successions occur in the most simple and indispensable progressions of harmony ; for instance, ia the natural harmonies and the necessary cadences. E ~s> -f- t- nr- ■sy r^ making it absolutely impossible to write a harmonic phrase with- out such progressions. But with the same right they might, under similar cireimistan- ces, have forbidden the use of thirds, sixths,^ and sevenths, which can also become very conspicuous ; for iastance. P ^ -&- ^ ^- -00--^ This very fact, leads us to the solution of the whole question. Such progressions are only conspicuous and disagreeable when they occur between unconnected chords, or when they are caused by unmelodious, unnatural progressing of one or more voices : when a voice instead of the nearest interval takes a more distant one of the next chord. Under such circumstances every interval becomes conspicuous. 131 Fifth Part. The Inversion of Chords. Until now we have principally thought of the discovery and connection of chords, while we have paid hut little attention to the melodious progression of every single voice. We placed the middle voices as near as possible to the upper voice ; but already in No. 143 we have deviated from this rule by giving to a voice that interval of the next chord which was nearest to it. Our bass always seemed the least flowing and most unman- ageable, because we had nothing but the fundamental notes of our harmonies to give to it. In order to obviate this awkwardness we will now extend the same privilege to the bass which we have given to the upper voices ; we will take third, fifth, or seventh of a chord in the bass, while we give the fundamental note, or rather its octave, to an- other voice. This proceeding does, not of course, influence the character of the chord. It is a mere exchange of one or more intervals of one and the same chord, and has assisted us already in developing our melodic element of the upper voices. Such chord, the fundamental tone of which has been transposed to another voice, is called an inverted chord, and the proceeding is called inversion. In juxtaposition to the inverted chords we will call the uninverted ones '■'■fundamental chords." 132 CHAPTER I. ENUMEEATION AHD APPELLATION OF THE INVERSIONS. When a fundamental tone leaves its place, another tone of the chord has to hecome the lowest. But it becomes only hwest tone, not fundamental tone ; for jundamental tone we only called that one which in the original construction (by thirds), was the lowest. This one remains the fundamental tone, whether it be above, be- low, or in the middle. There are as many inversions as (besides the fundamental tone) there are tones in the chord ; consequently every triad has two, and every septime chord three inversions. 1. 2. 1. 2. 3. ^^■W=W E^ -^ P ^TlT F These inverted chords are so important, that they have re- ceived particular names. Thus the first inversion of a triad is called the chord of the sixth, or Sext chord as we shall call it for brevity's sake. It has received this name, because the most im- portant notes of it, the third and fundamental note, form now the interval of a sixth. The second inversion of a triad is called the chord of the fourth and sixth, or Quart-sext chord, as we shall call it. In the dominant chord the fundamental tone is again the most important tone, but next to it in importance is the seventh. Con- sequently the position of these two tones gives the name to the inversions of the chord. Thus the first inversion, with the origi- nal third in the bass, is called chord of the fifth and sixth, or Quint-sext chord, as we shall call it. The second inversion is called the chord of the third and fourth, Terz-quart chord. The third inversion, in which the seventh itself is in the bass, we count the intervals from the latter, and call it the chord of the second, or Secunda chord. * See Appendix A. f See Appendix B. 133 The names thus obtained are not influenced by any change of position in the upper voices. The two first chords of the follow- ing are both called sext-chords, and the others are all called terz- quart chords. ""W f-^-T— f=7 This addition to our chords, though of great advantage, gives us no new difficulty. For all inverted chords follow the same rules which govern the original and fundamental chords. Thus when we said of the dominant chord, that its third ascends one step, and that its fifth descends or ascends one step ; the same rules still hold good in the different inversions. 3 J- M 162. ^ »=* ¥ rr r r r n=f' There is but one thing which might appear strange to us. Why, in the above, for instance, does the fundamental tone g re main instead of going to the Tonic, according to the original rule ? Because we consider it as octave of the fundamental tone, and its progression is prevented by the surro\mding voices. Besides this the Tonic is otherwise represented." If the position of the other voices permits it, we can still go from the fundamental tone of the dominant chord to the Tonic. J- 163. m ^ r though this proceeding is always most proper when done in the lowest voice. When we analyze the effects of these inversions, we find that by them the chords are taken from their original position, from their proper and firm foundation, and that they lose their natural clearness and security in the same degree as we increase the dis- 134 tance of the lowest note from the fundamental tone. But ia the same degree they partake of a mobility which is foreign to the original chords. Therefore the sext and quart-sext chords are not fit to be final chords. The latter particularly brings the tonic triad in so strange a position, that we wiU only employ it when we are led to it by the drift of the bass, or when we have particular reasons for it, of which we shall learn some in future. For the same reason neither quint-sext chord, nor terz-quart chord, nor secunda chord, are fit to prepare the end. Though they all must resolve into the Tonic, the strength of the step from fundamental tone to fundamental tone in the bass is wanting ; some even forbid the Tonic in the upper and lower voices. NECESSITY OF A DIFFERENT FIGURING. Before we return to our practice, we must take a precautionary measure which becomes particularly necessary on account of the inverted chords. As long as we placed every chord there where our first attempts at harmony made it necessary, we could hardly speak of a choice of chords. But we have not merely the choice of diiferent triads for every tone of the melody, but we can also introduce the dom- inant chord arbitrarily, and in addition to this we have the inver- sions. It is clear that the figures which we formerly placed above the melody are no longer sufficient. We require now a diflferent kind of signs which remind us what chords we have chosen, and what chords we have to carry out in notes. This new proceeding is called figuring. The composer in his sketches often makes use of this figuring in order to contrast the most essential points of his work. For this it would suffice to a degree, but it is im- possible to express in it what we express in notes, and instead of giving it that importance which many theorists attach to it, we will only introduce it as we want it. We are already accustomed first to remember the bass and then to add the middle voices ; the bass aids us to find our way in the harmonic mass. Over or under the bass we place, there- fore, this so-called figuring. For the present the few following remarks will be sufficient. 135 1. Triads generally have no figuring, because there are no simpler chords in existence. If, however, we intend a passage to be unaccompanied, if the bass shall go on alone, we will niark it with t. s. {(asto solo). When all voices proceed in unison, or in octaves, it is marked alV unisom, or all' ottavij, ; if a single tone in the bass is in- tended to be unaccompanied we will mark it by a°. 2. Every other chord is indicated by figures which correspond with its principal intervals. Therefore tJie Septime chord is marked by 7. the Sext chord " by e- the Quart-sext chord " by \ or *. the Quint-sext chord " by ^ or |. the Terz-quart chord " by ^ or |. the Second-chord " by ^ 3. The dominant chord, if before the end, requires no figuring, as it is too important to be forgotten, even without them. We will make use of these figurings, and consider them as memoranda, as it were, of what we are going to do, as we are not yet able to represent to ourselves a whole series of chords with all their different voices. For the present, therefore, we will merely write down the bass and figurings, and add the other voices afterwards. 136 CHAPTER II. THE FREE USE OF THE UTTEESIONB. A. — New Designs and Passages. 1. As we formerly passed through the positions of a chord, we caonow combine a chord with its inversions ; for instance a triad, 164. <^ 6 4 6 6 The quart-sext chord is here introduced, but we have been led to it by the bass which passes through all the intervals of a chord. The same proceeding can take place with the dominant chord, 165. ^ Y^ ^ T 3 4 J „ Y 5 3 "* 6 and with every other triad and septime chord. 2. Formerly we dared not attempt a succession of triads in parallel direction, on account of the consecutive fifths and octaves which would make their appearance, 166. I22I s: :sr: but the more mobile sext chord permits us to make such succes- sions and to employ them for new designs and passages ; and at the same time gives us means for the accompaniment of the scale. 167. ^ !^ 137 None of these sext chords, it is true, have any connecting- tones with its neighbor ; but the flowing diatonic movement of all the voices serves as a new and quite satisfactory connecting link. The strong drift of the voices gives us no time to perceive the lack of internal connection. 3. Such successions can be made tetraphonic, either by adding the octave of the lower voice, 168, $ -I s f ^' or by a middle voice alternately doubling the third and fimdar mental tone of the chords. 169. $ iM^E^y J J T r T f f It is apparent that the manner of No. 167 is the lightest; that of No. 168 is also flowing, but the zigzag movement of the middle voice in No. 169 makes it heavier and only appropriate for slow movements. 4. The quart-sext chord can also be employed in a small suc- cession, like, 170. W j=^ f rrT but a longer continuation of it gives a very unsatisfactory result. The figuring of the above is easily found. If we dislike the constant repetition of the same figures, we can mark them by dashes placed under or over the bass. Thus the following figuring 171. J i i :^ m -f-^-^^-^-r-^^ See Appendix A. 138 tells us that to each tone of the lower voice we are to take a sext chord. B. — Combination ef Inversions with fundamental chords. In the above we have used the inversions independently. The combination of inversions and fundamental chords gives us a much more extensive source of designs. We need not mention that evert/ inverston can be combined with every fundamental chord, as long as they do not cause faulty progressions. But the nearest-related chords enter most conveniently into combinatsions, be they now fundamental chords or inversions. Therefore the chords of the . Tonic, Dominant, and Subdominant or Parallels are most easUy combined in their inversions ; for instance, 172. m i ^ 3 zz ■O gj In fact, the more convenient position of the tones makes some combinations much easier than in the fimdamental position ; thus the following chord-successions 173. i -3 -f-r-r Y are much more flowing than the same in their fundamental posi- tion, where the bass has to take such wide steps. 174. m d= =s J- r ^ T r ^ r Still more important is the formation of new harmonic passa- ges, which after what we have said of them will be comparatively easy. Only as examples we give a few passages, produced from our present means. In No. 167 we first saw an ascending and iescendiag passage of sext chords. Each sext chord reminds us of its flindamental chord ; this prompts us to mix the two : 139 175. wu s r I p r d:^ W=F^ r I ^^ff ss zz 22: &^ ?z: The anticipating of the sext chord ■would give us a second passage, 176. ^^^ r =P2: S ?^ :=\- ?= We can descend in similar manner, 177. 178. i W^t^^ =s i -(9- g r; ~ ~z5' The addition of a third chord gives us still more variety, which, together with the thorough practice of every design through all positions, we leave to the ' industry of the pupil. No. 173, for instance, might be carried out thus : The above, as the student will remember, has been the foun- dation of our harmonic element. When we now consider the positions and distances of the different tones of which it consists, we find that 1. The lower the tones, the more distant from each other are they. 2. The actual diatonic melody begins with the highest c. 3. The full and close harmony lies in the middle tones, be tween the lowest g and the highest c of our model. 4. In the lower region there is only a doubling of octaves. 5. If we wish to double the whole chord, or some intervals of the same, this can better be done in the higher than in the lower region. (Compare b.) These observations indicate to us our rules. Only that we will not follow them too strictly or too pedantically. Now for the application : 195. 146 ijj-ij ii j.jjijj.j;i. Wwm t p 6 6 a 26 3 6- 7 But first we must observe, that horizontal dashes in the, figur- ing signify continuation of the same harmony ; as in the second chord of the penultimate measure, where thty stand instead of the repetition of |. The above, for comparison's sake, is treated at a in the first manner. At b we have treated it in the third manner, with em- ployment of the inversions, but in dispersed harmony. Above all, we perceive at b the transparency of the voices and the evenness of distances. Only at the close of the thesis and of the antithesis the bass is rather more distant from the othei voices. But this happens only on unconnected parts, and the' immediate preceding of the higher octave. This new manner of treatment should be practiced by the stu- d(^t on all the former phrases, and on melodies of his own inven- tion; 1. According to the Jirsf manner of harmonization. 2. According to the second manner of harmonization, and with arbitrarily-chosen chords. 3. According to the third manner, in close harmony, and 4. In dispersed harmony. Finally, he should pi'actice the dispersed harmony in harmonic passages, of which we have had several already. Each passage can be represented in more than one position ; for instance, the one of No. 179 thus: "197. w zzL or thus : See Appendix C. 147 198. ^EB BE :si ■&- ■A: zU s- :iii J- 4 -J Pff ^±f. ~A ^.^E^EidE= r :^ I F¥=FfF=PFf l9- RETROSPBCTION. With this we close the harmonic development of our major scale. It has given us 1. Triads : the major, minor, and diminished, with their in- versions : Sext chord and Quart-sext chord. 2. The dominant chord with its inversions; Quint-sext, Tere- quart, and Secunda chords. - We have learned to combine these chords in various manners, and to form with them phrases, passages, and periods. The de- velopment of the harmony in accompaniments, phrases, passages, or periods, we will now call MODULATION. We had to resign the invention of periodical compositions, bo- cause our tetraphonous formations were not sufficiently free to permit us the equal consideration of all the requirements of a period, such as Melody, Rhythm, Construction, Harmony, and Voice-progression. But instead of this we have learned how to find for one given melody three accompanying voices. We must attach one more observation to all our former results. We have obtained the justification of the major scale. At first ^Y0 accepted it as custom has given it to us. This serves already as justification ; but since we have arrived at harmony, the question whether our major scale is well formed gains additional import- ance. We have to consider whether it is well formed for har- monic treatment, whether it contains the material for satisfactory modulation, whether it can close harmonically as well as melo- dically. We can now answer these questions in the affirmative. Thi'ee 148 major, three minor, one diminished triad and the dominant chord, together with all the inversions arising therefrom, are sufficient means to harmonize the scale, and all the melodies therein con- tained. The dominant chord gives us a perfect cadence, the ma- jor and minor chords remind us of the nearest-related keys, and we have sufficient means for half cadences and imperfect cadences. We can now confirm the conception of a hey, that such a one must be fit melodically and harmonically as well, for the forma- tion of phrases and periods. But we must not close this chapter without drawing the atten- tion of the student to the fact that it is absolutely necessary for him to play over all his compositions and exercises. In dispersed harmony, particularly, it will require some practice to do full jus- tice to the different voices. These voices are all alike important, and should be played with precision and equality of strength. When thus practising, the student should watch the effect of every chord, and the results of this attention will be a better com- mand of means than can be acquired in any other way. 149 8ixth Part. The Harmony of the Minor Scale. 1 CHAPTER I. THE FOEMATIOlir OF THE MINOR RH AT.-R. We have justified the major scale harmonically. Its tonic chord was a major triad. Upon the dominant and subdominant we found also major triads, and in the tones of these three triads C-e-g g ■- b~d. f- a - c C e f g a b c d was contained the complete major scale. But already in the major scale we found some minor triads. We ought therefore to admit that as the major scale had ma- jor triads upon the Tonic, Dominant, and Subdominant, the minor scale ought to have minor triads upon the same points. These chords, in A minor, would be A - c - e e - g -h d-f-a. This would give us the scale A, b, c, d, e, f, g,a. But in that case the minor scale would lose that most important of all chords, the dominant chord ; for the latter is based upon a major triad. Consequently we must change the minor triad of the dominant into a major chord ; for instance in A minor, e-g-b, into e-g}^-b. For this proceeding only we have sufficient reason ; for the rest 150 we mil retain the above analogous formation. Were we to cliange the triad of the subdominaat also into a major one {d-f-a into d-f^-a), the minor scale would differ in but one chord and tone from the major scale. A,b,c, d, 6;f,gla, must therefore be our minor scale. Its character, in regard to harmonic treatment requires it so. In this manner, it is true, it contains a conspicuous progression, from /to g'jf, but at the same time it is also clear that by substi- tuting/I for/ the distinction of tone-sexes is almost completely- destroyed. It has therefore been concluded to write the ascending minor scale,. and the descending one, A.g,f,e,d, c, b, a, There, however, are in reality two different minor scales; or a minor scale in which two degrees are contained doubly : A, b,c, d, e,f,f^,g,g'^,a; and which appears in every way unsystematic. We shall therefore, witKout further explanation, take the above systematical one as foundation. If the harshness' of the superflu- ous second does not agree with our melodies, we need not use it but place another tone between (/ — e — g!^, a — g^ — as— /, &c.), or we take the g!^ an octave lower, as seventh from/ Later we shqjl find means to introduce in major or minor foreign chords and tones. It wiUthen depend upon us to avoid this obnoxious progression, by raising the sixth, or by lowering the seventh de- gree. But for the present we shall win from it several important discoveries, and even in future we cannot so easily be convinced, that on account of its harshness it is inadmissible. Harshness, too, must have a corresponding representative in sounds. Note. — The student is here advised again to read over carefully the Ap- pendixes A and B, that he may have a clear understanding of the whole subject. — G. 151 CHAPTEB II. HAEMONIZATION OF THE MINOR SCALE. Wk have now to find harmonies for our new scale in the same manner as we. formerly found them for the major scale. We will at first follow our figures above the melody, and avoid the 85 3 8 5 3+3 8 200. m :si: ?= -|S>.- ^ 221 faults between the sixth and seventh degrees as formerly. Here is again the beginning of our _first manner of harmoni- zation. But the succession of the sixth and seventh degrees becomes more difficult in the descending scale ; for in addition to all for- mer difficulties we have now the harshness of progression in the scale itself We might cha,nge (as before in. No. 108) the second chord, and thus avoid consecutive octaves and fifths, 201. -h m but in that case the harmony has no connection, and that, too, at a point where the harsh progression of the melody breaks, as it were, the thread of the melody. We ought rather to double the connection of these two degrees by their chords. We attempt^ therefore, to retain as many tones as possible of the first chordj or perhaps the whole chord for the succeeding degree ; 202. m -k but in order to make room for the succeeding tone of the melody, 153 we will place the two upper tones in a lower octave. Here we have a new harmony before us, e-9l-b—f, which even exhibits the normal construction, with the exception of the vacuum between h and/ Our second harmonic mass has already exhibited to us such a vacuum, by the filling of which we gained the dominant chord. Here too, therefore, we will fill the vacuum with the intermediate third d, and have thus a new chord oifive tones e-g^h-d./ before us, which we place at once into the succession of chords which accom.pany the descending minor scale. ......... 203. P #g= ;?: s= -&- BE 221 Our main object is now achieved, only that we have introduced into a tetraphonic phrase a chord of five tones. This leads us to a further consideration of the new chord. The fifth tone, which distinguishes it from all former chords, is the ninth from the fundamental tone, and gives to it the name • Chord of the Ninth. Ninth-chord, or Nona chord. Apart from this ninth we have a dominant chord, the character and progression of which is already known to us. We can ima- gine the nona chord, therefore, as a dominant chord with added ninth. This additional interval is nothing but an addition to the highest interval of the first chord (the seventh) and consequently follows the progression of that interval. In the nona chord, therefore. The Fundamental tone proceeds to the Tonic ; The Third ascends one degree, The Seventh descends one degree. The Ninth also descends one degree, and The Fifth may either ascend or descend. In the following 153 204. ^ -£2I ■-©- BE :22= =lte the progressions can be seen more distinctly ; only that in having the fifth descend, we place it above the ninth, in order to avoid consecutive fifths. (Compare a and b.) It now remains for us to reduce the nonachord to four voices, because a pentaphonio (five-voiced) harmony is inadmissible in a tetraphonic phrase, and it might not at all times be satisfac- tory to give two tones to one voice, as we have formerly done. 205. J^ m r ^ Which tone here can now best be omitted ? Undoubtedly the fifth. Fundamental tone, third, seventh — all are too significant, and the ninth is decidedly the most characteristic tone. The harmonization of the minor scale is thus completed, and we can practice it in the following, and in the melodies given below. 6 5 8 3+9 5 3 8 3 8 3 8 5 3+3 8 154 CHAPTEE III. THE NONACHORD. CONTINUED. Our new chord is so conspicuous a formation that we would gladly win it for our major scale also. It consists, as we have seen, of the dominant chord with an additional third. In Q mi- nor, for instance, it would be g-h-i-f-a\,. If we now add another third to our dominant chord in C major, it would be g-h-d-f-a ; and thus we have obtained a nonachord in major, constructed from the tones of the major scale. It is only distinguished from the nonachord in minor by the ninth, which in the latter is minor, while in the former it is major. We will therefore call the one the major nonachord, and the other the minor nonachord. But since the major nonachord, is constructed exactly as the minor jiona chord, it follows the same rules. 207. m ZS2Z -£2- -0- ^ ^- -&- The Fundamental tone goes to the Tonic ; The Third ascends ; The Seventh descends ; The Ninth descends ; and The Fifth, if helow the ninth, must ascend (a), otherwise it would create consecutive fifths. If above the ninth, the reason of this rule falls to the groimd (b) and if can consequently eithei ascend or descend. En passant, we must state that in thoroughbass figuring this chord is marked 9, from its most important interval. 155 Inversions of the Nonaohord.* Examining the usefulness of the nonachord, we enquire at once for its inversions ; its positions we have seen already in the above. But the tone-riches of the chord stand here in our way. It oversteps the boundary of the octave, and no sooner do we attempt an inversion, than the whole construction falls into confusion. 208. m S -©£2- :si^gg— ^^ -go- In particular positions only are these inversions of the nona- chord possible, and even then only under many 209. m ^ ^" -g-- "23- troubles and much hesitation. We shall therefore only use them carefully, and require no particular names for them. Even the omission of the fifth gives us here no relief For the collision takes place between seventh, ninth, and fundamental tone, which latter in an inversion steps right between the two former. This leads us to another manner of relieving the chord of its tone-burthen, We omit the fundamental tone, and thus gain two new chorfs of four tones, therefore new Septime chords. In the same manner we gained formerly the diminished triad from the dominant chord. Below are the two new septime chords, as the issue from the nonachord. 210. m The latter only deserves a new name, because by and by it will become important ; and since the diminished triad is contained therein, we will call it Diminished Septime chord. We need hardly mention that the intervals of this chord fol- low the same laws as those of the original nonachord, i. e., the * See Appendix E. 156 fundamental tone h (former third) ascends, the fifth (former sev- enth) descends, the seventh (former ninth) descends, and the third (former fifth) can either ascend or descend. These new septime chords can be inverted without diificulty, and without requiring further rules. 311. What intervals, we ask now, can be omitted or doubled? According to former rules the third is the one which can best be omitted or doubled ; the latter, because it is the only one which can either ascend or descend. 4 212. m 3 -e- &. -ei A tfe "^ -G>- 1 i& te r ' Y Former theorists have prided themselves no little on their tal- ent of inventing names for every insignificant new formation. This served only to confuse the, mind of the student, without in the least facilitating his labors. We have only given names to the most important chords. Any little variation from these can be sufficiently designated in the figuring. We know that the ninth and seventh are the most important intervals of these chords, and if we represent them in our figuring it will be all-sufficient. 157 CHAPTEE IV. THE FREER USE OF THE NEW CHORDS. We are now in possession of three species of triads, three spe- cies of septime chords, and two species of nonaohords. All the triads, two of the septime chords and one of the nonaohords are applicable in major as well as in minor. We also know the rules according to which they are applied. Each new chord gives us, therefore, by itself, and in combina- tion with others, new harmonic designs, which according to for- mer instructions can be easily found. One only shall be indica- ted here ; the combination of those chords which have arisen from either omission or addition of intervals. 214. m :i= -&- '^ These chords give us the best harmonic connection possible, except the combinations of positions and inversions of one and the same chord. We also discover here a new manner of avoid- ing the resolution of those intervals which are bound to a certain progression. In No. 160 the third h went to d, the seventh, _^ went to g, because the same chord remained, and these tones were represented by other voices. Here 215. E -©- T r /goes to a instead . of «, because tfie chord remains and becomes a nonachord. Then again atof, and ftob; not because the nona- chord remains, but because it goes back into the dominant chord whence it issued. However brief we can make our instructions by reference to 158 the preceding, it is still necessary for the student to continue his practice of harmonic combinations, in all inversions and positions, and to employ them in the formation of sequences and preludes, and particular attention should be given to the harmonization of given melodies. To this we add the following remarks : 1. — Major Melodies. "We have foUnd two new chords for them ; the major nona- chord and the septime chord arising therefrom, with its inversions. Both chords may be applied to all the tones contained therein, if it can be done without causing confusion and faulty progressions, for instance, ^feS—tfifS ■rrrE^ J N 1 ' ' J h i-^J- U J J 6 3 5 6 6 7 „ -•- =^ 6 6 4 5 2 6 3 4 6 7 4 2. — Minor Melodies. We have occupied ourselves so little with the minor scale, that we now require a more thorough practicing of formations in its compass. As introduction it would be well for the student to construct, from the chords of the minor scale harmonic designs and ■ sequen- ces, as many as he possibly can. Then he ought to treat every 159 given melody in two manners. First according to thej^rsi man- ner of harmonization, and right below it, according to the second and third manners ; i. e., by choosing his chords and using them in their inversions. We give here an example of, the last manner; for the first we have no room. 217. ^iite^i 'M EBtt. isi -i» '^i §t -M-li 5 1 H3 1 tl8 6 H t 4., -l^ iEk^ M^ ?•= '&U- i»^=S-- f. 3E£ ife^ :p— •- ^-i: m ■S*- 4 6 t!3 4 5 t|6 6 2 6 H4 H 4-a^ 87 We find in the figuring of the above some new signs which require an explanation. Until now we have taken all our chords as the ordinary key-signature (the sharps or flats placed at the be- ginning of a composition) indicated them. In major this answered very well. Bnt in minor this key-signature does not correspond with the actual scale, and we have to make use of accidentals. The same has to be done in the thoroughbass figuring. In, C mi- nor, for instance, a 6 above d would indicate the sext chord d-f-bb. But there is no h\, m our scale of minor, and we, therefore, must place a i\ before- the 6, in order to change the b}, into Jt|. If an accidental without figure is placed above or below the bass, it always refers, to the third. Thus the i\ under the second note of the bass in No. 317, indicates that the triad g-bVf-d (not g-b],-d) is wanted. If the key were G minor, a | above the d would indicate the triad d-f^-a. Frequently the figures are crossed instead of placing a # before them : %, $, 4, 0, jS, %. 160 3. — Additional Licenses of the Dominant chord. We have now completed the circle of harmonies developed immediately from the first fundamental harmony and the tones of the major and minor scales. Among all, the dominant chord has proved itself the most pro- ductive, having given birth to the diminished triad and to the two nonachords with their septime chords. Already on a former occasion we have permitted this chord a less restricted progres- sion; its third, if covered by the middle voices, was allowed to descend, while the seventh was permitted to ascend, in order to make the succeeding chord complete. It is now our next object to favor the better connection of chords. We will permit the fundamental tone, therefore, to remain as fifth of the succeeding chord (a) as if it were merely the octave of an omitted fundamen- tal tone (b) ; or it may descend into the third of the succeeding chord, instead of its fundamental tone (c), while the seventh (cov- ered by the other voices) ascends, in order to avoid covered oc- taves, which might be obnoxious, particularly when in the outer voices (d). 218. P^ r r T- The fundamental tones of the nonachord may also participate in the first license ; 219. i ^i =F=^ but the second is less admissible, because the accompanying ninth forces the seventh to follow its natural laws.* * See Appendix F. 161 SeTcnth Part. Modulation into Foreign Keys. All our formations thus far moved 'within the compass of any- one particular major or minor key, and contained neither tones nor chords foreign to that key. But in order to extend the sphere of our labors, and to add to our melodic and harmonic means, we must call other tones and other chords into action, i. e., we must combine the tones and harmonies of two or more keys in one composition. The technical term for this proceeding is " fo modu- late into foreign keys," or " to modulate." This combination of several keys in one phrase can take place in two different ways. We can modulate into another key and remain in it to the end of the composition, or at least form iri it an essential part of the same. In such case the step from the one key into the other is called a " transition." Or we can merely touch the new key, use one or a few chords, or even a sequence. In that case we have a mere " digression." If, therefore, in a composition in major we would introduce passages and phrases like the following. 220. which are not indigenous to that key, but which would have been touched merely accidentally, without actually exchanging raa- jor for another key, these foreign chords would be called " digres- sions." How to arrive at such chords, how to classify them, or how to construct them, requires no particular instruction, as the results of the rules of transition will furnish all the requisites. Transition, then, according to the above, is to leave one key, in the course of a composition, and to se^e distinctly another one, in order to construct, or execute in it an essential part of the whole. 162 CHAPTEE I. MODULATION FROM ONE KEY INTO ANOTHER. We modulate from one key into another by exchanging the aes and harmonies instead of C major, tones and harmonies of the one for those of another ; for instance, '^i <^> «i fi ffi «! h «i with its three major triads ((7, ff, F\ &c., we take A major : a,h, c\,d,e,f%g% a, ' with its three major triads {A, E, D), dzc. This womld be the most complete, but also the most troublesom,e manner of modu- lalting. But we perceive immediately that much is here mixed' up wMch might be called superfluous. The two keys, however distant from each other, have several tones in common (a, 6, rf, e), iiii which tones, therefore, they are not distinguished from each other, and in which we do not perceive that C major has beeir excMnged for A major. These mutual non-distinguishing tones need not,, therefore, be touched. The remaining three, /|, cjf, g^, indicate the transition. But even in our monophonic phrases we have already used foreign tones without exactly exchanging one key for another. We re- quire a more distinct sign of transition than mere single tones. This we can only expect from that harmony in which we have dis- covered the first conception and the foundation of keys. But which are the harmonies which serve us as the surest sign of a transition ? Those which surest indicate their key. Therefore the dominant chord with the nonachords derived from it, and the triads contained in it are the ones. The moment one of these chords appears in the course of our modulation, we say that we have entered its key^ We attach all further observations at once to the first transition- chord, the " dominant chord," and then pass on to the others. 163 1. THE DOMINANT CHOED. We know already that every dominant chord can only exist in Its own key and in no other. If, therefore, in one modulation a foreign dominant chord makes its appearance, for instance, in C major, the chord e-g!^-b-d, it is at once impossible that we can be in major, or in any key but A. The dominant chord is the distinct sign of the introduocion of its key. But it is no sign for the tone-sex ; for in major and mi- nor it is exactly alike. The above dominant chord tells us dis- tinctly that we are no longer in (7 major, but it is undecided whether we are in A major or A minor. This is only decided by the following chord ; if a-c|-e, we have gone to A major, if a-c-e, we are in A minor. Since the dominant chord is the decisive sign of its key, it must also be the decisive means to modulate into its key. If we in- tend to modulate therefore into any other key we have but to in- troduce the dominant chord of the latter. In order, for instance, to modulate from any key into A major or A minor, we have but to introduce the chord e-g^b-d, and since the dominant chords of major and minor are exactly alike, we are at liberty to go to major or minor. We need, therefore, only to know the domi- nant chord of a key, and the proper manner of its introduction, to modulate into the same. But this modulation must be effected in the course of a compo- sition, according to the rules of harmony. Not alone that faulty progressions must be avoided, but the chords shall also appear well connected. We must bring the transition-chord (the domi- nant chord of the new key) into connection with the last chord of the preceding key; both chorfls must be connected by mutual tones. • It is necessary, first of all, to know which chord of the prece- ding key was last touched. It cannot have been a dominant chord, nor a nonachord, nor a diminished triad ; for all of these have to return to tll% tonic triad. Our transitions can therefore only be attached to major or minor triads. We have in major three major triads and three minor triads. In minor we have two major and two minor triads. Here 164 221. EES ^ :£S=^E1E:: '-^=W we see at a the six triads of G major, and at b the four triads of A minor to which a transition-chord could be attached. It is clear that we can attach to each of these chords any tran- sition-chord which has one or more tones in common with it. With the chord c-e-ff, for instance, we can connect the following dominant chords : 222. * m W -&&& Deducting the dominant chord at h, because it brings us back to the preceding key, we have still eight actual transitions : to F, D, D\,, B\,, G, A, B, and 'A\,. We need hardly men- tion that we have used the inversions of the dominant chord, in order to effect the transitions as fluently as possible. If we intend now to make a transition from a chord, for in- stance from c-e-g, into a key, the dominant chord of which is not connected with the former, we make use of a mediator. In going from C major to E, for instance, we would require the chord 5-c?|-/|-a, which has noTnutual tone with c-e-g. We, therefore, go first to another chord in G major which has one or more tones in com- mon with the dominant chord of S, and which at the same time is connected with the chord c-e-g. Of such chords there are sev- eral, and every other chord in* G major can here accidentally be the mediator between c-e-g and J-rf|-/}f-a. 223. A B i= m feE W-. -fr =^^ z^z ^3Z 1 165 It is easily perceptible, however, that one of these mediations lies nearer than the other ; the one at e is the loosest, because the mediating chord has no tone in common with the first chord, and is only related to a degree, because it belongs to the same key. However, the connection by means of tones in common, (as we already know) is merely external. A more intimate relation exists between such chords as indicate nearly-related keys. Since a major or minor triad always reminds of that key in which it is the tonic chord, we must consider those chords -which re- mind us of the to-be-expected key, or indicate the way to it, as nearer than the other. In No. 223, for instance, the chord e-g-b at B reminds us by itself of the key of E, and prepares us best for the transition into E ; the chords at c and a, indicate at least the direction, following which we afterwards find the key of E ; at D and e ; however we are led into an opposite direction, i. e. keys with flats. At b, therefore, we see the nearest medi- ation, while at d and e we find the most distant ones. Finally we must consider that a transition-chord, though con- taining one connective tone, may contain so many foreign tones that a mediation by means of interposed chords with less foreign tones is desirable. Therefore we shall now make use also of foreign chords to prepare the transition, by arbitrarily changing major to minor, and minor to major triads ; for instance, in C major : c-e-ff in c-e\,-ff, and a-c-e in a-cj(-e. Thus, in No. 224, c, the dominant chord a\,-c-e])-g]}, though connected with the previous chord by means of c, was still too distant from C major, on ac- count of the three foreign tones a\)-s\r-gh- In order to effect a bet- ter connection we interpose another chord as mediator ; as for in- stance, at A i 224.5fe^=§= ^jp¥ fe -@- ^ Z2©= .»- -tr--^ ^ pE -|S>- -#- -&- $ -ft 321 =i-= --§- Sr W^- 166 the chord c-e\,-g, (we change the major chord into minor) and thus gain not merely an additional mutual tone, {c-e\,) but obtain also a harmony -vphich reminds us of C minor, and brings us nearer to Sh major than C major. At b and c we find other mediations of the same transition ; at d and e we find a media- tor for the abrupt transition of No. 222, g. In order, then, to modulate into any key, the most practical proceeding is, to write down first the chord ^om which we modu- late and at some distance from this the dominant chord of the key into which we wish to modulate. For instance, in modular ting from C to B, the first sketch would be the one at a. fe 225. S: fe= =fe- 226. 3t- iSj -&- -3- -& -&&- M P 'ZSl ^ Then we must examine whether these two chords have sufficient con- nection. In the above case the tone e is the connective tone, but the remaining tones are in absolute contradiction to the first chord and to G major. If the connection of the two is not satisfactory, a glance at the chords will soon suggest a harmony which con- nects the two chords. Thus in the above (b), we have first inter- posed the minor triad a-c-«, then the major chord, a-c|-e, and finally have taken the dominant chord of B. We must be careful, however, to place the foreign tones in that voice which can take it most conveniently, i. e. which has for- merly had the same degree now to be raised or lowered. Thus in No. 225, a, we have given c| to the upper voice which had c and aj} to the lower voice which had o. A strict adherence to this rule will be our best safeguard against harsh progressions. According to the above developments, the dominant chord gives us the following modulations or transitions into all the dif ferent degrees of our tone system. From Cto 167 ■f- We have here only employed the nearest and best mediating chords. Mediating for every particular case and its application to minor keys, and the exercise in diflferent positions of chords and other keys is left to the pupiL Each of these modulations, as we know already, can lead to minor as well as to major ; and, as a matter of course, the keys of B\), E\, F\^ &o., can he exchanged at any time for their enhar- monic representatives C|, i)|, G'b, &c. We must now speak of a modulation which does not strictly deserve that name, and for which our ordinary transition-chord (dominant chord) does not suffice. We have reference to the major and minor of the tonic, (for instance, C major and Cminor.) The dominant chord which the two keys have in common is cer- tainly the nearest mediator we could seize. 228. T M but exactly because of its being a chord belonging, to either of these keys, it can no longer be the sign of a transition. If such sign is required, the minor triad of the subdominant would be the nearest indication of our going to minor, (a) 229.; 168 and the major triad of the subdominant, perhaps preceded by the major tonic triad, (b) would indicate the transition from minor to major. 2. THE BrONACHORDS. Since these chords contain the complete dominant chord, they must be capable of having the same facilities, for modulating into a key, and characterizing the same. And, indeed, they fur nish us the same transitions, demand and find the same mediation, only that on account of their tone-bulk they are somewhat more difficult to manage. But on account of their nature they have the additional advan- tage of being at the same time indicators of the tone species into which we modulate. The major nonachord leads us to expect major (a), the minor nonachord indicates ininor (b). 23o.a^^3^3i; -bpg- Owing, however, to the just-mentioned existence of the dominant chord in either, we take occasionally the liberty of considering every nonachord as a mere dominant chord, and resolve them in either major or minor. «^ -&- -&- S- S- -&- S- That the resolution (a) No. 231, is less satisfactory than the one of (b) 231, is apparent, and that the one of 231 (c) is more satisfactory than the one 231 (b), is apparent. 3. THE SEPirME CHORD OF THE MAJOR NONACHORD. We know that this chord originates from the nonachord, and consequently indicates that chord and the dominant chord as well as the key. Nevertheless it has not the perfect characteristic de- cision of others ; for, according to its tone-contents, it can exist as well in the parallel key ; for instance h-dfa can be in A minor as well as in major. But this insignificant doubt is soon silenced 169 by the succeeding chord, -while our own feeling anticipates already the signification and the progression of the chord. Thus, for in- stance the resolution of h-d-f-a into C major, as at a, is per- fectly satisfactory, and yet the one at b is not exactly inadmis- sible, 232. ii but requires a certain confirmation as at c. Independent of these deviations, however, the septime chord furnishes its series of modulations with or without mediation, for instance to F D Ab E 233. ~^*"~ Si= fei:: -&^" m M m: i simply lacking the vigorous step from fundamental tone to fun- damental tone, or from dominant to tonic. 4. THE DIMINISHED SEPTIME CHORD. We know that this chord is derived from the minor nona- chord, and with the latter from the dominant chord. Consequently it must share the faculty of either, in effecting and characterizing modulations. With the original minor nonachord, it belongs to the minor species, but like the former it is used in major. 234. :^= --ii =a^ --^i- :i^-- -m- -M- -#- -•- -»- -0- If this deviation were not so trivial, it would, according to its original position, indicate the minor key at once. But in re- turn it has none of the vagueness of our last septime chord. Ac- cording to its derivation and tone-contents it can only belong to one key ; for instance the chord h-drf-a\) can only be found in G minor. 5. THE DIMINISHED TRIAD. We have first considered this chord as a dominant chord with 170 omitted fundamental note ; h-d-f, for instance, appeare.d to iis as the incomplete dominant chord of G. But since the diminished triad, like the diminished septime chord, consists of thiuds, placed one above the other, we can also derive it from this chord by omitting its fundamental tone and retrace it to the key of the diminished septime chord. For instance, J-c^ referred to g-h-dr-f, would indicate the key of major or C minor. In the other case it would refer to g\-h-d-f, therefore to e-g^-b-d-f, or in other words to the key of A minor. We see by this that the diminished triad, though sharing the modulating faculties of the dominant chord, modulates with less decision. The succeeding chord only tells us which of the two indicated keys was meant. The following modulations, for in- stance, 235. i; =2Z^fi -&—S- ^^ can be based on the dominant chords of and lead to F, J3\,, A, £ major or minor ; but they might also be based upon the dimin- ished septime chords, -cjlf/;j| ejif*, and we might lead them accor- dingly to B, G, F^, ffjf, minor (or major.) 236. 4 /* 4 fU Only the final chord's in each of these examples tell us what key follows in reality. Our ear, however, always expects after a diminished triad that key which is nearest related to the previous one. Thus if in G major, for instance, the chord b-d-f occurs, we trace it to g-b-d-f, and expect C major, because this key is nearer related to G major than A minor. But if the same chord occurs in ^minor, we trace it to g^-b-d-f, and expect A minor, because this latter key is much nearer to F minor than major. 6. THE DOMINANT TKIAD. This chord evidently lacks the decision of characterization which the dominant septime chord vrith its sub-species is in possession 171 of. The chord g-h-d, for instance, can belong to either major, D major, C major, or C minor. Yet we have observed already, that the dominant triad, if succeeded by the tonic triad, will be treated as an imperfect dominant chord, and be resolved accord- ingly. Therefore a mere triad can also become a sign and means of modulation if it is distinguished sufficiently from the until-then- prevailing key, and if it resolves like an imperfect dominant chord into the tonic harmony of its fundamental tone. Thus it is here at a 237. The phrase according to the first chord is in A minor. But the triad g-h-d disagrees with this key, and since it resolves im- mediately into its tonic harmony, ' it indicates sufficiently the modulation from A minor to C major. Certainly it might also as at B have been led to major or even D, and this is exactly the lack of decision which we have mentioned. But even here, our ear anticipates the decision ; it expects the first modulation to C major, because A minor and C major stand as parallel keys in nearest relation, while Cf or D stand only in more distant rela- tion to it. 7. THE MINOR TRIAD. Finally this chord can also be the sign and means of a modu- lation, provided it contains one or more foreign tones. By this it indicates at least that for the moment the original key reigns no longer, and we expect either a return into that key (a), or an actual modulation into, a key to which the new chord is indige- nous (b). 238. 172 We need not add that our former mediating chords with for- eign tones belong to this category. In regard to the succeeding chapter, the application of these new means, we have now to remark, that we have to consider them in three different views, each of which is so productive that we have to consider each one by itself 1. We consider the modulation into foreign keys, merely as means to combine the harmonies of several keys in one compo- sition. 2. We construct with them, independently, new formations. 3. We use them in more extended and well constructed formar tions. 173 CHAPTER II. INTEODUCTIOlSr OF THE NEW MEAJSTS INTO THE HABMONIZA- TION OF GIVEN MELODIES. We have now, therefore, before us the ability of combining in one phrase, in a single melody, two or more keys. A dis- tinction arises now, which formerly we had not to make. We must distinguish melodies which absolutely require modula- tion into foreign keys, from such melodies as merely permit, without absolutely requiring them. We might call them indi- genous and digressive melodies. The digressive melodies will always lead us for more or less time into foreign keys. Our harmony, therefore, will have to be constructed so that it faciliates and effects this modulation into the new key. How this is to be done we have already learned in the last chapter. Once arrived in the new key we treat it for the time as an original key and require for it no further instruo tion. It remains only for us to ascertain 1. Whether a melody requires a modulation, and where this modulation leads to ; or 3. Whether the melody adnqjts of one or more digres- sions. ' In the latter case we shall always prefer that which lies nearer, and shall rather modulate into nearest-related keys, (the keys of the dominant, subdominant and the three parallel keys), than into more distant keys. Having arrived in the new key we pro- ceed again on the same principle, i. e., we prefer remaining in it to unnecessarily seizing another new key. A. — The Ascertainment of Digressive Melody. The characteristics of a digression can be external or internal ; the former actually exhibited, the latter merely indicated in the melody. 1. EXTBENAL CHARACTBEISTICS. These consist in the foreign tone of a melody. If in a melody 174 in Q major the tone f\ makes it's appearance, we consider it as no longer in C; for the tone/| is foreign to the key of C major. Having arrived now by means of this tone at another key, O major, for instance, and the tone/t] makes its appearance, we have to consider the / again as a sign of digression, for in major there is no / But to what key does this foreign tone of the melody lead us 1 This question we cannot answer with complete certainty. We suppose at first we have arrived in the key in which the foreign tctoe first appears. Proceeding from C major, for instance, we would consider f\, not as leading to D major, E minor, &c., but to O major, as the key in which /jj first appears. A c| in (7 major, we do not consider as belonging to A major or B. minor, but as belonging to D major, as the first key to which the c\ is indigenous. But these are all mere suppositions ; we can make quite diffei'- ent uses of such tones. This melody, for instance, 239. i ^ can be conducted from C major to O major (a), it is true, but it can also be conducted to ^ minor (b). -J- 240. At some future time we shall even discover another possibility, viz. : that a foreign tone belongs to no harmony, and consequently indicates neither harmony, nor modulation, nor digression. This insecurity of external characteristics leads us to 2. INTEBNAL CHARACTBRISTICS. These are based upon the regular progression of all modula- tion, and upon the principles therein developed. To wit — as soon as we find a doubtfiil external sign of digres- sion, we interpret it according to the principles which guide our modulation, and among the probable keys we select that one which is the nearest to the principal tone, or which otherwise cor- 175 responds with the laws of construction,^ Accordingly we would led,d the phrase No. 239 from G major to Q major as the near- est related, and not to E minor. If then in the course of the melody the / again appears, we should go to G major, as the nearest key to G containing an_/5 in preference to any other. Even if a melody contained no foreign tone, we would aslc whether internal signs would not make a digression advisable, nay, preferable to the retaining of the same key ; if, for instance, the melody of a first part in C major should end thus : 241, or ' \ rj C2 • fi- / ° -^ r^ \{ \ ' 1 1 ; ,,_, 1 1 1 \ U J ' 1 I u we would consider it as a cadence in G major. 243. — Sl-n— l-F rr 'm « T 337 and not as a half cadence with the dominant chord, and as a forced modulation in the principal key. And thus, vice versa, the phrase No, 242 would not be consid- ered as a modulation into G major, the continuation proving that another key, say E minor. 243, f^s^z0^ ^m # was meant as the goal of the modulation : though it is admissible to consider the first /| as leading to G major, and turn only at the second /| into E minor. This will suffice, for the present at least, to ascertain the har- monization of digressive melodies ; by and by we shall arrive at a more thorough understanding. B- — Discovery of all possibly eligibli chords. Already in our second manner of harmonization we enquired what chords could possibly be chosen to a tone of the melody. 176 We ascertained still later, that every tone can be either a funda- mental tone, third, fifth, seventh, or ninth of a chord. But at that time we were limited to the indigenous chords. We have now a much larger field for such investigation ; for every tone of a melody can be not alone, third, fifth, seventh, &c. of a triad, septime or nonahchord of the key in which the melody is written, but in any key which contains that particular tone. Thus the tone C, for instance, can be : 1. Fundamental tone of a major, minor, or diminished triad, three septime chords, and two nonachords. 244. i ^. ^ ^ ^s =p^ '&- -&- 2. Third of three triads, three septime chords and two nona- chords. 245. & >fe«- ^ ^ M ^ W-- '-»-' 1?" ^ 3. Fifth of three triads, three septime chords, and two nona^ chords. 246. fe^=F*=« I^a^^a * 4. Seventh of three septime and two nonachords. 247. -TT lo " F — "g — F — g I "~ ^ 1 — ^ F 5. Ninth of two nonachords. 248. w. :M ,si b! * We have discovered, according to the above, one and thirty har- monies for every single tone, independent of the different inver- 177 C. — Application of these means to indigenous or digressive melodies. We have now ascertained how many chords can possibly be used for every tone of a melody, and the question arises which of them we have to choose, or which to exclude. Our general rules wUl be sufficient for the present. No chord should be chosen, the introduction of which would cause faulty progressions ; the con- nection of the harmony must be retained, and each, must be con- ducted conveniently (fluently) and intelligibly. The rest will develope itself in the cdurse of our labors. Our first care next to this, will be to preserve the unity of key, and the turning points of the modulation. We .shall, , therefore, end with the dominant chord and the tonic triad, and generally begin with the latter, while we shall mark the thesis of a phrase vyith the triad of the dominant, or with a modulation to the key of the dominant. Finally, in the course of a composition we shall always think first of those chords which belong to next-re- lated or near-related keys, in preference to chords of more distant keys. - • Let us attempt now to apply our new means to one of oui former melodies (No. 195). 255. i ^f^fe n S 6 f6 fcl b5 4-7 9 6 6- The first chord remains unchanged. The second tone we consider is fifth of a triad which brings us to A minor. The d imme- diately after, we consider as fifth of a diminished septime chord, [g\-b-d-f) which forces the tonic triad of A minor upon us. The sixth chord brings us back to Cmajor. The thesis closes with the chord g-h-d. We can either consider it as dominant triad in C major, and in that case we accompany the preceding e with the chord c-e-g, {vide No. 195) ; or we can consider it as tonic triad of G, in consequence of which we have to modulate into it. Ac- cordingly we treat the tone e as ninth of the chord (i/|-a-c-e, or as seventh off-orc-e. We have preferred the former, because it is easier for the bass to proceed from c to d, than from c to /|. Having occupied the parallel and dominant pi-incipally in the 178 first part we turn now to some other related keys into which to modulate. There remains for us the parallel of the dominant, the subdominant and its parallel. It would require the chord 6-rf|/|-a, or some harmony derived from it to get into the first of the above mentioned keys ; but all these chords are too foreign to the last four measures of the melody. We are limited, therefore, to the keys of F major and D minor, if we insist upon introducing modulations into foreign keys. Therefore, we consider the second tone e as fifth of the chord (i-c\-e-g, in order to modulate into J) minor. Being once in D minor, we might accompany the e of the sixth measure with the chord o-c-e ; but since it is our object to go with the next tone into F major, we prefer the chord a-c-e, because it prepares by its c this modulation. The remaining chords require no further explanation. The chords which we have chosen here, are by no means arbi- trary. Thus, for instance, we might have treated the fifth measure. No. 255, as at a, 256 or continued it as at b or c. The reasons for our present selection will become apparent at a future time. 256. THE COMPLETING OF OnR WORKS. We will now place our phrase completely before us, in order to attach our further remarks to it. No. 255 would perhaps present a form somewhat like this : 257. Looking at the harmonic contents of our phrase, we cannot but observe, that we devote more space and time to the foreign keys than to the principal key. We cannot justify this, proceeding which 179 takes away the unity and firmness of the whole structure, except with the plea that it was our object to introduce as many keys as possible. We must further remark that in finding these foreign chords we have observed a two-fold proceeding. At first we enquired which chord was suitable to this or that particular tone of the melody, and retained the key into which we were led by the se- lected chord. Then again in the antithesis, we consulted what keys we had already employed, and selected those harmonies which woujd bring us into the other nearest-related keys. Finally, 'it is clear that the above treatment is by no means the only one possible. With the aid of foreign chords and their inversions, the harmonization might be varied almost to infinity. It is not easy to introduce a new chord, without its influencing the treatment of the whole phrase. Here, for instance we give a treatment which does not even begin with the tonic triad. 259. I 1 I I it^zMizat IP :tT=^: I j !J 1 I I 3ti ■^-- t^ :d.t::-. W^m^^Gr- I '^ m ■i-- Jali- Ul^-d mm 2 6 3 tl \,1 i 5 bbY b6 iW No sooner had we touched the keys with flats (2d measure), than our whole thoughts turned to these. The thesis closed upon the dominant it is true, but not before a chord from C minor found room, and the antithesis touched upon G minor, F minor, and JF major. The third tone of the second measure has two chords (and con- sequently two figurings) beneath it. This is no fault, for we can rhythmically dissect every tone and treat it as tone-repeti- tion. The penultimate chord had necessarily to be a triad, becai.ise the resolution of the preceding chord required such a one. But in order not to lose the dominant chord for our final cadence, we 180 have led one of the intervals of the triad into the seventh (/), and thus satisfactorily ended the phrase. Figuring of two or more chords. How can we indicate that a bass tone contains two or more harmonies ? By douhle or triple figuring in succession. For distinctness sake the triads, on such occasions, are also indicated 5 ^ (by 3, 3, 5, though they do not absolutely require it. We have already, at a former opportunity drawn the attention of the pupil to a false relation, which, with foreign tones often finds its way into our harmonies. (Page 166.) It is technically called cross relation (mi contra fa), and has given ample opportunity for the writing of volumes. Though the pupil who follows our principles in the conducting of his voices need not fear the occurrence of such relation, we can- not pass this subject without devoting to it a few remarks. Proceeding from one chord to another which has one or more notes in common with the first one, it has generally been our rule to retain such notes in that or those voices in which it or they first appeared. Thus, for instance, we consider it better to write as at A, I E ^ I -*■ r r r than to write as at b. Now, if the succeeding chord brings us a degree which already existed in the former chord, save that it is now raised or de- pressed by accidentals, ^ r r f ' r r ^^ we also consider it best to give such an altered degree to that voice which had formerly the original degree. For this reason 181 the notes e}), /|, e and c|, appear in the same voices (treble and alto) which formerly had the notes e,f, e\) and c. But the moment we deviate from this natural proceeding, and give the altered degree to a different voice from the one which had the original, ! J - Mz i ^ rr i--^r-r rt mi l^z =F=is the voices have no longer a flowing and natural progression, and stand to each other in an unnatural relation. Thus at a and B the treble seems to stand in C major, while the bass is in C minor. At c the treble stands in D minor, while the bass stands in Z> or G major. At d the treble indicates C and D minor, while the bass stands perhaps in G major. Such equivocal relation of one voice to another is called a cross relation. Former theories have laid much stress upon this matter and have earnestly and anxiously warned against it. We, however, need attach no such importance to this matter ; not merely because our manner of conducting voices avoids such re- lations of itself, but also because we never decide one-sidedly, and may have reasons occasionally to permit such cross-relation These reasons we will now point out. A cross-relation is disagreeable, because the voices do not pro- gress flowingly and naturally, and because the key of the one contradicts that of the other voice. Whenever such is not 'the case, or when the harshness of this relation corresponds to our design, or, finally, when by the passing annoyance we gain a greater advantage, we shall unhesitatingly permit such cross-relation. In pointing out the admissible cross-relations, we meet first those cases in which the degree to be altered exists in two voices at once, and consequently can submit in one only to the altera^- tion. Here, for instance. at A, the upper voice cannot go to /| with the lower voice, with- out making octaves. Having once admitted the doubling of /in 182 the first chord we must of necessity lead the two fi in different directions. The same is the case at b, c, and d. But it is exactlj' because ol this necessity and because the voices are led as natu- rally and easily as possible, that this progression is permitted and can hardly be counted among the cross-relations. This relation is also covered or smoothed over, when the con- tradictory tone has the appearance of a newly entering voice, as at A, -£3. fe :d^i-4- 3^; ^=0=F+=if I I or when the two opposed voices indicate different, but near-related tones, as at b. At c, however, we can see how easily such cross- relations can be avoided and how much milder and flowing the modulation can be made. A similar state of things is, when the cross-relation occurs in chords which belong to different phrases or sections. W- i r -Si S u --^ m j^_ I ff rrf- I Here, in the first example, four and four chords constitute a phrase, and consequently the cross-relation of c and c| is admissible, be- cause they belong to different sections. In the second example we consider two and two chords as different links, and permit the cjf of the second link as a newly entering voice. If in either case the rebellious tone is conceived more distinctly, it serves only to more plainly distinguish the sections. The same occurs in the following phrases : I „l fe^ -J- J 5S fe^ ip-jz r^UT¥ T r We have now proved that a cross-relation, with all its harsh- ness, can be even desirable, as the only right expression, when it 183 is our object to introduce a voice decisively. As a further illustra- tion, we quote here a passage from Mozart's Quatuor in G major which of late has been the theme of earnest discussion among German and French theorists. Mozart commences thus : s; m^ OES r ^- - p-rrf ~f ^ ^^ in a mysterious, gloomy manner, before entering the fresh C ma- jor. The second entering voice leaves us uncertain whether c-f-a\) {F minor), or c-eh-a\, {A\, major) will appear. The succeeding voice decides for the latter, and with the next voice (the treble) Mozart breaks this harmony at once, and keeps us in anxious uncertainty, until with the sixth quarter-note he turns decidedly to G major, the dominant of the principal tone, and then con- tinues. Who perceives not that this piercing tone — it forms a cross-relation with the preceding a of the second voice — is abso- lutely proper and indispensable to the idea of the composer ? If Mozart had resigned the a\) or the a^ of the higher voice, the char- acter of his phrase, and the analogous succession of his voices would have been lost. For the same reasons cross-relations are well applied, when we use them in slow harmonic sequences and sharp and weighty modulations, for instance. IZt te 3i ^32:ja I £22 i m m -CZ- Zisr. ife In rapidly succeeding modulations, also, particularly in a flowing progression of the voices, the cross-relation seems to lose its harshness, #== ^=#= because the change of modulation occupies the hearer, and such 184 progressions (which are based upon the omission of the resolution- chords) have of themselves a certain strangeness which well i ^ t -^ ^=1_ . . mz ^ :^i corresponds to the character of the cross-relation. And thus we understand why cross-relations are permitted which, considered by themselves, are actually strange and contra- dictory, but which are the unavoidable consequences of a proper and well constructed progression of the different voices. As one of many instances, we give here a passage from a fiigue in C minor, by Sebastian Bach. ^ ^==^= ^ BF¥ m l^^^to drf ^^^p^- ^; g^— N 3^ d^ Pm^ i3— ^ -CET m W- 4^ ^^ fes -^t^=^-^-=gg It is evident that the cross-relations marked f, could not be avoided without sacrificing the upward pressure ii'om d to «K «j/^/ff) 5^1 ™d again from $• toal;, a, bb, b, in the lower and middle voices, or the spoiling of the upper voice. Until now we have only spoken of cross-relations between two chords in immediate succession ; but tlte same relation can extend above the second to a third chord, and in such case it is called an indirect cross-relation. Here 185 JJ!J-JJ UJ- h fl ' I I 1 [I ' we see a series of such movements which act upon us as cross-re- lations, and of which the first (a and b) are less distinct than those at c and d, because the cross-relation in the latter is in the outer voices. Why does not the intermediate chord destroy the harshness of the cross-relation 1 Firstly, because the flowing voices e\!-d-c, g-f-e, &c., are recog- nized at once as phrases belonging together, and because e|)-i^c, as well as formerly, is considered as a melody of C minor, while g-f-e belongs to C major. For the same reason the phrases b and f, in which passing-notes take the place of intermediate chords, make no favorable impression. Secondly, because the dominant chord is not sufficient to dis- tinguish major and minor, belonging as it does to both modes. 186 CHAPTER III. FORMATION OF NEW PASSAGES WITH THE AID OF FOREIGN CHORDS. Every introduction of a foreign chord can be considered as a new harmonic design, and can be employed by itself, or in con- nection with other chords, for the formation of new passages. We know already how to go to work ; and we require only a prac- tice of the same, in order to become familiar with the various chords. For this purpose only we give below a few examples. We have already been made acquainted with the modulation in the dominant. Continuing it, we 259. ascend from every new key into its dominant. Simultaneously with this, the chords change in positions and Inversions, and it is easily seen that the same can be done in various manners. The modulation into the key of the minor third above, issuing from C, would lead us to E\,, -)g- i fetEzgx s::ai r i^:g=: r ri-p -4- -p- we have carried the design straight through. But is it proper at .\, b, c, and D, to deviate from the rules of the dominant chord and the dominant triad! to omit the resolution of /J-a-o into g-b-d? to have the seventh c as- cend to d! to double the third, or to lead it now above, then below ? These deviations, too, like those in No. 271, and similar ones formerly mentioned, are hidden and justified by the analogy and the firm progression of the whole passage. At a and b the actual resolution-chord occurs — merely later and in a diflterent position — and we shall soon learn that this, is tl e case too at c and D. 194 FROM A SINGLE DESIGN, i. e. from succession of two dominant chords — or more properly from the passing over a single tone — that, in No. 271, instead of taking c b\, as at a, we have taken Sb at once, as at b. 280. $ ^C2. ^^ -33: I I r and we have again an illustration of the infinity of that tonical development in which every step hrings us a new series of forma- tions. Considering again that so many septime and nonachords, together with the diminished triad, obey A SINGLE LAW, which, though given only with the dominant chord, was already indicated in the second harmonic mass and the second position of the scale, we cannot but acknowledge the intrinsic unity which runs through the whole tone-development. We can, therefore, justly call the dominant chord ,. THE origin of HARMONIC MOTION. Its first inclination is towards the tonic, to which it drags the no- nachords and all the derived chords ; then, it leads us with its appendix from one key into the other ; finally, after its once re- nouncing the return into its tonic, its motion is unbounded ; for each of the passages originating from it, finds in its elements neither rest nor end, but drives us incessaptly through all the degrees of the scale, until we arbitrarily rest, or seize a tonic har- mony. Equally just is the designation of the tonic triads AS SEAT OF REPOSE. They are the goal, the actual end of all harmonic motion, as they (particularly the major triad) were the beginning. They, for themselves, have no stimulus for motion ; each stands there by itself, without the necessity of moving into another chord. Therefore, with the exception of the dominant chord, they pro- duce no new chords, and no necessarily connected harmonic pas- sages ; their most flowing combination, the sext chords are merely mehdically (by the parallel direction of all or most voices), not 19S harmonically connected ; for none of its chords has a tone in com- mon with the next succeeding one. Now, for the first time, we can fully appreciate the name DOMINANT. The tone so called reigns over, and leads every tone-combination and tone-motion; it is the centre around which from the two first harmonies to the end of all tone-motion, harmonic sequences and modulations turn. The greatest motion of the triad we can oppose to it and its harmony would be a succession of sext chords, diatonic as in No. 167, or chromatic, as here 281. But in the latter case it is evident that the stimulus of this mo- tion is not properly harmonic, but merely melodic. The chord c-e-ff has no relation to f'a\}-d]) ; consequently no inclination to move into or towards it. The separate voices only move diatonically or chromatically up and down ; but exactly because of the regu- lar manner in which this is done, the chords which they form are at least melodically connected. 196 CHAPTER IV. VARIABLE MODULATIOirS.* By this name we shall designate such means of modulation as can lead into more than one key, according to the view which we take of their relation. We turn our attention here par- ticularly to two chords. A. — The diminished s^time chord. Of this chord we said already, (page 169) that it is the clear- est designation of a key ; clearer than the dominant chord be- cause it designates even the species of key, (major or minor) while the dominant chord leaves the species undecided. But owing to a peculiarity of which we shall speak now, this very chord becomes what we just designated a means of variable modulation. The diminished septime chord, as we know, consists exclusively of minor thirds, for instance, in minor of b-d, d-f, and f-ah. When we invert this chord, (for instance, place the b above ah), the two tones form the interval of a superfluous second, which is equivalent to a minor third. Now, when this inverted tone, b is enharmonically changed into a minor third c we have again a succession of three minor thirds, d-f, f-a]), and ab-cl> instead of b ; consequently a new diminished septime chord, which is only dis- tinguished from the inversion of the first (quint-sext chord) by the name of one tone, but by no means in the actual pitch or tone- contents. And since this proceeding can be applied to every dim- inished septime chord, it follows, 1. That the inversions of the diminished septime chords sound like a fundamental chord. 2. That every inversion of it can be considered as a new dimin- ished septime chord. 3. That every diminished septime chord contains in its tones three others, that consequently there are only three tonically dif- ferent septime chords in our system, while of every other species of chords can be found twelve. * See Appendix (J. 197 The first can be said of no other chord ; the second causes that with every inversion, by merely changing a name, we arrive in a new key. Here, at a, 282. £], Dh or Cjj we see the diminished septime chord, b-d-f-a},, leading to minor. At B we see the quint-sext chord of the same, d-f-a\)-h, by the en- harmonic change of a single note 6 in ct, assume the form of a new diminished septime chord (ci^ab-cb), which leads us to ^|j minor The quint-sext chord of this new septime chord (or the terz-quart chord of the first) is again (at c) enharmonically changed into a new diminished septime chord, /ialj-cb-ebb, which would lead us to Q\3 minor. But in order to facilitate the writing of it, we change the whole chord enharmonically into e{{-^|-5-rf, and arrive thus in F% minor. At d we take the quint-sext chord, g\-h-i-e\, (sounding like the second inversion of our first chord) change the e| again into f, and thus obtain the fourth septime chord, g\-h-d-f, which leads us to A minor. Now, since neither change of name nor inversion alter the actual effect of the chord, we can represent the same results at once, thus : I IlJ J" I 283. We need hardly mention that these modulations can be efiected in every inversion and every position, and that each of these sep- time chords can lead to major as well as minor. The industrious student will practice all. To the above three observations we will now add a fourth one, equally simple and productive : "The seventh of the diminished septime chord (the minor ninth of the nonachord), has its position a half step above the octave ; therefore, if it descends a half step it would fall into the oc- tave." Consequently every diminished septime chord can, by means of 198 the descension of the seventh, be changed into a dominant chord, (or rather a quint-sext chord of the same), for instance b-drf-a)} in h-d-f-g. This gives us the above four modulations with a circuitous course of the dominant chords, Here we have obtained the above results by lowering one tone of the chord, consequently increased the distance of it just so much from the other tones. But the same is the case when we retain one tone and elevate the three otlftrs a half-step. This gives us four modulations, to D\), E, Q, and B\) major or minor. Here we have led upwards three tones of the chord; we will now attempt it with all four tones down or upwards, 286. i &e. iffi^ ^ E2^ % "^ i^ -^ % :fe Ac. :^MP^- leaving it to the student to carry it out through the various posi- tions. Here, be it observed, we meet again upon harmonic pas- sages or sequences, the single chords of which have as little relation to each other as those of No. 167 and which are admissible on ac- count of the then-mentioned m.elodic connection. With every step we arrive here at a new diminished septime chord, with which we can repeat the operation of No. 281. If this were the case, the seventh would twice descend a halfstep, (once according to No. 286, and again as in No. 284), the other tones would follow as in No. 286. Let us do this all at once : — The seventh may descend a whole step, and other tones a half step ; this gives us four new modulations to .5, D, F, and A), major or minor. 199 Of course the same proceeding can be carried out in an opposite direction ; one tone may ascend a half-step while others as- cend a whole step. 288. i^^^ Here we have again four new modulations to B, F, A\), and G, and it remains for the student to carry it out in other, per- haps more favorable positions. Thus the simple diminished septime chord leads us immedi- ately, or by means of an assistant chord into all twelve major or minor keys, and to most of them in more than one way. B. — The dominant chord. Already in Nos. 154, 155, and 188, our third and seventh of the dominant chord have risked, under cover of the remaining voices, some deviating steps ; at No. 271 we have arbitrarily changed the resolution of the third, and thus have arrived at a new dom- inant chord, and consequently at a new key (that of the subdom- inant). Let us now pursue the opposite. We proceed (at a) from one dominant chord into another, vis. ; that of the dominant. 289, $ ^S©;. _£2_ -59- li^ fro^-. The third pursued here its natural course, but the seventh was elevated, and the fifth and fundamental tone have also pur- sued a different course. This proceeding is based more upon our pleasure than any law of nature, and is only admissible because of the near relation of key. It is but rarely that a continuation of the same (as at b) is applicable. But we will attach to these some other nearer deviation. 200 291. A At A / goes properly to e, 6 to c, d to c or e ; it seems as if it were going to be c-e-g. But g goes to a, and in- instead of the tonic triad, we have the triad of a before us, which, perhaps, remains C major-, perhaps causes an ac- tiial modulation to A minor. In the same manner at b and c, we resolve the dominant chord into c-e])-a\) or a, instead of c-e])-g. We might excuse these deviations by imagining them as omissions of c-e-g, or c-e\)-g, as illustrated by d ; but the near relation of the keys justifies this proceeding in itself. We will now add to these deviations a few free resolutions of the dominant chord and the diminished septime chord, which might have been mentioned earlier, but will certainly be better comprehended here. 5 W •292. -&- E -iS^ :iES^^=g=± ^g=~ .a. s- m. ^^ s -e- s- -& At A the seventh of the dominant chord remains, while the other tones pursuing their regular course, form with it another chord, until finally in the last chord the seventh obtains its due. At B we neglect even this ; for g-l-d-f apparently proceeds to i?' mi- nor, while in reality we merely go to the subdominant of C minor. At c, D and.E, the fifth/ (the seventh in the nonachord) does not pursue its natural course to e, but goes far beyond into the fundamental tone. By this means we are enabled to double it. (k)* * See Appendix H. 201 CHAPTEE V. GENERAL ORDER OF CONSTRUCTION. The last and most important use of modulation into foreign keys, consists in its enabling us to form more firm and more ex- tended constructions, than we could formerly, in the compass of a single key. Though this is rather too soon to think of composi- tions which require a more firm and extended modulation, we will take the opportunity of exhibiting at least its principles. The harmonies of one single key permitted us in reality noth- ing more than to form a period of thesis and anti-thesis and coda or codas. In the duophonic composition we elevated this thesis and anti-thesis to a first and second part ; but this, in reality, is a mere extension of compass. The first part was only rhythmi- cally satisfactory ; in tonical respect it was by no means so well constructed, for its end we had merely the half cadence on the second harmonic mass. But this second mass has long since become the triad of the dominant which reminded us of the key of the dominant and served as close of the thesis. There remains now for us but one step ; we take instead of the mere triad of the dominant, the key of the dominant for the close of our first part. Thus anticipating, we have already, in No. 257, closed the thesis with a modulation into the dominant ; but the close was rhythmically imperfect. Here we have then A. — The first perfect construction of a two-part composition. The first part, as a whole, ends with a full cadence ; but this cadence is not in the principal tone, but altogether in another key ; and thus with all its completeness at the close, it still does not end satisfactorily, and leads us to expect a return to the principal tone. And now comes the second part as something expected, and leads us back to the principal tone, in order, there to end the whole satisfactorily. 202 The first is progression, elevation into a higher key ; the second part has the return to the principal key. It is therefore again the fundamental form ot page 81, though carried out with higher and richer means. The above is the general rule for major. Thus the first part of a composition in C major will end in G major. This is the near- est, and suificient until larger and freer formations lead us further. In minor, this modulation from minor to minor would add gloom to gloom ; for the minor triad, as we have seen already, is neither clear nor sure like the major triad, but as it were, has been developed from the latter by the depression of the third. That which characterises the triad is characteristic of the key also. Nor is the minor key so intimately connected with its dominant as the major key. For instance, in major, the dominant triad g-b-d indicates at once the key of G major. , Not so with minor ; for the actual triad of the dominant in minor, (for instance in A minor «-5'|-S) by no means indicates the minor mode of the dominant. Therefore, the modulation in minor does not generally turn into the minor mode of the dominant, but prefers to go into the nearest-related major key ; for instance, from A minor to C ma- jor. This is the regular progression of the modulation, which we shall follow until weighty reasons and more extended formations justify us in deviating from this rule. Our first construction in two parts would therefore be represented in the following sketches For major — 293, $ I ■e- -&- ~P- gd- S -s- ■p- — 1 -s? -ig- ^^E f^ ■^- and for minor- f S-&- 203 294. i _ss_ rw tp=^±y -p- $ SSSl i ¥ i: The two parts appear here in the original length of 8 mea- sures each ; the first is divided into thesis and antithesis, of the second we know not yet whether to give it such a division or not. The tonic harmony begins here the first part: it is needless to repeat that we might also commence with another. The the- sis of the first part, according to rule, ends in the principal tone. After that we leave the principal tone and move towards a higher key in which the part is to end. B. — Second two-part construction^ We have now, by means of a full cadence, made a whole of the first part. But this whole, in its nature, is one-sided ; a contin- uous elevation — a start, as it were up to the final point. It is true the second part brings a second motion ; i. e. back to the quiet of the first beginning. But the second part is to a degree sep- arated from the first. Thus the character of the first part disagrees with the meaning of a close, which ought to be quieting and soothing. How can we now unite these two essentials — the elevation of the first part and yet a satisfactory close ? According to the fun- damental principles of all tone-motion, the close ought to fall into a tone lower than the one in which the movement led it. But we cannot alter the close, without falling back upon the principal tone. Consequently the alteration must take place in the move- ment of the first part. We lead the movement BEYOND ITS ACTUAL GOAL, from C major, for instance, to Z* major; aud now we can fall upon the actually wanted key of the dominant, and have thus 204 united elevation and depression, and gain a perfectly quieting, soothing close. If the same proceeding should be applied in minor, the modula- tion must first be led into the dominant of the parallel key, and finally into the latter ; in A minor, for instance, fij-st to G major and then to Cmajor. But this impulse seems here to be less for- cible ; for the felevation in minor rests less upon the elevation into a higher key, than upon the transition into the clearer and more vigorous major. In the second part, also, we discover now an unsatisfactory move- ment towards the end. The second part follows its original des- tination, to the quiet of the principal tone. But it would be bet- ter if, as the actual ending of a whole, it had somewhat more vigor and decision. It ought to contain an elevation and stUl fall upon the principal tone. In order to achieve this we pass on to the subdominant, (too low, in fact) and now we can effect an elevation into the princi- pal tone. Below we give a modulatory sketch tor constructions in major, ^ -e- „ 1^^ — , "Of^ J* V d 4,V0. , ). 1 1 ' -, a rJ p 1 ■ 2 6 bt 6 'S }4 4 7 /■ y rj » )• 1 "-"S3 I 1 b5 b7 bi6 7 6 4 and in minor. oo/* ' V r^ 'J f_J 1 \ ^ r^ ''\ * ^ p-l 6 6 7 4 a J- ^- 'V~^ - M^ ■ — ' 1- 1 ' — ' — P 1 d- J — Sat^ LL. -e3- a 6 6 6 t {4 4 ? C. — Further extension of modulation. Until now we have combined the principal key with the key of 205 the dominant, or with the parallel key, as the nearest and most appropriate steps. Afterwards we introduced the dominant key of the dominant, or of the parallel, and the subdominant. If we were to go still further, we would again seize the nearest related keys ; these are the parallel keys of the principal tones and of the two dominants. But we know already that we can choose more distant keys without touching upon the nearer ones. Our present means are by no means so profuse that they should require a further extension of modulation. The second manner of construction, or even the first, will be perfectly sufficient ; only in passages (sequences) we shall be able to use richer and more extended modulations. The unity of our well-rounded phrases would be destroyed by too great an abundance of modulation into distant keys. But if it is our object to give to these phrases a richer and more extensive modulation, at the same time avoiding the danger of vagueness, we have but to remember the already mentioned CODAS, (page 86) which might repeat the final phrase, with or without alteration. By such a proceeding we not only gain on space, but the very repetition serves to strengthen the ending. In that case a more digressive modulation is less objectionable, because whatever in it leads away from the principal tone, is made harmless by the repetition of the ending, which of course makes the principal tone again more conspicuous. D. — The interrupted cadence. Formerly we had for our codas (page 86) no other means of connection than to, represent the first ending imperfectly. Now, the licenses of the dominant chord give us new means to avoid the actual close in the principal tone, and to introduce the coda, or codas, until finally we end with a full and perfect cadence. For this purpose we make use of one or the other of the free resolu- tions of the dominant chord. Thus, for instance, after a full pre- paration of a close in c. 206 297. ^ -^=$=f=^^^ 'P-'P- we could go to the triad of A or ^b, or to any chord which would bring with it a coda, and finally a principal cadence. We know already (page 86) that we can apply two or more codas in suc- cession, and that they can be eflfected by renewed avoidance of the final cadenoei Such preventive cadences are called " Interrup- ted cadences." The imperfect cadences, too, which we have for- merly (page 118) seen, belonging to this category, when they take the place of a perfect cadence and cause the addition of a coda. 207 CHAPTER VI. ABEUPT MODXILATION. The diflerent manners of modulating which we have learned thus far, are fully sufficient for all the constructions capable of being formed with our present means. But since our object for the present is to prepare means and foundations for future, more extensive formations, we will pass our self-proposed boun- daries in order to produce such new formations as can easily be derived from what we have learned. Until now we have effected our modulations by chords which signified more or less distinctly, that we had left the one key and modulated into another. By the transitive chord we renounced, as it were, the key which until then was the field of modulation ; at the same time our transitive chord had always more or less connection with the preoeeding chords. If we had ended the first piece, instead of modulating into another key, we could have begun a second piece in any other key without the necessity of a modulation. From the above we conclude that — when a phrase ends, as it were, a succeeding phrase, as if it were a new one, can, without transition, begin in another key. Here we have a phrase 298. M 1 ^ r which ends in G major. One voice only retains a tone in some rhythmical form or other ; in other wordSj we have to expect after the end, a continuation, a new phrase, or perhaps a mere repeti- tion of the former one, and the retained tone is the connecting link between the two phrases. This tone, without reference to its for- mer harmonic relation, can now become a fundamental tone, 208 third, fifth, seventh, major or minor ninth, of any septime or no- nachord in which it is inherent, and consequently can prepare SIX different modulations, each to major or minor ; 299 C Ab F D or Bb or or .B. At No. 298 we retained the fundamental tone ; but we could also have retained the third or fifth, and applied it in the same manner. This gives for the three tones eighteen modulations, less one ; for the fifth considered as fundamental tone of the dom- inant or nonachord leads into no new key. But since we considered the phrase No. 298 as concluded, we require no transition ; the retained tone can immediately again become fimdamental tone, third or fifth of a new tonic triad, in a new key. G minor E minor E\) C i --^■ :&« O minor 5 major 5 minor ^ lis=F4 G Git E IL- ^e- E major D minor D major. B\> %- ■¥, -s- M »E « W This gives us again twelve modulations (not counting the repe- titions of those already counted) into major or minor. In all these cases, it is true, the remaining tone was the con- necting link of the harmony. But we have depended more on the fact that the previous phrase was closed, and that the har- mony had ceased. We will now in reality depart for a time from the harmony. We will change No. 298 into the following, 301. — "J— tl d J 1 >-a»- t-^ 209 and after the perfect, ending of the harmony we continue^ in a monophonic or octaye passage up to. any particular tone, in this case it would perhaps.be/. This/ can again be part of a domi- nant chord, a nonachord, or any chord derived from the former two; and thus, we could have after the above passage transitions into six different major or minor keys. 303. B\, o\, E\, A\, A Or the same tone.can at, once. be. part of a new tonic triad, J*" major J minor Vt major jyxaxaax 303. i ii ^ I£2I m %%. and, therefore, again lead into three major or minor keys, among •which there are four which we have not reached in No. 802. And since we are not absolutely bound to attach our new phrase to the tone/ since we can stop at any tone of our tone-system, it is evident that there exists no key which could not in this man- ner be attached to the preceding one. But all these harmonies and keys, at which we arrived in Nos. 300 and 302, have not the slightest harmonic connection with the preceding chord g-h-d. They are justified by this very disconnection, by our •purposely resigning the harmonic connection, and they are connected with what preceded by the mere thin thread of the melody. At last we have arrived at the point where we can resign even this last connecting link, and enter a foreign key without any mediation.. Here is an illustration. The second measure closes in C. The cadence is full and perfect ; the rhythm only leads us to expect a continuation. And imme- diately we continue, without preparation, in a foreign key. By 210 -what right ? Because this continuation is a phrase by itself, as it were ; a new piece which takes up the thread of the previous phrase at a different place, and perhaps in a different sense. And it is exactly because the continuation in the third measure is con- sidered as a new phrase, that we consider the new chord H\)-g-b\f at once as a tonic chord, though the key of JE}} is only indi- cated by the dominant chord b\)-d-f-a\>, which occurs three notes later. If the continuation should not correspond with our expectation, if we should continue thus : 305, $ fT^ feE h-^f^ and turned to 5 b major, we should still consider the first chord as tonic of ^\)f and the second as a second modulation into £\> major. 211 CHAPTER VII. ORDER OF MODULATION FOR MORE EXTENDED COMPOSITIONS. One more rule can be derived so easily from the previous prin- ciples of modulation, that we retain it at once, though its full im- portance will only become evident in more extended forms. It has reference to the order of modulation which should be observed in forms which combine several phrases in various keys into one whole, and is a continuation of the fifth chapter, in which we men- tioned the order of construction for compositions of two parts. At that time the transition in major into the key of the domi- nant or parallel was the means and sign of the close of a part. The seizing and combining of various keys gams additional im- portance, when several phrases are to be connected in one piece, or when others have to be repeated in a different sense. In such a case every key mentioned in the laws of construction becomes in time the field fOr a new phrase, and influences its relative keys. At first appears the actual principal key, and demands room for development. If the association with another key is absolutely necessary we must take the subdominMit, for the dominant will soon be a principal sphere. After this comes the dominant as principal sphere of modula- tion, preceded by its dominant. Its subdominant is the princi- pal key itself, which has just been passed, and will return again at the end ; and consequently would be altogether unnecessary here. Therefore, if we must extend our modulation we shall have to select the parallel of the dominant, as its nearest re- lation. The third principal sphere belongs to the key of the subdomi nant, which prepares (page 200) the close. An extension of mod- ulation in this third sphere would lead us to its parallel ; for, its dominant would be the principal key, which must follow soon after under any circumstances, and its subdominant would lead us off too far, without bringing anything new. And now shall this par- allel occur before or after the subdominant. 212 We would prefer the latter, because we cannot reach the par- allel without passing through the subdoi/iinant, and can only be comprehended as belonging to the latter. But this analogical po- sition would place a new key where we want it least ; where the elevation from the subdominant to the principal key is of impor- tance. And this must decide us to have the subdominant prece- ded by its parallel. The close, of course, is made in the principal key. There is but one relative key which we have forgotten thus far — the parallel of the principal key. It would be proper to attach it to the principal key, either at the beginning or at the close between the subdominant and the principal key. At either place it would stand in the way of proper elevation. Its best po- sition would, therefore, be where all the parallel keys meet ; here we find a mass of minor modulations which, by the intervention of the principal parallel, becomes first duly organised. As a summary of all the above we give now a diagram for the order of modulation in major. Major. Minor. Major. Cmajor, JD major, G major, jF minor, A minor, 3 minor, i*" major, Cmajor. Everywhere we have' an analogical progression, sufficient con- nection, and, in the combination of major and minor, a simple and vigorous distribution of masses. Were we tobreak up these ma- jor and minor masses, and intersperse them at random, none of the keys would achieve its full efficacy, and the modulation would become unstable and restless. The order of modulation in minor, naturally resists such a sure and simple combination, corresponding thus perfectly with the gloomy and undecided character of the minor keys (page 202.) The cause of this lies in the fact, that, immediately after the prin- cipal key, the second sphere is occupied by a key of a different mode. To this parallel key we could attach the dominant, (or rather the parallel of the principal key's dominant) and afterwards the dominant of the principal key itself. Then the key of the subdominant and its parallel would naturally follow, and we would have the following diagram : A minor, major, G major, E minorf, F major, D minor, A minor, in which we perceive at once that the parallel of the sub-domi- 213 nant (at f ) does not attach itself as easily as the others ; — this might be obviated by placing between them the principal key, or by omitting altogether the disturbing key, or in various other ways. Both these orders of modulation have another property, which gives freshness and decision to their effect. Uach key, with the exception of the principal key, appears but once. It follows from the whole tendency of our work, that these or- ders of modulation are by no means absolute laws, but that other, deviating orders can also be attempted. But the principle will remain the same throughout. The last particularly, the non-re- petition of a key, can rarely be neglected without serious disad- vantage. If we deviate, therefore, from the above, and give to any key a different position, we must take care to adjust the other keys accordingly. If, for instance, we concluded to end a first part of major in the parallel instead of the dominant of the principal key, that parallel must not occur again afterwards, though the dominant would find a position at some other place. The following order would perhaps come into existence : C major, A minor, D minor, G major, E minor, i^'major, C major. Passages, whose object is merely to touch the harmonies of dif- ferent keys, as a matter of course, are not tied to this order of modulation. Keys, too, which are merely passed over can occur at any place. But let us consider now from a different point of view what we have achieved by our order of modulation. Not merely the passages lead us through different keys, but the actual spheres of modulation are different keys, and each one fills an important part of the composition : the thesis of the first, and the anti-thesis of the first or second part, &c. The whole composition, as it were, is merely an extensive passage — simply its aim is fixed. PASSAGES OP PHRASES. In reality. No. 266 is already such a passage ; it consists not like others, (for instance, No. 270), of a series of well connected single chords, but of two and two harmonies : the dominant chord and the succeeding triad. In like manner each phrase, by repeti- 214 tioii on different degrees, can be made a passage, or a phrase chain. Here, for instance at a and b. 306. we have such chains before us, each consisting of a combination of four chords. Phrases of greater length, as a matter of course, can also serve as designs for such chains. Thus we have here 307. i^i_4ifMJ: ^^m^ a passage before us, the phrase of which originated from the de- sign, No. 306 — A, and which regularly descends a third. But even here we see, already, that phrases which are well rounded in themselves, do not require a frequent repetition. The phrases (No. 306 — A and b), were insignificant in themselves, and only the repetition made them a more significant whole. The phrase in No. 307, however, is in itself more rounded and satisfactory ; the first repetition makes it moie vigorous, and accidentally rep- resents it in minor ; the second repetition will already be con- sidered superfluous, and in order to invigorate it anew, we have placed it in a higher octave. It is also apparent, that passages, if formed of more extended phrases, are apt to get too broad and expanded. 215 CHAPTER VIII. THE PEDAL-POINT. We have now developed a mass of harmonies, and perceived the possibility of combining any keys with all their modulations into a single whole without destroying its unity. But even making but a limited use of these means, there comes into existence a balance of motive power against the calming mass of the princi- pal tone, which is much stronger than that of the scale against the tonic (page 72). At that time we found in the first har- monic mass a succor for the tonic. It is necessary that we should now find a similar succor for the principal tone. Where is, in reality, the beginning and origin of all motion ? It is in the dominant chord ; we have perceived this in our de- velopment and have distinctly acknowledged it (page 194). But the dominant is not merely the basis of the dominant chord, the nonachords and the derived septime chords, but it is also the fundamental tone of that triad which we consider at one time as a harmony of the principal key, at another time as a tonic harmony ; it can be fifth of the tonic triad of the principal key, or the basis of a quarUsext chord. It could bear, at least, the following chords : 308. Such an accumulation of harmonies would fiirnish a much more weighty return to the principal key, than the mere domi- nant chord, however long continued. But we must proceed. The dominant chord itself is nothing but an issue from the tonic (page 76) resting upon a tone of its harmony. At page 91 we have already learned to express this origin in tones, and to introduce the dominant chord simultaneously with the tonic: 216 309. $ But since every tone can become a new tonic, we can con- sider our dominant, too, as new tonic, and build upon it a domi- nant chord. 310. i ^ Only now the dominant has reaUy become a tonic, and we can combine it in this capacity, and in its original capacity {g as tonic of Gf major, and ff as dominant of C major,) in the following harmonic formation : 311. or with the addition of the already known septime and nona suc- cessions in a stiU richer formation. 312. in which the most essential of all modulations, The tonic triad as quart«ext chord, The dominant chord of the principal key. The dominant triad as harmony of the principal key. The dominant triad as tonic harmony of another key have been combined. But we have seen already in our order of construction, how the dominant, when it becomes the tonic of a new key, (page 163) brings with it the key of its own dominant ; and having just now considered the dominant G, as a new key, we can open the way for its dominant. 217 313. i =«: r- f And thus, chord after chord is drawn into the whirlpool of the dominant chord, and ascending and descending 314. passages which are a condensed recapitulation of the whole mod- ulation are built upon the single dominant, and are thus led into the tonic harmony of the principal key.* Such chain of harmony is called a PEDAlj-POINT, and is the last and strongest means to make a decisive and vigor- ous return to a principal key, after a rich and extensive modula tion has led us far from it. While in the pedal-point the chain of chords returns to the prin- cipal tone, the sustained bass serves to connect the chords built upon it. Thus we see in the pedal-point, in two respects, one of the most energetic tone formations ; firstly as the basis of a well- closed series of chords, working towards a certain aim, and sec- ondly as the connecting link and support of these chords. It is exactly for this, tha,t the pedal point is only then in its right place, when it is intended to counterbalance a rich and ex- tended modulation ; then only the sustained bass serves as a rest ing place for the mind and for the tones. But as every dominant can stand as tonic, every tonic can stand as dominant'; consequently we can develope a pedal-point upon the tonic. Uniting, then, the pedal points of dominant and tonic, * How can we explain the chord a-ci-e-g in No. 314? By, itself, alone, it certainly does not agree with the pedal tone ji; we can, therefore, only speak of its position in the above modulation. We have considered the first chord as the tonic of 5 o ■S'CZb ^ » h 1 1 s 1^ (2 1 »■ :S=L J_ Here, too, we meet with suspensioas which resemble some of our former chords. Their treatment, however, proves them to be suspensions. Having become familiar with these two species of suspensions, nothing need prevent us from attempting the two simultaneously. 339. Wz P t -rjr Here we have combined suspensions from above and below, and have attached them to our septime and nonachords. By doubling the intervals we have suspended the whole chords, as it were, and the fundamental bass only progresses unobstructedly. Seventh and ninth become suspensions from above. The third becomes a suspension from below. The fifth, according to its nature, and by means of duplica- tion, becomes simultaneously a suspension from above and below. The octave, as future fifch, remains. We need not add that such an accumulation of tones and sus- pensions may appear overloaded, and we can but rarely employ them as we have done here, but using them partly, as here. 340. m * iM BE -s they will be of vast advantage to us. 238 And now we must return to the heading of the whole part, DISPLACEMENT OF CHORDS. Formerly we have looked upon the suspensions in a literally melodic point of view, as the most important, and have acciden- tally acquired some new harmonic formations. Now that we can reconnoitre them fully, and observe their effects upon the harmony, we can see in them A new means, and the strongest means of harmonic connection. Next to that most general connection which chords have on account of their intervals belonging to one and the same scale, there were two means of bringing them in a harmonic relation to each other. Firstly, the mutual tones. But as far as we have seen, they are actually the most ineffective in the new chord. For, on ac- count of their having been in the previous chord, they are less conspicuous than the new tones. Secondly, the necessary progressions to another chord which nature has given to the dominant chord and all its sub-species, though we have occasionally permitted some deviations from the natural progression. ; The Suspension combines both of these means, and strength- ens them too. The suspension-tone, also, has been retained from the previous chord ; but since it absolutely disagrees with the new chord, it monopolizes the attention. The suspension-tone, too, has its decided progression ; but in consequence of its disagreement with the whole new chord — as far as we can judge at present from the nature of the suspension — this progression cannot be post- poned ; the resolution must follow while the new chord is still in existence. Thus, by means of suspensions, we can form harmonic succes- sions firm, unseparable, soldered one to another, and in this capa- city they will be of vast service to us. In the course of our instruction we have only spoken of what was absolutely necessary for the occupation of the student ; we have not even drawn attention to the fact, that the tone of a mel- ody need no longer be considered as an independent tone of the chord, and that, now, it might be considered and treated as a sus- 239 pension. But now, that we have done justice to the nearest and most practical object of our instruction, we must not fail to draw thelattention of the student to some peculiarities. The resolution of the suspension was necessary, in order to ex- plain and justify the discrepancy between the suspension-toiie and the new chord. But this justification can be postponed, by pla- cing between suspension and resolution another, or more chord- tones. Thus, here at A, the suspended e reaches correctly into d, but not before the third of the new chord found its way between suspension and res- olution. At B, in the above, we find even three tones between the suspension and its resolutions. Beethoven, in his Sonata Op. 101, has gone even farther. i A t^^i=H -fi @W ^^^^Ih&^ The first measure closes with the quart-sext chord «-a-c| ; the suc- ceeding ineasure begins with thS dominant chord e-g\-b-d, in which the a of the first chord is retained, and must resolve into ^ff. But before doing this the a goes first to the foreign tone/|, then to J, and finally to ^^f. If it were at all important to reduce every new formation to fundamental forms, we might easily explain the above by imagining the chord /|-(i-c|-e, but the explanation of that/jt is here of minor importance, the retarded resolution of the suspension is our chief topic. The whole reminds us of the retarded resolution of the third, seventh, and ninth, in the septime and nonachords. Thus much of the resolution of suspensions. In regard to their * See Appendix K. 240 preparation we must remember that a succession can only be un- derstood, inasmuch as its tone or tones have appeared as harmonic tones in a former chord, and have stretched over, as we'said before, into the new one. This was in fact, its resolution, and we ad- mitted that it had to take place in the same voice ; preparation^ suspension, and resolution are in reality nothing else but the pe culiar progression of a voice. But now we can derive from ii many new and freer formations. Here m BE ~^' ^ ^ iE^^^^m^^^. ±z at A, we see the chord g-b-d with a suspended c ; it was in the first chord, even in the ?ame octave, but in a different voice. The suspension-tone at sis not even in the same octave," but in a lower one. At c the suspension-tone does not even exist in the first chord, but our experience and sensation lead us to imagine the chord c-e-ff. It is easily seen that in all these cases the preparation of the suspension does exist, though only in imagination. We cannot say that such formations are inadmissible or wrong ; but we must admit that there is something estranging m them. And, finally, we might allow a suspension without any preparation. -^ 'ff ^ f F=F m ^ ff II ' y^ c^" jr~s BE ■2?". r if we aimed at all at a decisive, startling combination of tones. These unprepared ■ suspensions might serve also for a milder, anxious expression ; for instance, 341 P w ^ -zsa w But often the apparent irregularity lies only in the manner of writing it. Phrases like the following, 1= J^^^^P^ 1^0 ^^ - O^^g — ^^s- containing apparently unprepared suspensions, might have been written thus : E=^ 221 J2—-S. ^i=: -G- 3 and can in that manner be easily explained. But we must return again to the resolution of the suspension. It ought to take place while the chord into which the suspension has found its way is still in existence. Here, however, -&- W- y=^ -^- -19- i Y P we see the resolution take place on a different chord. The /of the treble ought to resolve into the e of the chord' e-e-^r, and in like manner should the e resolve into the d of the chord g-i-d. Both tones pureue their prescribed course, but in the meantime the chords c-e-g and g-h-d have changed into- cb-c-e and h-d^f. It is sufficient that the resolution is effected on the proper toTie. The chord does not influence it. But there are still more peculiar formations.. We know already of two ways in which to retain a chord while one or two voices progress: — 1, the suspension, and 2, the pro- gression of a voice from oi:e chord-tone to another, (Nos. 59 and ft5.) We need not hesitate to employ the two in succession, as 242 long as either of them, particjilarly the su»pensioiif obtains its due. Here, for instance, the suspension of the treble at a, b, c, and d, is correctly re- solved into the next tone ; but immediately after the resolution the voice passes through several tones of the chord. This cor- responds perfectly to our rules, but since it might often be too diffiised, we will here P i ty^ Jtt E * -^-: i ^^ / -^T i— J^J — 1 J=i-f^ • u- r^ '- ' i=£Etpz= L-lb at once seize the last tone to which the harmonic tones lead and omit the middle tones. It is true, by this omission, we have also omitted the resolution ; instead of the tones c-e-g, we must be 243 contented with the still sounding chord, which though containing the resolution-tone, has it in another voice. But this very defect serves only to isolate the suspension-tone still more, and to make the discrepancy between it and the harmony either milder or stronger. In the above it is not only better to introduce the suspended chord-tone simultaneously wtth the suspension; for instance, tn make the accompaniment of the above thus : ^^ •g--g-- ^?# -^V-fi- m. but the chord-tone m another voice can serve in a degree as the expected tone of the resolution. Here we see agdn a deviation from the first niles of the sus- pension. We see the suspension-tone and the suspended tone at one and the same time, though in diiferent voices. i -'(2- -&- "^ 1 I ^^^ jG^Tn =F=f= ^ BE -e- Z2= The distance modifies the disagreement, if it does not obvi- ate it. Finally we must mention an ambiguous form which arises ana- logically from the suspension. Here we see this form twice before us. The g of the treble remains with the chord OrC-e ; in the same manner does the b remain with the chord c-e-g. Were we to consider these tones as suspensions, they could only be from below ; g would resolve into a, and h into c, though the resolution of g would be an octave lower, and 244 that of b retarded by two intermediate tones. But in that case these suspensions i I would be nothing but octaves of another voice dragging after it, and suspension-tone and suspended tone would meet in the same moment. A regular explanation of these tones is absolutely im- possible. But w6 need not bestow too much time or thought upon these formations.. It is sufficient if we have a perfect control over them. Thus much of the suspensions themselves. But we have seen that in all their fornis they have the effect of making the single chord less clear and distinct, because they unite or solder it to another. Therefore, they serve as modifications of such relations as, when given in their nudity, as it were, produce a disagree- able effect. This last remark reminds us of the reputed octave- and quint-successions. Let us glance first at FIFTHS MITIGATED BY SUSPENSIONS. Here at a, we see an evident quint-succession ; it belongs to the less objec- tionable class, on account of the seventh therein contained, and at B it is still less objectionable on account of the suspension. The following succession i I I f 17" I PT'if^ would be absolutely wrong, if written as at a ; but the suspen- 245 sions at b, soften it to such a degree that we need not hesitate to employ it. It is different with OCTAVES COVERED BY SUSPENSIONS. Here, it may often happen, that suspensions make the evil worse. Thus if here. 1 i I r I i I i at A, the octaves are objectionable ; those at b, on account of the meeting of suspension-tone and suspended tone are still more so. 246 CHAPTER m. ANTICIPATION (ANTICIPATED TONES). What made the suspension comprehensible and sufferable? The fact of its having been a part of the preceding chord. In other words, it finds its explanation and justification in another chord, and in one that has already been heard. / To attempt the reverse, let us now lead a tone into a chord to which it does not belong, and with which it disagrees. But the tone has not remained from a former chord, but has been antici- pated from a future chord. 341, m % ±: ■i^ -^ m We see here that the tone c appears in total contradiction to the chord g-b-d, without any justification of its appearance. The tone d appears in like manner with the chord a-c-e. The succeed- ing chords, only, /jf-o-c and g!^-b-d explain the contradiction. It is clear that such discrepancy, which is not even prepared, must pro- duce a more harsh and decisive effect than the prepared suspen- sion. We have to consider well, therefore, if the introduc- tion of such effects corresponds with the object we have in view. Sometimes it is the consistency in the progression of our voices, which leads us to anticipating tones, as for instance in the following : where the upper voice pursues its own course, and thus blunders 247 upon the tone e, •which belongs to the succeeding chord, c-e-gi, in- stead of the dominant chord which accompanies it. Sometimes the anticipated tone is merely intended to add rhythmical vigor to the succeeding one, and cannot be considered as belonging to the chord in ■which it appears. Thus, in the ancient cadences, 343. ~i\ f= r in which the anticipatory c acts merely rhythmically. Or, by means of anticipation, the figuration of a melody may become more animated, as in the following : 344. i^ — g. — ^ — # — Pis'- f=f^ r r ^ And again these anticipated tones are used^ when one voice makes a decisive entrance. Thus, Spontini, in the overture to his opera. La Vestale, after having closed in F and modulated to D minor, anticipates a tone (6), 345. full two chords, and only justifies it in the third chord. There is no need of searching for such formations, or of dis- covering all possible liberties we might take with these tones. It is best to trust to our inspiration for their development. 248 JVinth Part. The Pass. The suspensions and anticipations were the first step towards the liberation from the triple nature of our chords, and the de- pendency of every tone of the melody upon the harmony beneath it. But in reality this dependency of the melody has not ceased. Tor if the tone of our melody does not belong to the chord be^ neath it, it belongs to either the one before it or after it. Yet we have now at least a choice, and this new liberty has arisen from the harmonic element itself, or, to speak strictly, FROM THE CONNECTION OF THE CHORDS. But we know that in every single chord lies the element of melody ; that we can introduce its tones in melodic form, one after the other. »And this new view of harmonic formations must open to us a new melodic sphere. Here 1 346. f we see the treble pass through all the tones of the chord. It pro^ ceeds, consequently, in thirds. But knowing that the third is in reality nothing but the third degree, and that another degree lies between it and the fundamental tone, can we not include this in- termediate degree in our melody 1 347. We go from e through d to *. Thns we see at once the nature of the pass. The passing-tone does not belong to the harmony ; neither to the present, nor to the preceding, nor to a future one. It is simply a melodic sub- stance, a filling of the melody, a mediation between two tones (c and e). It agrees with the harmony, because it leads from one harmonic tone to another harmonic tone. 249 CHAPTER I. THE DIATONIC PASS. We are already familiar with it. We might have introduced in No. 346 a second passing-tone, from e to g. 348. m Instead of the prolonged tones of the chord we might have re- peated them thus : 349.: Tf=f We see that the chords fall always upon a harmonic tone of the melody. Thus we are led to place the whole scale upon one and the same chord : 350. .^^ n the repetitions of the chord have also been here employed. This leads us to something entirely new. We see that the last chord does not fall upon a harmonic tone of the melody, but upon a passing tone, h. This is not as satisfactory as the former arrangement, though the fourth chord is in reality nothing but a continuation of the same harmony which did not displease us to the tone d,f, and a. Still more strange would this form be, if a new chord should meet with the foreign tone : 351 ^ff 250 but the immediately following harmonic tone (c) balances every- thing in either case. A passing tone, when happening upon the entrance of the chord itself, is called a Participant Tonei^itl'-' Sa.' ■* ''^ Thus in the following example. the twoy^'s are passing-tones, while the two e's are participant- tones, a distinction, however, which we consider as unessential. Had we tried to avoid the participant-tones, we might have achieved the same object by a different rhythmization, perhaps like the following : 353. P ^ Tf *=f ^ sM w^ This has led us to employ two passing tones in succession. In reality we have done this already in No. -349. Let us now con trast the repetitions of one and the same chord : 355, i iS^Eg^ it is nothing essentially different from No. 350, and we see the whole scale accompanied by one single chord, in which we con- sider d, f, a, and b as passing tones. But we are by no means confined to the tonic triad. Here, 356. i ^MM=i I 23 .a. 1 is the ascending and descending scale with the accompaniment of 251 the subdominant and dominant chords, in which we have only- taken care to begin and end on a harmonic tone. Thufs far we have taken all our passing-tones from the reigning scale. These are called Diatonic Passes, and well deserve a thorough practice before we proceed. Above all we must remember that it is immaterial in which voice we introduce the pass. Like the suspensions, they can occur in every voice, and consequently in different voices simulta- neously. The above tells us that every third can be filled up with one passing tone, and every fourth with two, or, to speak strictly, with one passing-tone and one participant-tone. Let us now employ them as often as possible, ' We take again our melody of No. 255 as basis, harmonize it as A simply, and at B we introduce our passing-tones. 357. A. dz ■^.^M^ ■.i- IM f'^mw^F^--^^^ tMi 'i 11 1 1 1 I iJ-J- ^ -0-0 — -»-0:^ ^^ V=^- i fSEi^ tt F i i^ D I J 1 y=ri j#-*— aL ^ l^§fe ? t==|: F Why, at A, have we not filled out the bass ? Because it would have produced a peculiar kind of octaves, 358. i 12*" '^J 252 (1) which are even worse than the open octaves at 2. A similar case would have happened at e between bass and alto. Why, at B, have we not filled out the bass 1 It would not have been wrong : 359. f but the seventh-succession between alto and bass, and the accu- mulation of passing-tones in the three voices, would have given a dragging character to the whole phrase. Why, at c and a have we not filled out the alto 1 Because in the first case we should have caused consecutive fifths between treble and alto. 360. ^^ w and in the latter case between alto and tenor. 253 CHAPTER II. CHROMATIC PASSES AND ASSISTANT-TONES. A. — The Chromatic Pass. Our present means enable us to fill every third and every larger interval with passing-tones. But let us attempt to fill out a smaller interval, the second. With the same right that we seized between c and e the interme- diate tone d, we can now take the tone c| between c and rf, or rfj between d and e. -^^ This gives us much to consider. Firstly, we see passing tones employed, which are foreign to the key. Secondly, we see the small space of a third filled by three passing tones, and thus are led to take the whole chromatic scale upon a single chord. 362. Thirdly, we see among the passing-tones raised degrees which are in the chord in their original form ; for instance, c| against c, ^1 against g. Of course we can also introduce depressed degrees against natural, or natural degrees against pressed or raised de- grees. 254 363. iiitS33= t)- 73SZ S>^ i :^ a -& iatfl ^^ i^ :fe =1= I I II X These formations remind us of our former cross-relations. But such a momentary oross'relation, appearing in an analogical suc- cession, can produce no disagreeable effects ; it is merely a part of the hielody, and by it justified. This teaches us also the proper manner of writing passing'tones. A passing-tone, for instance the c| at a, is nothing '''■$ Bd=^&:j ^ P i I =5F but a leader from one tone (c) into the next one (d); we might say it raises itself until it reaches the d. If, according to this, the passing-tone is nothing but a continuation of the preceding harmonic tone, it should, of course, be called accordingly. Con- sequently c raised to cjj, in order to lead to d; and in the -^ame manner, at b, d descends to d\,, in order to lead to c. But why, in No. 362, have we written b\> instead of a#, as it ought to be according to the above rule t or why in No. 363 have we taken /j) instead of ^rj,, or e?K and c| instead of eb and d\)t Because the strict observance of this rule would lead us to tones too foreign to the original key, and would make the reading of notes more difficult. What we have just now shown in the upper voice can also be done in every other voice. But we must look out, particulaiiy in the middle voices, whether there is room for these passing tones. And since these passes are practicable in every voice, they must be practicable also 365. :^=^^^^^^B3E&=| M\ '^^m 255 m two voices simultaneously, or even in three or more voices : 366. But, of course, the more passing tones we introduce above or below the harmonic tones, the more are the latter placed in the shade, and the more danger is there of causing confiision. And again we return to our phrase of No. 357, in order to in' troduce the chromatic passes too. i JEEJ^^fei^ i '^0-t-f^i—- rr-fi w¥^=-y f^f^F -f- seIe S F- ?^|: ^E£ >J.# -&- -J-. :f: r In order to make this phrase richer, we have introduced some suspensions, but we have by no means exhausted all possible passing-tones. For this would lead us into false progressions, and would overload the phrase with foreign tones. The treatment of the thesis may serve as an example. 368. m^ ^^^s i- 256 With the introduction of the diatonic passes we ran the risk of spoiling an originally correct phrase by consecutive fifths and other bad relations. The chromatic passes add another danger — that of accumulation of foreign tones and cross relations. B. — The Assistant Tone. A pass supposes always a vacuum, a step in the melody wide enough to admit of an intermediate tone. Between c and e we could place the d; between c and d we had room at least for cj( ; between c and e| there is no vacuum to be filled, consequently we can have no pass. And yet there may be at such places a necessity of interposing a tone ; the very effects of the pass would lead us to think of this. We gain by the pass, as we have just explained, the possibility of filling up larger intervals' by interposing smaller ones. But these passes serve also to increase the rhythmical anima- tion. Here, for instance, i the half notes of a are resolved into quarter-notes at b, and into eighth-notes at o. But between e and / we can gain no such ani- mation by the mere passing-tone, because there is not room for one. It is true, we might avail ourselves of tone repetition, or of a harmonic by-tone : 370. =>^ ^ But for many reasons neither of these expedients might be of any use. The first might seem poor, and the second might be preven- 257 ted by the progression of the bass, which, too, might go from ciof. For such cases we require a particular aid. We derive it thus : The phrase a 371. ! 1 372- ^r*i I -9- is filled up by passing-tones at b. The d led to e and back to c. But must we absolutely go to e 1 We can change our mind and return before we get there, as at c and d. At e and f we have made use of half steps. Such tones are called Assistant-tones. They can be either steps or half steps, ascending or descending. Half steps are generally best for ascending. We shall have more use for these assistant-tones at a future time. At present it will be sufficient for the student to practice chromatic passes, with the occasional introduction of assistant- tones. 258 CHAPTER III. THE KESULT3 OF PASSES. The results of these passes consist principally in the additional means acquired ; then in the capability of making our voices more connected and more flowing than we were able since we deserted onr monophony. It is true that by a too frequent application of the passes, our melodies can now become too round and polished, as they were formerly too angular and rough. But our only object, for the present, is to practice these passes, and at a future time we shall be able to to judge to what degree we can make use of them. But the greatest advantage obtained is that we are no longer forced to construct a chord for every tone of the melody ; and thus we are liberated at once from the yoke of harmony. Our harmony is now dissolved into four voices, each of which devel- opes itself melodically ; based upon harmony, but not chained to it. This melodic relation can even sometimes be predominant over the harmonic element. Mozart, in the " Magic Flute," in a light and animated triphonio phrase, writes thus : 373. i i: I If. ^ f Z!' ?~K^> It is easily perceived that the two-eighth-notes of the second measure are in reality nothing but the chord ffJ>-d, suspended in the upper voices by a-c and the lower voice passing from b to the d of the next chord. The phrase, originally, was 374. i^^^fc r r ^ f W 259 at A, and according to rule as written at b or c ; but Mozart ■wanted a more flowing progression and he mixed up suspension, and harmonic-tone and passing-tone, A similar proceeding has been applied in the following : 375. W- s r f -r tr ?2I where the simultaneous application of suspension and pass has preserved the flowing progression of all the voices and the dia tonic progression of the bass. But since the passing-tones now actually begin to play a part in the harmony itself, to which, originally, they did not belong, they are also applied, though merely pseudo-harmonic tones, as real harmonic tones. We use them 1, as suspension-tones, by making of the passing-tones at a, for instance, suspensions as at B and c ; 376. P fegM i&t^ IZ± u r r lU^UM^i: ^: "rT --^ r the preparation of which suspensions does not even exist in the choii c-e-g. It will not be difficult to construct similar illustra- tions. Two more illustrations here. 377. Ei ^ -yri&— H- ge \-^ -^ -e>- "cr -cr merely to remind us that even cross-related passes can become suspensions. The passes can also become 2, new chords, or, they can at least disfigure well-known chords to such a 260 degree, that we can use them independently, without regard to their origin. The first of these new chords arises from the pass of the fifth in the major triad. 378. m :|bi- 3E Eti^d=^ f= r The triad has now a superfluous fifth, and owing to this circuni- ' stance this chord is called THE SUPERrLTJOUS TRIAD. It is the only passing-chord which boasts of a particular name. It can be introduced whenever its superfluous fifth has not ap- peared as a previous passing-tone, 379. ,..,1,.,1, b^J,,U.. and it can be used in all its inversions, and for the formation of new sequences. 380. rrr^' Since the dominant chord is nothing but a major triad with added seventh, we can embody with it, also, this superfluous fifth (a), and use the new chord ff-b-d'jf-f independently (b). It fol- lows, as a matter of course, the rules of the dominant chord, with the exception of its fifth, which, owing to its origin, must as- cend. S81. ' '.J MM. -^ f tiP'e—- i^ Knowing, further, that every septftne-chord is nothing but a triad with added seventh, we might apply the same proceeding to the major septime chord. Here 261 382. I M. '^m^- -i ES£ i we have made from the chord c-e-g, the passing-chord c-«-^|, and by adding to it the seventh, we have obtained the septime-chord, (•-e-jijf-6, which we might call the superfluous septime chord, if it were at all necessary to have a name for every new forma- tion. Formerly in No. 378, we altered the dominant chord by eleva- tion of the fifth. Let us now attempt it by depression. 383. E^=^ ibAi ibA.i W--»- m^ f- f^^ We have done it at a ; at b we have placed the passing-tone at once on the place of th^ proper harmonic tone, and thus formed a new chord, g-h-d\,-f, which differs from the dominant chord by its depressed fifth, and by the absolutely necessary descension of that interval. And as we formerly made a diminished triad from the dominant chord, we can now make a triad from our new septime- chord (f) which is even smaller than the diminished triad, and which might, therefore, be called the double-diminished triad, if we were in want of a new name.* If this new chord is to be * The chord d\i-g-i-f (o) boaBted formerly of a high-sounding name. Jnst because the superfluous sixth, ck-b attracted princapal attention, it was called the chord of the superfluous sixth, or some similar name ; and not satisfied with this, the same name was given to another chord, d\>-f-a\i-b, which had altogether a different origin, and thus, sext-chords, terz-quart chords, and quint-sext chords wei'e all thrown into one category. This name is not only superfluous, but it is absolutely unsystematical and confusing. 262 used tetraphonically, it can only be done by the doubling of the ssventh, as at g in the above. But it can easily be seen that not every position of these chords appears favorably. All those positions in which the conspicuous tone (c?l)) is close to the third (6) are unfavorable, because after once exciting our expectation by its strange appearance, it resolves into a tone which has already been obtained otherwise, and thus deceives us. Chords like these, which take their intervals from different keys, can become new means of modulation, or mediation, by trans- ferring to them the freer resolutions of the dominant chord ; for instance, thus : 384. The minor triad, too, has a major fifth, and by transferring to it the elevation of the fifth, we obtain a new chord 385. $ M {g-byd!^) which resembles a well known sext chord {g-h\)-e\/), but which differs from it in its progression, and even leads to a new septime chord : 386. ^ Ife ^-^ r ^ -&- Finally, we are led to harmonic formations, in which the for- merly unlawful quint-succession appears purposely and with good effect. 387. $ ^V5 ^ '!fn- fc 1'^^ iZ- ^- fe t^- •ST "ST -e- "C3" f -xsr We know that the diminished septime chord (b) arises fronj 263 the dominant chord (a). We have also submitted to the suc- cession of heterogeneous fifths. Here now, at c, we have intro- duced the passing-tone ab, and at d follows the chord, /f-ab-c-e^, formed by it. The lower voices form here consecutive fifths, which are by no means disagreeable or inapplicable ; nay, which can even be used, as Mozart has done, and with good effect, in slow movement. 388. *; E :^- m^^ fe i .-■&- But we are led here to an observation which the attentive stu- dent has probably made before us, viz : that the peculiar posi- tion of the chord-tones does much to favor the admissibility and the comprehensibility of these successions. If the foreign tone is too close upon another tone of the harmony, if the two resolve in one and the same tone, the resolution of the chord brings about something so forced and confused that it can almost become in- comprehensible. TJie successions of No. 383 and 386 are well admissible. But the same successions in a different position T T"^ are useless and wrong. Thus, is the passing-chord d^-f-a 389. E^ F=> j tlli T-r ff & quite correct at A and b, while at o it is spoUed by the position. But let us return to No. 388. Why are we justified now in making use of progressions which we formerly denied ourselves? Not merely because we now 264 consider them agreeable and fit for use, but because we have noTf been led to them consistently, ailalogically, instead of owing them to accident. Here is the point whence arises often the greatest error. We say the greatest, because active minds often seize the new and ir- regular instead of the nearest, and thus cut off at once every fur- ther development. But we must warn, also, against slavish obe- dience to the letter. Every artistic nature has within it the im- pulse to free itself and to become independent ; but reason must decide how &r a deviation is admissible. And, finally, we see in the passing-tones 3, the means of modulation, or, at least, the introduction and preparation of transitions. Here 390. P --F Jfl ^ 1^ w we see a phrase beginning decisively in C major, but modulating in the third measure into G major. But already in the second measure does the passing-tone /jf indicate the subsequent G major, so that it hardly requires the dominant chord. ! ' ► J J I ' J_J_ j \ . 4 Here we see both dominant and subdominant defend and main- tain the major, and yet, from the sixth measure, everybody will imagine himself in G major, though the dominant chord of that key does not make its appearance even at the end. The passing-tone /t] would have as surely indicated and retained the key of C instead of G. This leads Us to a very importa,nt observation. If we had taken the passiflg-tone f, we should not haive been prepared for 265 Q major but rather confirmed in C major. In future, therefore, we will construct the pass before a modulation, so that it pre- pares rather than contradicts the subsequent key. For this very- reason, if we intended to remain in C, the tone f\ would have been unfit, 392. r^ i :*=* and the tone /ti the right one. 'f 266 Tenth Part. The Treatment of More or Less than Four Voices. Latelt we have limited ourselves to the tetraphonic composi tion, and only occasionally represented one thing or the other with more or less voices. It requires now but a brief considera tion of the more-or-less-voiced composition. CHAPTER I. THE TEIPHONIC, DUOPHONIC, ASD MONOPHONIC COM- POSITIONS. We have perceived that not even four voices were sufBcient to give us always complete chords, unless by making use of har- monic bye-tones. Complete nonachords were altogether impossi- ble. Septime chords could only be carried out completely with five voices, and faults could only be avoided at the expense of the completeness of the chords. It is natural that this incompleteness of chords should happen still more frequently with less than four voices, or we should still oftener make use of hannonic bye-tones. These, however, if we wish to avoid a certain emptiness and superficiality, will force us to make use of passing-tones ; and it may not always suit, our purpose to overload our voices with harmonic and non-harmouic additional tones. Before making use of the latter, therefore, we must first consider What harmonies we can best represent without imperfection. The triads require but three voices, and consequently can some- times be better applied triphonically than tetraphonically. But we know already, that the progression of the voices often pre- vents our directly reaching those tones which seem desirable to 267 us. Therefore, even in triads, we shall have to resign many a position, in order to represent our chords as completely as possi- ble. If, for instance, we were to accompany the first tones of the scale with triads, the position at a and b would be preferable to that at c. 393. $ ■P=f & -JF 2 : I though we had to introduce sext-choi'ds in the former. But even this precaution will not always/ be sufficient; we must, for the sake of flowing progression, leave some chords in- complete. It is now necessary to know what tones of a chord can best be omitted. We have given all necessary information on that point. The dominant-chord cannot be represented completely without harmonic bye-tones. The fifth is the interval in it which can best be omitted. We know, too, that the fundamental tone can be omitted, in which case we have a diminished triad left ; the pro- gression of the voices will often force us to make use of this chord. Let us now attempt the accompaniment of the scale according to our first manner of harmonization, with employment, howev- er, of the inversions, wherever they seem preferable. We perceive that the final chord of b has lost the fifth and th.rd, unless we prefer to end with a sext-chord. The duophonic accompaniment would be still more meagre. We could employ the natural harmony, 395. or, take a mere succession of sixths, or pursue any other course. 268 The nonaohords would have to resign third and fifth, unless we preferred to exchange them for derived septime-chords, in which latter case the third had best be omitted. According to these principles, No. 217 would be harmonized triphonically, perhaps thus : m-wri 1 1 1 In duophonio composition we should have to cling still closer to the model of natural harmony, and to successions of thirds and sixths, for instance : 397. ^^m ^m rnffT^^Tf- w We know, too, that by means of added bye-tones and pa>.i--ing- tones the harmony can be completed, and the voices made more flowing or animated. Instead of all further explanation we merely give here a single illustration, -yy— h i — d " 398. ^ :^^^ ^■^-^ Li'j ^^ CCj' :?-*! :?=^i ■F-^a- 1-5= ^^m 1 269 which the student may analyze for himself. This, of course, is not the only way in which the phrase can be carried out. And, finally, we must return again to the monophonic composi- tion. This was our first lesson, but we resume it, having in our possession the means of a fully-developed harmony, and the tone- foi'mations attached thereto. We must now confess that the mere scale, though the first and most necessary, is but a meagre basis for melody. Our phrases have long broken through the limits of a single scale ; the thesis will no longer end upon the tonic, but strives tqwards the domi- nant, or has become a separate part and ends in the key of the dominant, or the parallel, &c. ; we have a continual longing for harmony and the latter strives again for embellishment by suspen- sions, passing-tones, &c. Can all this be done in a single voice ? Beyond doubt. We know already that chords can be melodically represented, in part or entirely, by a single voice. Then we can easily see that suspensions, passing-tones, &o. 399. ^feg^ -f:^ -S t£?; ^--^^ i can easily be mixed with the harmonic tones. We have, there- fore in reality, the means for every harmonic form, and conse- quently can distinctly express every turn of the modulation. Thus we see in the following monophonical ritornel of a concerto by Sebastian Bach: 400. gfe^^- ^^J^ E^ m ^± rn^M m^^^^ itijiqc that it contains all essential points of an energetic modulation ; the tonic chord at the beginning ; the turning to the dominant (mea- sure 2 to 5) ; the modulation into the subdominant (measure 5 to 6), and the modulation to the dominant. It will be suiHcient for us to indicate the means and possibility, as the student of harmony will have no difficulty in writing such illustrations. 271 CHAPTER II. THE MOEE-THAN-TETEAPHONIC COMPOSITION. Wb must here distinguish whether all the voices belong to one single body, one choir, or to two or more bodies, which, though connected, still form separate' choirs among themselves. The first is in preference called many-voiced, or polyphonic. A. — The Polyphonic Composition. In it the necessity of leaving harmonies incomplete will occur less frequently, but instead of it we shall often be forced to dou- ble one or more tones, in consequence of which we must be careftil to arrange our voices so that they are not in each other's way. Above all, we must think of those harmonies and those re- sources which permit each voice to pursue its free and independ- ent course. Nevertheless it will not always be possible to lead all the voices clear through the throng. We shall have to choose occasionally between a greater and less evil, and we shall even be forced to employ duplications and progressions which are con- trary to rale ; the greater number of voices forces them upon us and covers them. "" Next to this, we must think of procuring more space for the middle-voices. The bass must go lower, must take the funda- mental tones more frequently, in order to give a firm basis to the numerous voices. The middle voices, in turn, must cling to one position as long as possible, and only progress in small steps ; for, when a numerous mass of voices once happens upon dispersed harmony, it is very difficult to control it and to avoid confusion. Finally, we must always remember in the right place, to extend every chord internally, {i. e. to make of the triad a septime chord, and of the latter a nonaehord) in order to find the greatest quan- tity of matter for the many voices. All these rules are so clear and consistent, and have been pre- pared so much already, that they require no particular practice, 272 save a few attempts to apply our acquired information even under diiBculties. We add the subsequent remarks, but warn expressly against a too-great extent of these attempts, as this man- ner of writing is of but little importance, save in extraordinary cases, and leads the student to ponderousness and affectation. The polyphony in the orchestral composition is something based ^upon entirely different principles. The student ought to begin with very simple successions, and test of how many voices they admit. Hfere 401. w^m at A, we have written a simple melody with an a<«iompaniment of six voices. At b we have arranged it ootaphonically, and have introduced a somewhat richer modulation. At o and d are two, more treatments of the same for seven voices. We have every- where taken as many voices as we could introduce without diffi- culty. It is practicable • enough to add still more voices. Thus, we have here 273 402. B ^^^^ i -°-#- ^ i^i^ g^ B= 1 BE ^m^ m^^^ e= ^^m^- -•.9^ *=■(: -4 ^ arranged the melody of No. 401 for ten voices, or eleven, if we count the pedal-tone. But, independent of single inconveniences, it is undeniable that the ninth and tenth voices find their way only with diiBculty, and even then have to cross between tones which have been much better represented by other voices. In order to obtain the greatest amount of clearness and care in polyphonic compositions, it is always best to have two or three voices progress in thirds and sixths, and to place these parallel voices so close together, that they form among themselves an independent, separate choir. In a, b, and d of No. 401, the voices 1, 3, and 4, formed such a choir; in c is a similar choir consisting of the voices 1, 6, and 3. There is another in a, formed by the voices 5 and 6 ; and the voices 8, 5, and 6 have another in B. Wherever such choirs occur they ought to be placed as Soon as possible after the upper and bass voices. In No. 401, after having written the bass, we have imme- diately written the voices 3 and 4, which, together with the upper voice, form sext-chords and appear as a well-closed mass. After this it was desirable to have a second mass, proceeding in a con- trary direction, which formed itself in the voices 5, 6, and 7, though much less connected. The other voices were added as well as we could. As a matter of course, we cannot always finish one 374 )r two voices before beginning the others. It can only be done where a voice seems particularly apt to such treatment, as, for in- stance, the voice 8 in No. 401, or, when the general arrangement of the voices permits it, as in the following : 403. -4-S& -3-g — -i. i: w i=s -e- -J- r-*- zz^sz Y In conclusion, we will now gite a hexaphonic (six-voiced) treat- ment of No. 396, with slight alterations of the upper voice. ^W ^ --^ e^ f--^B J.fi^'.^J ^.J_J_,gj. J-J-^ 3t=t & ^^ ^ rff-r*=nfT i^ 275 rm~im r It cannot be denied that the whole appears overloaded, and though at some places we have obtained a greater volume of tone, the phrase, as a whole, is by no means an improvement on the former treatment. But this is snuch less owing to the manner of execution, than to the forcedness of the task. It was not our ob- ject to make a work of art, but simply to illustrate the possibility and the manner of writing polyphonically. But even admitting that the phrase had been treated with an artistic object, the result would teach us — that even in the number of voices simplicity and suffi- ciency are always best, and that every excess is injurious. Not easily will a composer overload his work with voices, with- out a particular and sufficient reason. But even under the exis- tence of a reason, he will not treat everything polyphonically, but only appropriate phrases, or parts of phrases, particularly in simple, slowly-developed harmony and quiet, steady melody, while the remainder will have to be satisjfiied with a less number of voices. Handel, in his oratorio "Israel in Egypt," has treated Several choruses in this manner ; sometimes employing eight dif- ferent voices, sometimes forming different choirs, and at other times dissolving two or more voices in one. There is an apparent or pseudo-polyphony which is effected by doubling some real independent voices, bass or treble, or perhaps all voices. We have had such cases in the double-duophonic composition, (page 90) and have decided that these duplications cannot be considered as actual voices. For this reason we can consider the following phrase 276 405. merely as pentaphonic, though it contains nine voices. Even if these assistant-voices should exchange their parts among them- selves, the phrase would still be pentaphonic. Not even the em- bellishment of one or the other of these assistant-voices, by- means of bye-tones or passing-tones would change it into a real voice ; and if we were to write the highest voice of the above, thus, 406. for instance, it wovdd still be a mere duplication of another voice, (page 72). B. — The Double-choired, or Polychoired Composition. This is the more customary manner, because it is more practi cal and useful. Dividing the voices contained therein into two or more masses, we can employ one or several of these masses by themselves, or, we can unite them in real polyphony. The first manner, particu- larly, which is not limited to periods or phrases, but which can be employed in even the closest interchange of choirs, gives to the whole manner a mobility, transparency and clearness, of which the real polyphonic manner is absolutely incapable. There are various ways in which this manner can be em- ployed. .,H, We can form two or more choirs of voices. 277 The choirs can have equal or unequal number of voices and position. The different connected choirs can be employed differently ; one choir can be treated simply, another can be more figura- ted, &c. All this demands no new law, and requires but a simple consid- eration, which then, of course, refers to the real polyphonic com- position, also. The united choirs must appear as a whole ; not merely all to' gether, but each choir separately, and at every separation of the single choirs, the fact of each one being a whole, even when they are all combined into one grand whole, causes us to conceive each one separately, as long as we can distinguish it from the others. From this it follows that we must treat each choir as an inde- pendent whole, characterize it by good upper and lower voices, and make the harmony as complete and clear as possible, while we are at liberty to permit between two voices of different choirs all those relations and progressions which the real polyphony forces upon us. But as soon as we consider every choir as a separate whole, the most manifold applications are open to us. While we give the hai-mony to one choir, the other can proceed in unison, octaves, or take the pedal-tones, or contribute in various ways to the effect of the whole. All these formations will be reconsidered in the orchestral and vocal composition. They do not, for the present, require even a particular practice. It is suiiicient to have indicated them. SECOND BOOK. THE ACCOMPANIMENT OP GIVEN MELODIES. 281 INTRODUCTION. Jn the first book we have acquired the means which the toni- cal and rhythmical elements offer us for artistic objects. We shall now proceed to the application of these means for artistic objects. Though we have already constructed compositions with the mere natural harmony, which in their sphere were probably satis- factory, we were always restricted in our means, and these compo- sitions were merely the means of practice. Our fiiture labors are also merely devoted to the practice and development of our means, but they can already be considered as independent works of art. Beginning again with the most simple task, we are led at once to THE ACCOMPANIMENT OF GIVEN MELODIES. There are two species of melodies, the accompaniment of which can be demanded of the composer : |; 1, the choral melodies, and 2, the secular melodies of the people. Other melodies are generally provided with an accompaniment by their composer.* * [The chorals and national melodies, or melodies of the people, form a style of music peculiar to Germany and to German composers, and, owing to their importance, German theorists have attached to them all those rules of composition which perhaps could have been attached to other musical forms. The translator had no alternative before him, but either to give the information embodied in these important branches as he found it, and to give a literal translation of the work before him, or to reduce this informa- tion to mere principles and to adapt them to other cosmopolitan forms. The translator of this work has chosen the former, because, independent of the correct conveyance of the author's ideas, he thought it too good an op- portunity of acquaiating the student with these peculiar musical forms, to let it pass for mere brevity's sake, or for other equally unimportant reasons.]— -Ed. 283 First Part. The Accompaniment of the Choral. The choral melodies, as embodied at present into our mode of worship, fiirnish us, because of their simplicity, the first and easi- est task for the practice of accompaniment. Their compass, gen- erally, is not too extended, their melodic progression is generally quiet and steady, and their measural construction is very simple, for with the exception of a few passing-tones, their melody pro- gresses generally in measural parts,* interrupted but rarely by notes of longer duration. The division into single, short strophes (phrases), each of which, as it were, forms a whole, facilitates their internal arrangements, the treatment, and the survey of them. Even the adaptation of words to them is very simple ; each syllable has, generally, one tone, to which, occasionally, a passing- tone is attached. Thus, in every respect, the choral forms one of the simplest lessons for accompaniment. But in other respects it can also be called one of the richest. For the noble simplicity of its melody makes it appropriate for the most manifold harmonization and accompaniments ; aye, most of the chords have so general a destination, that from various points of view they admit of various accompaniments, which each in its place and for its object can be considered the best, while none can be caUed the only correct one. Added to this is now the religious and artistic importance of the lesson. The choral was always, and is now an essential part of Christian, particularly evangelical worship, and will remain so for all time. Many of these melodies have been transmitted to us from our fathers and forefathers ; for centuries past they have been the voice of the people, their consolation and their strength : * Measural parts are such parts of a measure as are indicated by the bythmical signature of a piece ; thus, for notes, in 4 time all the quarter-notes, t^*^ , J'^^^w.^it^ <'/ ^^^i^te r M^-g Bst m^m ^ -• — •—- • |g^F^ i F;=p=?^ a— p- i ^ ^S^ii i if 2S8 zfr. f f r jE3ri:=pitf:^ i'-^*- i i ^£g ^ m nr^¥T^¥=f '-¥ -0-m- cl^cJU.f^'y^ ^r^^^^^t-d^CUkM , Ol^ ^^^^^^ a *—m- ^,P,,,,^„./de;fe6-»*v HCyrr€^t dJiu^ CA/ frV^ o«-^ ^ s^gfe ^ ^Tt^ i^S3 B^ ^f^fPs gg^F^a * ^^^^^p^^iil ,^^^, Je//*^!^'^»-^''^«^*^*^ i ^^S -1^— i^ i =#^ ?=P=f= 289 Having once decided upon the key of a melody, the next question is how to arrange the general modulation. The rhyth- mical construction of the chorals, must be our first guide. Many chorals are actually divided into two parts ; as, for in- stance, the first four of the above. In others again, this division is not distinctly marked, but it is indicated by the arrangement of the whole. This is the case here : $ ■=t ^^^ zzt -%-- -&- f±:^^ '^- zgpi :ri ■^■p&ir^ -i » d M ^ F-F d= ^^^^_^|lpJ^ :^tj:/^^. ^ :^--4 . 1 Oh ^p= fe=-Hfe=grL=:g| f^ ! I 'Sl 3E ^ iEgre i=S: .^_f2: ff^f^Ff it^z > -^-J¥ T ^=3 l-X .d..^_ m .is d: ■^^s- P=f f-V" T tJEPfei 3e&e^ €—-§- f— f :'?: .d. :^ •^^-?^- f-^: .<:1 ^- :«: :?: ■ J. l^r=^M-T^ tP2-~ 290 The second part repeats the first two strophes of the begiimingy and thus causes another beginning, while it indicates at tmce a division of the choral into twice three strophes. If a choral has this two-part form, we close, if the melody per- mits it, the major melodies in the dominant, the minor melodies in the parallel. Each single strophe of a choral has again its close, which by means of pause or interlude, or voluntary retardation, separates that strophe from the remainder. Thus we have to treat each strophe as a separate part of the whole, and to close it with either a half cadence, or a full cadence ; we consider, therefore, the end of each strophe as a resting-point of the modulation upon which the latter breaks off, more or less satisfactorily. We must reflect well, therefore, at the end of each strophe : — what conclusion of the modulation is possible ; and which is the nearest and most natural, and most appropriate for the progres- sion of the whole ; and, finally, which conclusion would be most in keeping with the character of the choral, and consequently the most preferable. B. — Summary of Cadences. The importance which these strophe-cadences, as chief moments and end-pomts of the modulation, have for us, demands a care- ful preparation ; the more so, since the numerous strophes of a choral demand so many different cadences. What cadences have we now at our command ? 1. The full cadence, from the dominant chord to the tonic triad. Instead of the dominant chord we might also use the major or minor nonachord, or the derived septime chords, (these, however, form but imperfect cadences) ; even the dominant triad is admis sible, except in the last strophe. 2. We shall require occasionally another species of full ca dence, which passes from the triad of the subdominant to the tonic triad. 407, i G major. =F and is called "ecclesiastical cadence." It is evident that this 291 cadence closes not as satisfactorily as the piv per full cadence ; the two chords do not even designate the key with decision, (the forms of No. 407, could also be half-cadences in F major), and the triad of the suBdominant does not so well prepare the final chord, because it has not the impulse of the dominant chord to resolve into it. Yet, in choral treatment we cannot well do without it, and we need not care how much - or how little satisfactory it is. Full cadence and ecclesiastical cadence, can at all events be em- ployed for single strophes, in an imperfect form ; merely the end of the whole, and of the first part (if there is any) demand a per- fect full cadence. 3. The half-cadence. This, as we know, is formed by the progression of the tonic triad into the triad of the dominant. But we cannot always employ it in this form, in the chorals. or replace it by another cadence. The after-effect of the ecclesi- astical keys, or the will of the composer, necessitate occasionally a second species of half cadence, which is formed of the triads of subdominant and dominant : 408. i -F "ST r consequently of two chords which are not even harmonically con- nected. However, imperfect such cadence may be, it must be em- ployed occasionally; we have employed it already in No. 105, when the periodical construction was of minor importance, and we have employed it on different occasions to close the thesis. All we have to remember is, that the final chord of the half- cadence, whether in major or minor, must be a major triad, be- cause both tone-species have upon their dominants a- major triad. And now we have to enquire at every choral, which of the enumerated cadences are possibly applicable in it ? Most of the choral strophes end by ascending or descending one degree of either a step or half-step. In major, for instance, it would go from c to d, or from d to c ; from c to b, or from h to c. 292 The last tone of the final strophe, at all events, must be part of a major or minor triad ; and we know that the last chord of the half-cadenoe must be major. Let us now survey all possible cases, considering the last tone either as fundamental tone, minor or major third (in the half-cadences exclusively as major third) or fifth. 409. p E.C.*c == 1 — 9 c ^l' .Mi C n. 6 = 1 = Maj. Min. " mm. 3 = e a = A min. 3 . • ■ • . , " maj. 3 5 maj. 3 5 . dg . .be. . G E E. C. c = 1 " min. 3 " maj. 3 « 5 ■ • • • • 6=1 = min. 3 . maj. 3 . 5 . e g . a e . . Q E H.C. c = 1- " maj. 3 5 • • • • • 6=1 = maj. 3 5 . . a 6. c g . a e . . . C E A In the same manner can we derive here all the possible car dences with c, d and d, c. 410, $ F.C. d = I . . " min. 3 " maj. 3 = / 6 = 5f, " » 5 E. C. rf = 1 = ... Maj. Min. C min. 3 . . maj. 3 . e a Maj. Min c c 5. . 1 = cf. F H.C. "min. 3 . . . " maj. 3 . . . " f> . c g . d ^ \ = c d "maj. 3 . a\,b\, 5 . c g . ■f9 F F G G G G E\, f> . hf . . . B\, * ¥. C. indicates here " full cadence ;" E. 0. " ecclesiastical cadence ;" H. C. "half cadence;" min. 3, "minor third;" maj. 8, "major third;" 1 min. 3 =^ maj. 3 . . 5 . min. 3 . 5 . d a b\,c . hf- 293 There are other closings of strophes which exhibit a repetition of the last tone, or the descension of the third ; in such case it depends upon the student, and upon the adjudging of each partic- ular case, whether to treat the last two tones as belonging to the final chord and to place the preparative chord upon the previous tone, as here i i^^l^ 411. BE ^^^m ^- t m goai=gjJ %FM^^F^ a J J m f^ at A, or to attach the whole cadence to the last two tones, as at B. And now only, we ask which of all the possible cadences is preferable in each particular case. Let us now analyze a few chorals. J/j^ ^ . j^ .^_^ ^ 412. fc: W=3k±jt^r=^ ?^ =t "t "^< ^# — P- P f ^ Signature and end-tone indicate here the key of 5b major ; the stands for " fundamental tone ;" 5 stands for "Fifth." The formula is thus : If we take e as fundamental tone, we can make a full cadence . with g-b-d-f to c in C major or C minor. Instead of the indicated nonachords, we can also take derived septime chords, and instead of fundamental chords we can take inversions. As a matter of course we need not absolutely use the triad c-e-g or ce\>-g to go to (^ but we can also substitute the sext chord e-g-c or eb-{r-c. Whether all these cadences, as enumerated here, are appropriate or not, is a question to be decided in future. 294 close can be accomplished with the dominant chord, in regular manner. We might also close in Q minor, without having the signature interfere with it ; but in that case the final cadence would be imperfect, and in the melody we should always meet with /, instead of the /)( of Gf minor. The above choral contains four strophes, two of which re- semble each other in length as well as in tone-succession. Now, since the second strophe admits of a close in the dominant, we can consider the two first strophes as the first part of the choral. The first strophe admits of a like close in the principal key. It might also end in the parallel {^G minor), and it would matter but little that the cadence would be imperfect. But, according to our principles of modulation, this digression into the parallel comes too soon. The second strophe closes, as a first part, in the dominant. The nonachord f-a^c-e\i-g would enable us to close it, too, as the princi- pal key ; but, apart from the opportunity to end the second part satisfactorily, a repetition of the close in the principal key would have been lame, and would have confused the harmony, which evidently inclines towards ^ major. The third strophe, too, might be ended with a full cadence in F, by means of the nonachord e-g-i\)-d, but here, too, it would be a mere repetition of one and the same cadence. We might close in C minor, or even A]) major, but for so small a phrase this is far too distant. But have we not already considered the first strophes as a whole, as a first part which ends on the dominant 1 Consequently we can consider the last two strophes as a second part which returns from the dominant key into the principal. The beginning of the third strophe corresponds to such conception. We perceive now that the third strophe, as thesis, makes a half cadence from the tonic upon the dominant ; the full cadence at the end will be more satisfactory. Here is another ex, ample: S-rMjdUtXu^^, ^^'^ 413. • p -0—0- ■F-* irz^zs % ^ — F— r- -» — ^- i i i 295 "Ehis choral is really constructed in two parts. The key of the whole is evidently G minor ; the nearest modulation, therefbre, would be the parallel, B\, major ; and such modulation corresponds to the ending of the first part. We have now decided the two most important points of the modulation, to which everything else must be subordinate. The first strophe, too, might be led into B\, major, but this would be anticipating and injuring the effect of the just-mentioned full cadence of the whole part ; and we prefer, therefore, to em- ploy the half-cadence from the subdominant to the dominant. The third strophe can make a full cadence in D major, by means of an actual modulation, or can make a half cadence upon the triad of the ^minant.^ The followipg chora,! g » ^2^ 414. « W:^^ 3 ^ i^zp: *: 1 3F -& — •- s Ij-jj- * i ::izz±zd bizfz may serve as third and last example. This melody offers some slight difficulty, because five of its strophes turn towards a close in the tonic, and always in the same manner, by a, g. In order to retain always the most simple, we should have to remain contin- ually in G major ; even the penultimate strophe is appropriate for a half-cadence in G, though inclined to modulate into D major. But it is clear that simplicity would here lead to monotony. Let us admit at once, then, that the penultimate strophe leads to D major ; and the question is, how shall we make the other five cadences t. The ot, g can be employed for a close in G major, by means of the dominant chord d-f^-a-c ; in C major, by means of the nonachord g-h-d-f-a ; in ^ minor, by means of the dominant chord h-d^-f^-a ; and consequently gives us, in addition to the principal key and the dominant, the keys of the subdomin9.nt and the parallel. We are now prepared for all the nearest modulations. 296 We close the first strophe in the principal key, to confirm the latter. The last strophe belongs already to this key. We place the cadence of the subdominant, according to its character, as near as possible to the end ; — consequently in the fourth strophe. The second and third strophes, consequently, belong to the parallel. It is easily seen that more than one deviating arrangement could have been made ; we .might have ended the second strophe, for instance, in E minor, the third in C major, and the fourth again in E minor ; or we might have closed the third in Q major. But where in that case would have been the steady mass in E, which we gained in the above ? And where would have been the decisive juxtaposition of subdominant and dominant ? But in return we should have fallen again upon former keys — E minor, G major, E minor, G- major, E minor, G major, we should have modulated in a vague manner, and deadened the effect of former keys by returning to them. For two strophes we might have chosen, also, the key of the subdominant, E major, instead of E minor. But in that case the decline of the modulation in the subdominant would have been too conspicuous ; and with five major strophes, we should have had but one minor strophe, while in the above sketch there reigns abetter symmetry, i. e. two minor strophes against four major strophes ; or two strophfes for the principal key, two for the ma- jor, and two for the minor modulations. Thus much of the sketch of choral music. But when we re- consider the principles which have led us, we see that our actual aim was merely a general appropriateness, a natural, fresh, and analogically-developed modulation, without regard to the single moments of the melody, to the meaning of the words, and to the color which we would like to give to one or the other phrase. We must remember, therefore, that the above sketches or plans of modulation are subject to many alterations, however appro- priate they may have appeared from our present point of view. We must permit such alterations, nay, consider them as ne- cessary, when the melodic contents of a strophe would not agree with the harmonies of the pre-destined key. 297 CHAPTER II. DISPOSITION OF THE HARMONY. As soon as the strophe-cadences are decided upon, the harmony of each strophe has received its destination ; and, according to that destination, it has now to be arranged decisively and steadily, with due regard of all the principles heretofore mentioned. Again, therefore, we think first of the nearest and most appropriate chords, look then to succession and connection, and without losing sight of our aim, we avoid every unnecessary repetition and every wavering. We bear variety in mind, too ; particularly when the melody might lead us to monotony, and we shall gen- erally prefer vigorous and dignified modulations, corresponding to religious dignity and elevation, to those of an effeminate, triv- ial character. We shall also avoid too frequent inversions, particularly quart- sext chords. The latter, which formerly seemed so appropriate for the preparation of the ending, would here make the harmony monotonous and weak, in consequence of our having so many endings and such short strophes. ■• For the same reason we shall generally avoid those harmonic successions in which bass and treble progress in thirds or sixths, for instance : i ^f^k^i^. s 415. ^ f^^= r =M '■^: m i 1= T- r r r f For, owing to the preponderance of the outer voices, such succes- 298 sions are apt to produce monotony and effeminacy in the har- mony, however vigorously the latter may be organized in itself. We need not here repeat that, in the proper place, we may devi- ate from this rule as well as from every general rule. The whole disposition of the choral melody tells us already that each tone of the melody ought to have its own chord, in other words ought to be a harmonic tone. But we must add to this the follovring : 1. To give each tone of the melody its own chord is the most simple, it is true, but often, as in No. 417, a chord can be re- tained for several tones of the melody. 2. A tone of the melody can also be considered as suspension, and consequently as a part of the preceding chord. Thus, for in- stance, the last strophe of the choral. No. 1, page 287, might be treated in this manner : A J=L=i . 416. i BEl m 3. The tone of the melody can be considered as mere passing- tone. For instance, the ending of the third strophe in No. 414, might be treated thus : 417. 5S m ^^9\ J. A ^t A I Neither of the above are, however, as vigorous as the employ- ment of a separate chord for each tone of the melody. 4. We meet occasionally, as in the third and fifth strophes, of No. 414, instead of equi-long measural parts, notes of longer duration for one syllable. It depends then upon us to give such a tone one single chord, or to give a separate chord to each mea- 299 sural part therein contained ; for instance, the third strophe of No. 414, which might be treated thus : 418. 1= or thus. SSfg I ^^^ w- ~cs-jitp=rz:5=l rrr-r e^d^P^I^EfePE^^^Ei ^ i I I f^ When a syllable has two measural parts, but different, tied notes (for instance in the penultimate measure of the first and sec- ond strophe in No. 414,) these two tones can have a single chord. But it is more customary and vigorous, to give a separate chord to each tone. 5. We iind occasionally (for instance in the penultimate mea- sure of the same choral) a measural part divided into two measural members — two-eighth-notes instead of a quarter note. We can, in such a case, treat the one or the other tone as passing-tone, or we can give a separate harmony to each of them. The just-men- tioned instance might be treated, therefore, thus : 419. ^^^8p ^^^3 I I s ?=FK ,Ji5,^ ?*£F= r Each of these conceptions can be right in its place, though the treatment as at a or b is more common ; but the question is — which of the tones shall be the passing-tone, and which the har- monic tone ? If the progression of the melody does not indicate the one as essential, the other as added, we follow the progres- sion of our harmony and consider that one as harmonic, which, according to the connection of the modulation, is most appropriate for it. It is less usual to treat each measural member as harmonic, 300 because it is apt to interrupt the steady progression of the har- mony and to overload the modulation. Therefore, if we are once determined to employ two chords, we ought to prefer the closest connection of chords, as at c, though the treatment at d may be appropriate for a particular expression. After these observations, let us now turn to the task itself, i. e. to our first choral. No. 412. Its first strophe we have decided to end in the principal key. We know, therefore, that the last two tones must be accompa- nied with the dominant and the tonic chord ; it is also most nat- ural to begin with the tonic chord, and to the first /of the melody we shall take, therefore, the chord bh-d-f. And now we have to find the harmony between these fixed points. Three times more does the / appear in the melody, and we shall find the mere repetition of the same chord too monoto- nous : J. .1 A 1 420. HF¥ r '-^ or its inversions too trivial for the chorals. We must then intro- duce new chords. The nearest, and, therefore, best, is the triad of the dominant. The nearest step, now, is the chaflging of the dominant triad into the dominant chord, which, then, leads back to the tonic triad. We have now found the following fundamental bass, 421.SEd2: ^ but shall prefer a more pliant inversion. 422. Bq± fe£ Qfc,P=i=tt 6 2 6 probably the one at c, because those at a and b end with the same tone with which they began. There remain now only the tones 6b and c ; the former might 301 be accompanied with the tonic triad, if we had not just had that chord, 01- with the subdominant e\!-g-b\), if it were not too soon for that chord. We prefer, therefore, the triad of ff, which reminds us at the same time of the parallel. And exactly because of this reminiscence, we attach the subsequent chord to this harmony and accompany the following tone of the melody with the triad of c, the subdominant of ff. Thus, the first strophe would have this form : 423. r ^ ^ =^^ m 3= 6 2 6 6 7 We see here, in addition to other observations, that the bass as- cends and descends in a decisive direction; the elevation or as- cension is accomplished by quart-steps, therefore uniform, and this would be an additional reason for choosing no other chord for the tone JI7. The subsequent sext-chord gently prepares the de- scent of the bass ; a triad would cause here a stiff progression in that voice. If in this harmonic disposition we have specially regarded the bass, we have a good reason for it, in its being an outer voice, consequently more conspicuous and more important. We can now understand why the beginning could not have been made with a quart-sext chord, or a terz-quart chord on the second tone of the melody : 424. Obtr r :t How weak and inappropriate would the succession at a have been ! and how insignificant at b the two inversions of one and the same chord ! But the greatest loss would have been in the sacrificing of the consistent progression of the bass, as we ob- tained it. The next strophe we intend to end in F; it is, therefore, nat- ural to turn towards it as soon as possible, in order to introduce the new key with decision. Its first tone, c, yields under any 302 cii-cumstances no nearer harmony than the triad of the doinmant, which we employ as sext-chord, so as to avoid the repetition of the tone / in the bass. But we consider this dominant triad as if it were a tonic harmony, and follow it up with the dominant triad of the new key, c-e-g. It is clear that this triad is quite sufficient tor the transition, and it enables us, besides, to preserve the freshness of the dominant chord for the cadence of the stror phe. It is natural that the dominant triad, like the dominant chord itself, should lead to the tonic triad, /ac. One more tone, g, demands its harmony, for the other g be- longs to the dominant chord. "What can this g be in any chord ? The triad of the new dominant is again the nearest ; but we have but just employed it, and the subsequent dominant chord Would appear weak and a mere repetition. The triad of e|j, which we might choose, lays even beyond B\> major, while we are pro- ceeding towards F. But we have the minor triad of g, or to strengthen the modulation to F still more, the major triad or sep- time chord of ^. But is it worth while,, for so short a strophe is intended to be in ^ major, to go as far out of the way ? In the absence of par ticular reasons we shaU. avoid the modulation to C ; it lies now nearest to change the foreign chord g-h-d-f'vcAo an indigenous one, g-b\)-d-f, as we have learned already, (page 190.) The second strophe of our choral would now be thus : '25. i i fe^=r msE Here are the last strophes with three diiferent basses, 303 426. $ ^ 'i=F^ =*— •^ 2 6 S 6 4 =P=F= 6 5 7 4 3 5 7 s^ -©- ^=E 6 6 » 7 S=E r rtF i^i which -vrill require some few remarks ; that there are still other harmonizations possible need not here be added. At A, the secunda chord e\,-f-a-c issues immediately from the preceding final chord, f-a-c, and in accordance -with the nature ot inversions gives a greater mobilty to the harmony. Simultane- ously it has been the means of our returning most rapidly and most decisively into the principal key. The subsequent har- monies which seem as if conceived for horns, or a more frequent and untimely employment of them, might easily disagree with the religious dignity of the choral, and we must consider how far otherwise, the treatment of it upholds this dignity, and how far the words admit of a more light conception. At B, the return to the principal key, in the first part of the strophe, has remained undecided, contrary to the general rula given on page 301. But it is here now the more decided, be- cause we modulate into the subdominant, £}, major, and thus as- cend to the principal tone. It is only in the penultimate mea- sure, when this principal key becomes decided. At c, the bass tried to avoid the return to its first tone, {/, g,/)j therefore the sext-chord. It would have been nearest, now, to take the triad of 5b, but in that case the bass would have proceed- ed in thirds with the upper voice, three or four times in succes- sion. We introduced, therefore, an actual modulation into the parallel of the principal key. This has caused a cross-rela- 304 tion in the harmony, which, however, by means of a tone, /— fi- 437 ^ ^^ f~^'~f~r~ :^=i ?'=F^ uJH' 3E5 ;^E J or I I I 1 could be easily mitigated. We might have avoided it altogether by an alteration of the bass {//|, instead of a/j(), but we should have lost by it the symmetrical progression of the bass. We might, also, change this obnoxious /| into /, or, in other words, change the major sext-chord into minor ; this would give a more serious turn to the whole strophe, and would be better concluded in the manner of a, than that of c. Prompted by the foreign triad, we might also turn to C minor, and conclude the choral thus : 428. I b: -&- 3 OEfc ^ :^=t3p: -&- 3 5 if this foreign and serious ending corresponded to the words or to any particular intention. In that case we should have made a modulation into the parallel of the subdominant,' and at a point when foreign modulations, accordhig to rule (page 211), are not in their place. This makes it advisable, in the penultimate measure, to touch once more upon the key of the dominant, and thus to return gently and quietly into the principal key to end there. 305 CHAPTER III. SIMPLE TREATMENT OF THE CHORAL. The reflections in the preyious chapter were merely prepara- tory. We will now harmonize one or two chorals, and at the same time indicate that method which has proved itself the best and safest. The following choral, which we select for this purpose, is one of the most insignificant and unchurchlike melodies, but this is of slight moment to us, as long as it gives us an opportunity to illustrate the method of our labor. 49.ft 7f r- 1 - p\r F , P ^ ^ -f-ry~ TTt: ^1 H-+ \l.g 7* > 1 c m f ft , M m ^^ r — m — #- fe-^J= t^ H-:: ni d 9 i- 9 e Signature and end tone of the melody indicate the key of C ma- jor; we decide, therefore, first of all, upon the close of the whole, as at I. The first strophe, too, demands a close in the principal key, as it would be injudicious to end already the first strophe in minor ; and, accordingly, we write this close at II., as a second fixed point. Finally, as third point, at III., we write the close of the second strophe in G. We have thus three-end points for the modulation, and instead of one single task, we have now three smaller ones. By this proceeding we have first fixed the most certain and necessary, then the most important, and after- wards the more distant steps. And now comes the arranging of the harmony. Here we can see the weakness of the melody ; the beginning of the first and ihird strophe wanders about in the tonic triad, by no means with that intrinsic strength and dignity which sacred melody obtains from a rich harmonic development. 306 We are not responsible, however, for the melody. But we must hasten to its assistance, as far, at least, as it will permit us. Yet, we shall find that the distinctly-expressed character of the melody makes it very difficult for us. If, in the above, for instance, we should try to avoid the C major triad, which is so forcibly indicated by the melody. 430. i tfEfclHE=E| m m zMzziL ^= 6 6 Tl6 6 we should disfigure, or mask the key in the very beginning ; and the further harmonies would be placed in the shade, because we have first introduced the distant chords and afterwards turned to the immediate proximity. This treatment is, therefore, preferable. We have here submitted to the har- mony, as indicated by the melody, at least for the first four steps, and have confirmed the principal key in the first strophe with such harmonies as the melody admitted of The second, strophe, too, clings to the principal key, but with its minor triads re- minds us of the two parallels, and, finally, confirms the dominant. The third strophe turns again towards the tonic of the principal key, but leaves us ample room for other harmonies. The arrange- 307 ment of the harmony is as simple. as possible, only towards the end we see the voices beconie more'animated. The monotony of the cadences could only be mitigated by the suspensions ; even the quart-sext chord, in this connection, could not well be avoided. As second illustration, \v«; will take the following choral, ♦ 432. * ^P^ ■A^- 3 -^-d=^\-t=i^*=-*^^- i t III. 61, e\, II. 61, eb ^ -»—*- icipz -&- -e — IV. / 61, I. 6b «b - the first two strophes of which form a first part, and are repeated as such. _ , We first fix the key, ^1» major, and in accordance with it at I., the close of the whole. ■ After this we decide upon the close of the first part at II., and fix it also in the principal key. For it is impossible to have the cadence in the dominant, the subdominant would be out of place, and the parallel would appear strange and gloomy. But we now discover that the same cadence is requi- site for the first strophe, and we shall consequently fix upon the parallel after all. We decide now upon the third str6phe ; if the 433. I 1 1 ) I . .■ I I ' I.I K n^liM S jc:p: 1^ d_d_ *: '^M=^ t=f=,^F=F=iF*F=*=^ff=r r te^E^ti 3=* ?="Pl^ m g^h*— *— ^ - 308 principal key had preceded it, instead of the parallel, it would have been best to end it in the dominant, but under existing cir- cumstances, it -will be best, perhaps, to adopt the arrangement of No. 433. Here, in the first place, we have liberated ourselves, in a de- gree, from the close position of the harmony ; the chords are clearer and more dispersed, and for this reason, already, the voices are freer and more mobile. The observations made formerly upon the monotony of the ca- dences have not been made without results ; they have prompted us to enrich the modulation intrinsically, to touch upon the sub- dominant in the very beginning, and the parallel of the same in the second strophe, &c. It would have been equally easy to en- hance the modulation in the beginning, by touching the dominant ; the fifth chord might have been a-c-e\,-g, instead ib-ff-b],. The fol- lowing choral, by Graun, is treated in this manner. Graun repeats the first two strophes which form a first part, with different har- monization ; the words of the last strophe, too, are repeated in a coda, and in both repetitions the composer clings to the harmonic system of the ecclesiastical keys, to which his choral in reality, belongs, and with which we have at present nothing to do. But the remainder confirms the just-mentioned principles. $ s r ■^ ^E ,^j^^£La ;r^^^=F^=-P ± p=^ -0-p^ -A J. W^. " Thou, whose tears were flow - ing, When Zi on ^ --^hd :i zt SS=^ 'A -& — =^ & F ?f was in sight, Re - solved on deeds of e vil, Ap- h rJ rJ ^sA 309 J_J. J- J S J J :J J- £ .£2_ -JO- f^ proach-ing its de-cline. Wliere is the oBve, the val i ^^ -M: d= f=^E|g=f^=f- -i -^- M OEE J .J- J I I I :te fiP= ^ ^ :^ ley That hides thee, Je - bus, Lord? And ye for « fe=^i=-i: i ffS 2^= -S> A. M: J zL_d_J_^ ^ ?3I :?2= S f-=P= blood now thirst - ing. Is his blood on your H- g^^^ ^ S P¥^^?%=f=-^ soul! Is his blood on your soul?' 310 CHAPTER IV. THE HIGHER TREATMENT OF THE CHORAL. In the preceding chapter we have executed our task in the sim- plest manner. The voices were employed, almost exclusively, in the representation of the harmony, rarely in suspensions or passes ; the harmony, itself, kept as close to the requisites of the melody as it possibly could, without becoming meagre and weak. The principles of modulation will of course remain the same, even in a higher conception, for they are based upon the very elements of harmony ; but we have already been taught to consider the voices as the motive power of the harmony, be- cause by their combination the harmony is formed. Suspen- sions, passing-tones, assistant tones, &o., have also furnished us with the means to give to our voices the necessary melodic con- nection, flow, and pliancy. And this is what we miss in the former treatment of our chorals. Let us compare, for instance, the treatment of the last (No. 433) with the treatment below, 434. g g^^ i^^l 11*1, I 1 I ^ . K J J U-U 1 h^ i=J=J=iy:d=J=3=Ti M^ ^m H^f-S*rrT-^r-*n*^-7? fc±; * *==rat£=?LjU !^ ^ It: W- ;e^ m It r- and we see, with almost the identical harmonies, a higher anima tion of the voices, and through them of the choral. 311 This is the higher character at which we aim for the. present. We no longer conceive the choral as a congregational song, but conceive it as an artistic work, to be executed by four animated, i. e., melodically-expressive voices. Though our present means do not always permit us to elevate the voices to an animate melody, without dimming the choral melody, we shall endeavor not to neglect any voice entirely, or more than is absolutely ne- cessary. For this purpose we must now bestow some attention upon the vocal element. A. — The Characters of the Voices. Since we purpose,, however, to elevate the afccompaniment- voices to animate song, it will be appropriate here, to speak of what we might call THB CANTABILITT OT VOICES. With this expression we shall designate, /«%, the position and progression of voices, which enables the human vocal organ to ex- ecute easily and conveniently. Secondly, we understand by it the quality of a voice of being conceivable, comprehensible, and the quality arising therefrom of being easily represented, be it now in vocal or instrumental music. It is clear that comprehensibility and representableness can exist in a voice in different degrees, and that it is absolutely im- possible to designate to what degree a melody ought to be compre- hensible. It is more important to know on what basis the com- prehensibility of a voice rests. It can have a physical or a mental reason. A physical reason of incomprehensibleness, or a less degree of comprehensibility, can only lie in the impossibility or difficulty which meets a voice or instrument, to reach a tone or a tone- combination, and to represent it. Thus, some tones are too high for a voice, others too low ; some tones cannot be reached on some instruments ; some combinations cannot be represented, or are at least only represented with difficulty. Such considerations, however, do not belong here, but will be treated of in the science of vocal and instrumental composition. For the present it is sufficient to know that intervals extending beyond the octave are generally difficult. 312 The mental reason of comprehensibility or incomprehensibility rests upon the consistency of a tone-proportion. Tone-propor- tions are comprehensible and representable as soon as we con- ceive them ; and the more so the clearer and surer we conceive them. For this reason there are no more comprehensible tone- proportions than those of the major scale and the first chords ; — therefore, the minor scale, and particularly its superfluous second, is more difficult to comprehend. And thus we say that the latter developments must necessarily be more difficult of comprehen- sion, for they are based upon more or less intricate suppositions. Thus, the development of the tone and harmonic system proves on one side the progressive difficulty of comprehension, while on the other side it enables him who has comprehended the connec- tion of the whole, to comprehend the more distant and last for- mations as easily as the first. Therefore, is a voice most comprehensible and " singable" when it progresses in the order of t>he scale, or in, thirds, or from one to another- connected chord, particularly in its nearest intervals. A voice proceeds also, generally, more easily to connected har- monies of the same scale, than to foreign tones ; and, if to the latter, sooner to nearest-related than to more distant tones. We perceive now, already, that we need but follow our previous rules of harmony and progression, in order to wiite that which may easily be sung. The characterization of the voices is justly based upon the tetraphonic composition, as the juste milieu, which has sufficient means for most and the most important harmonies, without add- ing difficulties to the treatment by being overloaded. It is for these reasons that we can call it the normal composition. But the four voices are not merely called after the four princi- pal voices of the vocal chorus, but they are characterized accord- ingly too. If we exceed this number of voices, one or more of the principal voices are taken ofie, two, or more times. In every more than duophonic composition, we distinguish now, first of all, OUTER VOICES, and MinnLE VOICES. Treble and Bass are outer voices, Alto and Tenor are middle 313 voices. If there are several trebles and basses, the highest treble and the lowest bass are the outer voices. The outer voices, in the first place, have the most space for their movements ; the treble above, the bass below. They are, therefore, most capable of rich development, wide passages and intervals. In the choral, as we treat it at present, the upper voice has the melody. This melody is the property of the church, and of the religious service ; it must not be altered, and is therefore called CANTUS PIRM0S. Next to it, however, the bass is the most eflfective and im- portant voice. Both of these outer voices, on account of their position, are also the most conspicuous. We must bestow, therefore, more care upon their progression than upon that of the other voices. If any one voice has occasionally to be sacrificed, it must not be one of the outer voices, unless for some very im- portant object. The middle voices are enclosed on both sides, the alto by treble and tenor, the tenor by alto and bass. Their character is, there- fore, less free, their movement must be quiet, and their progres- sion rather in smaller than in larger steps. Sustained tones and suspensions are principally their property ; progressions in large steps should not be suffered, except for some particular reason. When we now approach the particular character of each voice, and bear in mind the representation of the four principal voices, we perceive that the four voices form, as it were, two separate couples : Treble and Alto, the female (or boys') voices, and Tenor and Bass, the male voices. The Treble is the upper voice of the first couple, the Tenor the upper voice of the second couple. This observation enables us to enter more deeply into the actual character of the middle voices. The Tenor, the original upper voice of the male voice-couple, has lost the free movement of an upper voice, in consequence of the existence of a higher voice-couple, which made it a middle-voice. But ofi;en, even if but for a short phrase, and particularly in cadences, it likes to assume the free movement of an upper voice. 314 and instead of seizing upon the nearest,' it departs from the higher voices more than necessary, or ascends beyond the alto. The Alto is the lower voice of the upper voice-couple, but it lacks the manly vigor of the b^ss, and the space for its free movement. Thus, it is absolutely middle-voice, and preserves a certain passiveness against the inroads of the tenor, clings more to the upper voice, and moves niore quietly and cautiously than any. The Bass, on the contrary, is a free, and manly, and vigorous under-voice, and loves a dignified, often bold progression. As such we have known it in our very first attempt at harmoniza- tion, and as such we have tried to preserve it. It, too, sometimes breaks in upon the other voices, but then it is done in keeping with its character, in bold, decisive, and large steps, by itself, in juxtaposition to all the other voices. Thus much, for the present, of the character of the voices. Ap- plying the above to the string-quartett, we would give the tenor part to the viola, the alto to the second violin, while first violin and contra-basso, or violoncello, would represent the outer voices. Applying it to bassoons and clarinetts, the first bassoon would have the character of the tenor, and the other instruments share in the remaining voices. It is different with the piano forte ; for, apart from the general pharaoter of higher and lower tones, the different tone-regions of this instrument have all the same, or rather, no particular char acter. But if a composer has constructed his voices characteris- tically, the listener will inadvertently transfer the character of the construction to the tones of the instrument. The organ, by means of the pedals, is enabled to represent the bass at least characteristically. B. — Application to the Choral. In our future treatments of the choral, we shall endeavor, FiBSTLT, to give our voices a higher melodic animation. We know that the strength and the merit of a melody do not de- pend upon the number of its notes. On the contrary, an accu- mulation of smaller measural parts would deduct from the rhyth- mical strength of a melody, instead of adding to it. It is the mix- 315 ture and contrast of slow and rapid steps, and their employment for designs, which gives significance, animation, and variety to the rhythm. We shall endeavor, secondlt, to lead our three voices charac- teristically. We have to bear in mind here, not merely the rhythm, but the tone-contents also — as far, at least, as modula- tion and position have left undecided. The more vigorous and quiet moments appertain generally to the bass ; the passionate ones we shall give to the tenor, and the alto will cling to one or the other of its neighbors. Nor must we forget the compass of the different voices, as upon it, too, depends the characteristic of the voices. We shall lead the Treble not lower than ' />1\ , nor higher than 3t: the Alto not lower than M y , nor higher than ^t or the Tenor not lower than Wr , nor higher than Ei ^ _ , 11^1 lUgLOi .,1.»11 T^ 22 the £ass not lower than H i , nor higher than Hi- only, when the bass ascends or descends by octaves, or whenever we can unhesitatingly take the higher for the lower octave, we shall permit ourselves to use lower tones. This restriction will also have the advantage of guarding us against too great disper- sion of the voices. But since the higher animation of the voices tends greatly to increase the tension of the choral, we shall at first lead our voices quietly, and moderate the use of bye-tones, so as to enable us to sustain the uniform movement of the whole, and to Increase the animation rather than decrease it. Por the same reason, and in order to avoid the overloading or obscuring the harmony, we shall but rarely give a richer treat- 316 ment to two simultaneous voioessand still more rarely to three. Here ci2w^ c/^i^Oe^nf >0 I^V\J< 435. 'ii yfejj:4tuxi m ^ ;: 3L I -^JL M^i i jrr^-i J il l! ?^¥^ p^ mmm '^ 1 ? I n ^ J. Jjv ./j^_ jv m J BEIEPE^^i; t ^ gatEEEf r is the first chor&l treated according to these principles. The most conspicuous moment of the above is the end-tone of the second strophe, which strophe is afterwards repeated as third strophe. This end-tone lasts three beats, and a single harmony, however much varied by suspensions or other means (as in No. 431) would not satisfy us; we had to employ different chords, and reserve the cadence for the last beats. The modulation of the first two strophes is the one which was nearest. In the third strophe, in order to avoid the monotony of a repetition or a halt, we thought at first of the key of A ma- jor as dominant of D ; but A major being too distant from the principal key, we preferred A minor (the parallel of the subdom- inant), and resigned even this key in the very next chord, e-^-S. In the last strophe we have touched upon the subdominant. 317 The examination of the voices is left to the student ; the tenor is least favored in the middle voices. Below will be found two more chorals which the student will do well to examine attentively. The deviations from genesal rules have not been made therein without some particular reason, and at every such point, the student should not rest until the de- viation has been sufficiently justified. 436. 1 m ^-^¥? =*-«- •#tfi«p: S i j5;CTi;^ji ,_j-ji4C^ %^*^f#^^^ 437. u m I *Hl g?3EEE* ^- 318 :i=^ m^ f-r-r- '^^^^m^m^- The importance of the choral, as an educational medium for the student, and as a part of the religious service, prompts us to re- turn to it once more, and to direct attention to two different points. 1. TECHNICAL DIFFICULTIES, These can only exist in the melody when it requires a particu- lar execution of the harmony, or where it stands in the way of a good progression of the voices. The former is the case when a tone or a phrase is repeated several times in succession, or when it takes a turn which prohibits a dignified and rich development of the harmony. The latter is the case in melodies which skip restlessly about, when it often happens that this unsteady movement is communicated to the other voices, or causes a colli- sion with the melody. It will be best 'to consider the single cases. A. Tone-repetition. — Those who know how many harmonies can be made subservient to one tone, wUl have no difficulty in surmounting this obstacle: they will merely have to care for a consistent arrangement of these different harmonies. B. Phrase-repetition. — This is of frequent occurrence in chorals, and requires an attentive consideration. Sometimes the intent of the choral is such that the modulation of such a repeti- tion should not be varied, or, at least, but slightly. Frequently a good arrangement of a few near harmonies can do more than the roaming in the ipost manifold, distant, and unexpected chords. On the following page is the second part of a choral, as illustration. It can be seen at once that this phrase admits of many and richer treatments ; but it would be difficult to find a treat- ment better in keeping with the intent of this choral. 319 438. m m -G- f=FF ^m F? Unfavorable to dignified, ecclesiastical harmony, are such melo- dies or parts of melodies as cling too firmly to one single chord, and thus threaten to exclude other harmonies. Here 439. ^P^^^ rf^f?f*^rf^^?f ^^^^^m is such a case. At a we have treated the first measure triphoni- cally, and the tetraphonio harmony of the next measure is the more effective. At b Tve have balanced the skipping unsteadi- ness of the melody by the calm steadiness of the harmony. 2. ARTISTIC AIM OF CHOEAL TREATMENT. Harmony and melody are merely the means of expressing what moves our soul, and what the choral is intended to arouse in the hearts of the singers and listeners. In works of unrestricted art it is the aim of the artist^of his inner promptings and conviction — ^to seize what is right ; science cannot directly assist his prompting, and his conviction is not a subject for a musical theory. But the treatment of a choral is not a work of fi-ee or unre- stricted art, for it does not issue from the unfettered spirit of the artist. The principal matter (the melody) is given, and in- fluences everything else — rhythm and harmony, more or less. In such case we can only express what the cantus firmus permits or occasions. • Therefore, we advise the student first to investigate the mean- ing of every single choral, to seize the current which issues from 320 the melody and influences the other voices and the modulation. This current cannot be seized by touching upon all possible har- monies, but by a steady development. We must consult what harmony is the first upon which the melody insists, and thence we move on steadily, without rest, never remaining stationary with- out sufficient reason, or returning to something previous, but never passing the nearest to seize something strange or new. Oddity and unexpectedness belong to the dilletante ; that only is truly proper which strictly appertains to the object. This course will indicate to us the proper modulation, and the progres- sion of the voices. 321 CHAPTER V. THE CANTUS FIRMUS IN OTHER VOICES. Until now we have always employed the upper voice as abode of the principal melody ; but it is also possible to mahe one of the other voices the abode of the melody, and in that case we have to consider two points. 1. The cantus firmus will not appear with the same clearness as in the upper voice, and we shall have to arrange the other voices in such a manner that the cantus Jirmus can be distinguished 'from them. 2. The upper voice, though no longer containing the principal •melody, will still absorb considerable attention, and we must, therefore, develope its melody with great care in order to make it satisfactory as the conspicuous part of a whole. In bass and middle voices we can permit occasionally an unmelodious progres- sion, in the upper voice we must not do it. On reconsideration of the means for the formation of an upper voice, as given in the last chapter, we find that they are not quite sufficient. The accompanying voices move in quarter and eighth notes, exactly like the principal melody. This similarity, and the manner of our present treatment, (the simultaneous be- ginning of all the voices) give us but little hope to distinguish the cantus firmus from the other voices, as soon as we take it from the upper voices. Only with more means, and in a later form shall we be enabled fully to accomplish this object. But this later form requires some preliminary practice, and this practice can best be inti'oduced here, where we speak of the cantus Jirmus in the upper voice. It requires but little instrao- tion. If it depends upon us, to which of the three lower voices we shall give the cantus firmus, we have to consider the tone-region first. If a melody lies high, it wiU be more appropriate for the tenor than for alto or bass, unless we transpose the choral to another tone. 322 Then we have to consider the character of the melody. One quickly progressing, will be more appropriate for the alto ; one moving upwards, will be better for the tenor ; one progressing in wide steps, inclining towards below, will be better for the bass. The tenor, in general, is most suitable to take the cantus firmvs. Having made our choice, or having a choice made for us, we first fix upon the plan of modulation, sketch the harmony, and attempt, first of all, to make the new upper voice as consistent and flowing as possible. Where, with one harmony, this is not possible, we select anorther, or a more favorable position of the same, and finally we complete the work by carrying out the other voices. As illustration, we take, here. P A. — The cantus firmus in the Alto. i^f-^-fe^; t 440. f=5^^=f3p ^ B^ ■m — r»— S — '-^ J — r^M p— • -r»— I f- ' d * EPS 323 We perceive, first of all, that on account of its tone-region and moderate movement of steps, the cantus firmus is particularly ap- propriate for the alto ; the seventh and eighth measures only de- part from the character of the alto. Considering the whole, we find confirmed what we have so lately said, namely — the insuffi- ciency of our means for the proper distinction of the cantus Jirmus in the lower voices. Here, evidently, every other voice is -more richly developed than the cantus firmus. If we were to avoid this, for instance, thus, 441. all the voices would become an indifferent, uncharacteristic tone- mass, whether we select the above harmonies or others. Nothing but a doubling of the cantus firmus, or a conspicuous tone-me- dium Tvould serve us to distinguish it from the rest ; this, however, is not our purpose at present. B. — the cantus firmus in the Tenor. We know already, that the tenor, as upper-voice of the male choir, is more appropriate to the cantus firmus. Considering now the relations which are called into existence by this position of the cantus firmus, we perceive that it separates the bass from the other voices, while the higher voice couple, treble and alto, still remain intimately connected. This teaches us, then, that the bass, being sole and independent, will have to be constructed with particular care, because, its isolated position makes it more conspicuous. The two higher voices, however, will cling to each other, and mutually support each other by means of suspensions, progressions in thirds and sixth, or, at least, close position. We need hardly repeat here, that this is not an absolute law, but merely intended to facilitate at.d guide our invention. Most melodies are suitable for the tenor, but particularly so those moving in high tone-regions, or inclining upwards. Here is a former melody, the cantus firmus in the tenor. 442. I 1 324 s^^^^m f-f-r-fr g eis I j I .J J J- i T.^ ^&%=7^^ ;fii ^^e i^:^^^^^ i 3= :d^: rfcl m-r ' zm - iSfT-f- et-i J- -i -J- W7" s^E^^^i^ P s l^rt^^^ n-^:ff^r7-*F->, Jill I I J J- J I I F= r C. — The cantus firmus in the Bass. The introduction of the cantus firmus in the bass, brings with it, in most cases, an inconvenience which can only be hidden, not avoided. The reason of this lies in the fact that most melo- dies are conceived for the treble and tenor, and that consequently they end with the step of a second ; the above, for instance, with c-d, c-5b, a-g, very rarely with the step of a fourth or iifth. It will, therefore, be frequently impossible to form a perfect ca dence. This will be still more inconvenient, when the imperfect cadence occurs at the the end of a part or the whole. How can we now make aiAends for the weakness of our ca- dences 1 The nearest would be a prolongation , then we have the pedal point. But of either means we must make but a lim- ited use, or the whole will be overloaded and spread. We take a former choral as illustration. Its high tone-region makes it 325 perhaps, less appropriate for our object, and we must, therefore, think of avoiding this inconvenience. 443. fc^ ^E:Je^P^SEF^= £p# J JJ-J-J. '" ' ' spppspp^i ?^-?= I — F- ±^^ I I z^ fTT I i :* d_J. IE ^E 3i W. ¥^ =p ^ ^Efe=^ , r-iKj I I I M==f^ SE -© — - — •- --¥ IE T- ^^ =J= & rrr ^-F= p- ^ f=Hi kSljr^ g i- 1 r r- First of all we have reinforced the cantus firmus with a lower octave, an addition which does not change it materially. The plan of the modulation is that mentioned in the first chap- ter ; the third strophe only had to submit to a slight alteration. This strophe, according to known principles, should have closed with a half-cadence in 5b major, or with a modulation to F m^ jor. But this was not practicable in the present instance, for the closing tone of the cantus firmus (c), would have forced us to end with a quart-sext chord. "We had to consider it as funda- mental tone, and to close in the parallel of the subdominant. We are now at the point from which we can give a clear view of the whole proceeding. It is clear the cantus firmus in the bass gives us nothing but a melodically-regulated series of tones, upon 326 which we have to construct chords, and above which we have to lead the other voices as melodically as possible. Whence above all, shall we now take the chords ? Each bass-tone can be fundamental tone of a triad, a septim* chord, and a nonachord ; it can be another interval in an inverted chord, it can be a tone foreign to a chord — suspension, pass, anti- cipation. What shall we choose from the above 1 We select again, first, what is most necessary for the plan of modulation, then we think of the nearest, or of the most appropriate for the particular case. Thus, our first strophe closes with the dominant chord, (inversion) and the tonic triad ; it begins with the domi- nant triad (apparently in JF major), then follows, with remaining bass, the dominant chord of the same key, and finally it passes with dominant chord and triad into the principal tone, £\) major. The remainder needs no explanation ; the beginning, resembling the pedal-point, indicates the end. Let us now turn to the char acter of the voices. The high region, and the ascending character of the cantvs firmus press the other voices upwards, and limit them to a small space. They have, therefore, formed themselves melodi- cally simple. 327 CHAPTER VI. MOEE AND LESS VOICED TREATMENT OF THE CHORAL. We have to add a few words in regard to the treatment of the choral for more or less than' four voices, though the most neces- sary facts have been given already in the tenth part of the first book. A. THE CHORAL WITH LESS THAN FOUE VOICES. The choral, as we know it at present, requires fiill harmony, at least tetraphonic, the more, since in comparison with other compositions, it so much lacks melodical volume and rhythmical variety. The simple tones, generally of equal measural value and in short strophes, without harmonic volume would be but a mere thiii thread. Therefore a triphonic, or perhaps duophonio treatment can only be justified by particular reasons, and with many chorals it will be absolutely impossible to render them satis- factory duophonioally. The reasons for triphonic or duophonic treatment are either ex- ternal, when we have not more voices: or internal, when this sim. pier treatment conveys a particular expression ; for instance, when we intend to represent the whole in a light, free, and trans- parent manner ; or when we have in view a combination of par- ticular voices, for instance, two female voices and a bass, two male voices and a treble, &c. In all these cases we must select such harmonies as are suitable for a duophonio or triphonic treatment. Many good combina- tions will have to be sacrificed, and many otherwise less appro- priate harmonies will have to be seized. But in either case the melody of the voices requires particular care, because the less voices, the more distinctly will the feults and merits of each be preserved. 1. — The Duophonic Treatment. In duophonic composition it will be necessary to construct the accompanying voice as simply as possible. It is best to keep 328 the voices together, and to limit them to the most necessary in- tervals. Thus the following choral might be treated in this manner : 444. m#». ■&?: W I iy= 3 1 n f=lS I r f ^- r The second and third strophes hegin with a suspension, under the supposition that there is but a small or no pause between. If, for particular reasons, two more distant voices are taken, it will be better to give to the accompanying voice a peculiar char- acteristic; for the two voices, under any circumstance, will not be well connected. The above phrase would, therefore, be more ap- propriate for treble and alto, or tenor and bass, than for treble and bass. In the latter case it would be better to construct the bass perhaps in this manner. 445. aiS t jtt: s?^ s 2. — The Triphonic Treatment. This treatment is not merely richer in tones and harmonies, but it admits also of a freer and richer development of the voices. For the two voices at its command are by themselves already sufficient to give a character to the whole, in case we should go beyond what is absolutely necessary. And since a richer devel- opment of the voices is permitted, we have also the means to make up in melodical volume and fullness of the single voices what we lack in numbers of chord-tones. Harmonic bye-tones, suspensions, and passing-tones will do justice to our hannonies, and at the same time melodically perfect our voices. But we must not lose sight of the character of the choral. A triphonic treatment of the last choral is given here, merely to remind us that the greatest simplicity can often be sufficient. 329 446. II E m^^^^M fe^^ggai is i ¥ i :SE=3 =?2:: 'P?>n*^ fE-:^ 2221 m -jt=zt^zJlzjt gE^^jE The voices in the following are developed in a richer and more mobile manner. 447. ^:^=y BrRr-^h— '^ ^--hp-f --^-ff]fft»-j> _ I — ^ »- SF=%f J=J=-Lt^^.j EdEddEJEJ r-^^ i^n ■©--r SS l}J_:f:_l^_^d;.d_ t^fe r The triphonic choral is also well fitted to have the cantus firmus in the iower or middle voice. This requires no instruc- tion, and simply as example we give here the above ohog^l with the cantus firmus in the tenor. 330 EfS^^^^Pfe3?E^3E P m '& 448. e^FJq:^fej=-FP^J =!^" PT»^j:=fc^d=i =F^ P^ t^ztpz B. — ^Thb choeal with mobe than four voices. We are convinced that the tetraphonio choral is quite satisfec- tory in regard to harmonic volume and fullness. Therefore we shall never write a choral for more than four voices, except for particular reasons ; sonietimes only we add to the last strophe, or to the last chords of a choral, another voice, in order to ob- tain a full ending. For either case the information given in the second chapter, tenth part, of the last book, will be sufficient. 331 CHAPTER VII. HOW TO ACQUIRE FACILITY IS THE HARMONIZATIOlf OF THE CHORAL. We have always maintained that a choral (or any melody) can be treated in various ways, and that there is no absolutely best treatment possible, but that object and circumstances give preference at one time to one, at another time to another treat- ment. We require, therefore, the capability and the facility to harmonize a given melody in various ways. We have given the means in former chapters, and can add nothing new, but we repeat here that the practice makes us con- scious of our powers, and we now merely indicate how the most manifold treatments can be obtained from a single melody. There is an external and internal variety of treatment. The external variety consists in the fact that a choral can be treated duophonically, triphonically, tetraphonically, and poly- phonically ; that the cantus firmus can be placed in the upper voice, the middle voices, or the lower voice. These are the ex- ternal forms of choral-treatment, as far as we know them at pres- ent. Each of them, however, can be carried out in the most man- ifold manners ; we can make use at the same time of different har- monies, and different construction of the voices ; we can trans- pose the cantus Jirmus as well in the triphonic as in. the tetra- phonic and polyphonic choral. But placing aside all these various forms, we will limit ourselves to the tetraphonic treatment, and to the cantus firmus in the upper voice. Tile internal variety, to which we have thus limited ourselves, is based upon the different modulation, harmony, and construction of voices which we can give to a choral melody. The construc- tion of the voices is the easiest, and therefore least important to us; it is conditioned, essentially at least, by the choice of chords. We shall merely remember to make them as melodious as possi- ble. But the modulatory and harmonic design or sketch are the 332 most important for us. How can we always find new modula- tions and harmonies, without trusting to chance ? The reply to this question and the necessary instruction, constitute the con- tents of this chapter. In general we can only repeat what we know already. We first ascertain the key, and fix upon the principal mo- ments, the ending and turning-points of the modulation, accord- ingly. Next to the principal key we must ascertain of what modulation the close of each strophe admits. Here we take the nearest first, and pass thence to the more distant. And to these end-points we lead our harmony, employing first the nearest, then the most appropriate, and finally those in general admissible, taking advantage, however, of the slightest alteration which opens to us a new way. This wiU result, also, in designs and direc- tions of the bass, at which we have to consult how they can be employed in one or the other manner. But now to work. We take the following choral, and simply because it contains the greatest number of repetitions in the small- est space. 449. fc Sgfefj ?2=S=i *-•- cSasS yap^ i .0-0- m ^EfagEf: -0-0. We shall merely give beginning and indication, and it remains for the student to carry it out. The first strophe is the most naturally in the principal key. 450. -• • 0- -0 a •■ ^rr f=±f « J- We have taken the tonic chord for the first two tones, and led the bass in a higher octave. Let us now attempt to lead the bass in an opposite direction. 333 451. 1 ^fe^l TIT rfr'=FT=f jlj f =t r The bass ascends rather far, and forces the middle voice to an equally passionate ascension. If we were to begin in this man- ner, the following strophe would have to avoid such exaggeration, but in its stead we might exhibit a more marked direction. It might, perhaps, be thus : 452. ^lf=i- m- A i^ I al £^S i^^ =F 1r S^F But let us return to No. 451. The exaggeration of the bass lies particularly in its last step upwards ; the middle voices have to ascend so high, because they have begun too low. This gives us a new treatment. 453. ^^ ;fe^| Jl A- -d.J-J-d ^ f=F="=r=r ,iV I 1 I -d .4. f=F . I I £ The bass, from the fourth tone, might also have proceeded in this manner : 454. ^^"^' m It: 6 7 7 6 6 7 but in all these cases it would be advisable to employ for the second strophe a less extended progression of the voices. 334 Both these fundamentiil forms exhibited a bass progressing in wide steps. Let us now attempt a more quiet melody for this voice. 455. i k fe-^E :ttP= ^E m i I 1 E^; We might continue the diatonic movement of the bass, perhaps thus: 456. m^Hm ^ tt rj r g^ The bass descends here chromatically, and ascends again diatoni- cally. But there was no need of discontinuing the chromaticpro- gression ; we might have continued thus : 45T. ii * rJ=i P^^^^- i m J^J r .5-^ 1 1 -g**' ipi =F and this would have enabled us to close in the tonic, instead of modulating at so early a moment to the parallel. If we were to continue either of the above, we should prefer a diatonic pro- gression, because the chromatic progression would embarrass us by the smallness of the steps, and by their being harmonically so unlike. We should, perhaps, continue thus : 458.be mt 3 6 4 8 6 4 t g^fe 335 We must break off here, in order not to anticipate too much for mere indications. All these formations are based upon the first two chords, being the triad of 0, or perhaps an inversion of it. Let us now depart from this first harmonization. We retain the tonic chord for the first tone, but we must find a different harmony for the second. What now can the tone ^f be ? We have already considered it as fundamental tone, but it can also be third or fifth. The latter leads us to the subdominant of the principal tone, and is, therefore, the nearest. ■ Sebastian Bach has solved the question for us in four different manners. Here they are : 459. & teS^^f^ mi r^=£ff=mT & l-j&i , A, or B, we must consider it as D Mixolydian, A Dorian or B Phrygian. We have thus exhibited the general rule of ancient signature in transposed keys. It is immaterial to us that not all keys were transposed in this manner, as we have only to do with the melodies as we find them. It will now be easy to understand the signature of other trans- positions. To represent, for instance, the Phrygian key in the tone-chain of D or 0, — 346 «, /i 9, «. *. «. d, e, <^) «b, / ^, a, *!?, c, d, «) 4, e|7, /, ff, a},, b\,, e, — t required in the one case two, in the other case four flats. A melody of the tone-chain J), therefore, with a signature of two flats, or of the tone-chain C, with four flats,, is to be considered as a transposed Phrygian. Thus we see a series of diiferent keys before us ; each can ad- mit foreign tones in its melodies and harmonies ; each, also, can be represented by means of foreign tones, in more than one tone- chain, and though until now we have only observed the external deviations of these keys, it is clear that these must also have given them a diiferent internal character, which we shall endeavor, at some future time, to comprehend. F. Modulation into other Keyi. In order to complete our analysis of the ancient system, we must add, finally, that like our own system it possesses the all powerful means of modulation from one key into the other, and the combination of different keys in one composition. We know of two ways of modulating. 1. We follow the path ;f the quint-circle, and pass from one major tone to another, or, ny means of the parallel, we go from a minor key to another major key, and vice versa. 2. We substitute, on the same tonic, minor for major, or major for minor. The ancients, too, modulated according to their quint-succes- sion—and in still different progressions ; but they always found diiferent keys. Or, by means of tone-transposition, they formed a new key on the same tonic — ^modulated without leaving the tonic— but, here too, they had a vastly greater variety than we with our major and minor. On the other side again, the more decided, peculiar character of their different keys conditioned it that certain digressions or modulations were absolutely inadmissible, whUe we, though gen- erally seizing the nearest related key, are not prevented from modulating into every possible key. Thus much in general of the ancient keys ; and now for a sepa- rate consideration of each, and its treatment. 347 CHAPTER II. THE lONIAIf KEY. We know already that the Ionian key is the only one among the ecclesiastical keys resembling one of our modern keys — major. — But all our^iajor keys have the same construction, while the ancients, in their Mixolydian, and, if they chose, in their Lydian key, had two more, differently constructed major keys. Thus the character of each, and consequently that of the Ionian also, became peculiarly distinct. We can see this at once in the order of the modulation. Ac- cording to the principles of our modern system the modulation in major goes almost invariably first to the key of the dominant, for instance in C to G ; this is the nearest, — ^but for that reason also the most common, least exalting modulation. But for this very reason, in the ancient church-melodies, it was least liked, it was not high-minded, not festal, not exalting enough. In fact it could hardly stand for an actual modulation. For, what do we find on the Ionian dominant 1 Either another Ionian tone- chain, (hypo-Ionian) or the Mixolydian key, which, for reasons to be afterwards explained, was as little sufiicient to rise from the Ionian tonic. Therefore, in the reign of the ancient system, we find the modu- lation into the dominant either entirely avoided, by means of ca- dences in the principal key or the subdominant, or retarded upon the parallel of the subdominant, if not an actual modulation into that key {A jEolian). Thus Sebastian Bach, in three different treatments of a choral with the following strophe : 464. ^=r H=^i=^ ^ forms its cadence, the first time with the subdominant and tonic, and on its recurrence he treats it thus : 348 465. ^pi^iS^P +-r s^ u ^^^^m 349 CHAPTER III. THE MIXOLYDIAIf KEY. We know of it, that it is a major scale with minor Seventh, and' therefore with a minor triad on the dominant. It lacks therefore the possibility of a perfect cadence, according to our prmciples. We have nothing left, then, but to make our cadence by means of the subdominant ; a cadence which we have used occasionally as a half-cadence, and which is generally known under the name of ecclesiastical cadence. This is by no means, however, the only ecclesiastical cadence, and we shall soon arrive at others. Never- theless there is in the Mixolydian key a dominant chord, but it is on the tonic and points towards the Ionian scale. For this reason has the Mixolydian key a peculiar inclination to modulate into the Ionian. Mixolydian is in fact Ionian in its origin, therefore it takes part in the transpositions of the Ionian. G Mixolydian (originally Ionian), like Q Ionian goes into F Ionian ; a modulation which lies very far from our Q- major. In order to exhibit the peculiar characteristics of this key we give here a Bohemian choral, (p cJ,/u^ ^«... ^ , > X-M 466. i^3^Ji "^^m ^ i i ?i f=i= i f S«f-,'rrT'rT a 1 f- 350 CHAPTER IV. THE DORIAK KEY. The Dorian is the first minor key of the ancient system. We know already that it has a major triad upon the subdominant, and that it can change the triad of the dominant into a^ major, by introducing (?|. Thus the major element is predominant^ and the minor of the tonic cannot impress us sadly, but merely with a deep earnestness. This is the character of this key. Severe and strict, but not sad, it was the key to which the ancients en- trusted their most solemn music, for instance the Oredo, and in short most of their ecclesiastical songs. The authentic character and the low region of most of the Dorian melodies corresponds with this character. The Dorian makes its nearest modulation into its dominant, the ^olian, or represents this key upon its own tonic in the genus molle (d, e, /, g, a, b\) , «, d). But it is frequently the case that other modulations precede this one. The intimate connection with the Mixolydian, with which the Dorian has the subdominant chord and the two characteristic tones (/and b) in commpn, prompts it to modulate into the Mixolydian. With the Mixolydian it goes into the Ionian, and with the Ionian it goes to the subdominant of the latter, F Lydian. Again we give here a Dorian choral which exhibits that key in its mosL distant And rare turns, i J ff. -^ ^ ^ *mJ ' 467. 351 *^mm^ ^mm 352 CHAPTEE V, THE ^OLIANKET. Upon the dominant of the Dorian rises the jEolian key. Its characteristic tones are c and^j the minor Third and minor Sixth. The seventh, however, not being a characteristic tone, is often changed into a major seventh, and thus makes it possible to have the triad of the dominant major, and the cadence of the jEolian key decisive. This key, softer and gentler than its predecessors, does not modulate into the minor or major key of its dominant, for this ■would require the major triad or septime chord h, rf|, /|; or h, d\, /j(, a. But the ancient system has no rfjj, and / being in the ./Eolian an essential tone, /|t is not permitted. Nor can the .(Eolian go to I) Dorian, for this would require the tone c\, and ct] is another essential tone. The jEolian, instead of making use of these striking modular tions, is satisfied with half cadences upon its dominant (without modulation), or turns to the Phiygian (which can hardly be called a modulation) and through that into the Ionian. © '-^ T~ 4fi8 » ^ 1 p n '^ ' ■ |— When we take into consideration, now, that the jEolian melo- dies are invariably plagalic, we see that everything combines to give this key a quiet, gentle, suffering, passive character, the sad- ness of which is only relieved by the frequent half cadences upon the dominant. Here is an jEolian melody, which in keeping with its inclination merely passingly touches upon the Ionian, 469. ^^^^i# ^^^m^ i^^Si*^*i ur ag^ T'-rr $ r I "Cj f^^: r^r 354 CHAPTER VI. THE PHKYGIAN KEY. This is the last of the ecclesiastical keys, and with its minor Third and minor Sixth, it distinguishes itself from all other keys by its minor Second. The latter,/, is therefore its characteristic lone and cannot be changed. This, however, naturally conditions the minor seventh, d, even apart from the fact that the ancients had no major seventh (rf|) from e. For, it is characteristic of all diatonic scales, and consequently of all ecclesiastical scales, that two half steps never succeed each other. If therefore, we were to give to the Phrygian scale a d |, — «. /, 9, a, b, c rf|, e,f, &c. two half steps would appear in succession, and the scale, for the time, would be chromatic. From this follows then, that the Phrygian key has no cadence which we should consider perfect ; nor, in fact, can it form any cadence with tones belonging to it, for this would require the tones b, d jj, /jj. Thus it is entirely dependent upon the jEolian, from which it originated, and can close in no other way but upon the dominant of the same, e, g!^, b, — i. e. with the use of a foreign tone; the half cadence of the jEolian (from ^ to ^) serves in this instance as fuU cadence. We perceive here in two minor tones, again, the same reversion of the order of modulation which we formerly noticed in two major tones, the Ionian and the Mixolydian ; only that the Phrygian cadence is still less independent than the Mixolydian, because in its very final chord it requires a foreign tone. This led to the strengthening of its cadence. It was effected either by introducing in this preparatory harmony the character- istic tones, d and f, — or in addition to them the minor third ol the tonic, ff. Thus have we two Phrygian cadences : 470. i*^^ 355 which are peculiar to this key, but by no means as decisive and satisfactory as our own cadences. In consequence of the relation between the Phrygian and the Molim. keys the former likes the modulation in the latter, as well as the latter inclines towards the former. Weak and helpless as the Phrygian stands there, it is really as- tonishing that in connection with the Ionian, which can be placed imder it without hesitation. Ionian. we should obtain so significant a result. We see here a close intimate connection with the Ionian, the firmest and clearest major tone, and through it we are led at once to the Hypo-Ionian &. The dependant nature of the Phrygian, and its relation to an almost opposite major key, causes that its melodies often begin in tones of one of these related keys, so that it is almost impossible to know at once in which key the melody is^it^en. ^ H,r^. , . ^^^ ^ A/fe,.^ ^^ Q^ic^^w^ Ht^ I '^^^^m 472, ^PP iUl £ fm^ m m 1^-4 mw^ r^.rf BE Uii II m 5J^ ii-- ^f3g ?3^3F r the first strophe points distinctly to the Dorian key ; but the next strophe having a modulation to the Ionian (7, proves that the former cannot be the reigning key. Only towards the end we recognize the Phrygian distinctly. 356 CHAPTER VII. THE LTDIAN KEY. We have reserved the analyzation of this key for the last. One reason for this rather irregular proceeding is, that even in the ancient system, this key has never been able to acquire an independent and rich application, and that, since the reformation, it has vanished entirely. Only in Bohemian collections do we find Lydian melodies at all, and in others the Lydian appears merely passingly in other keys, particularly in Dorian melodies. Its characteristic is b, the superfluous fourth of the tonic. This one tone only, distinguishes it from the Ionian and from all the other keys ; b, therefore, must not be altered as long as the key is intended to be Lydian. The fact of this tone's making a dominant chord impossible (c-e-g-b\i) would not have mattered much ; for most of the cadences were prepared, not by the dom- inant chord, but by the triad of the dominant. Nor would it have made much difference that the superfluous fourth (/ — b) is an unmelodious proportion ; for it was easy enough to avoid this step wherever it disagreed with the melody. But in other re- spects this tone b, — thei only characteristic of the key, — ^was the cause of the decline of this key. In the first place the Lydian scales resembled another much more apt and useful scale (the Ionian in the genus molle : /, 9, a, K e, d, «, f,) to such a degree that it could not well escape being mixed up with it. In the second place the Lydian, in consequence of this very b, lacked the tonic harmony of the subdominant, and conse- quently could not modvdate there, and was thus crippled on one side. And, thirdly, there was nothing to indemnify us for this loss ; for this b could only lead to a modulation into the domi- nant — a modulation at once characteristic of nothing and the most commonplace. Every single key, except the Phrygian, had it, and without demanding a sacrifice. These are the causes of the 357 Lydian's never obtaining any extensive efficacy, and the reasons for our separating it from the other ecclesiastical keys. The deep meaning of the ancient system could not be denied, and in many instances we had to accord to it more subtle dis- tinctions and better characteristics than our own. But it would be a misunderstanding and an unartistio roaming, if we were to en- deavor, in our labors, to return to the rule of the ancient system. Every form of expression which the ancient system oifers to us, we have in our own system, with the additional advantage that while we can make a free use of them, the ancients were restric- ted by regulations and rules. These, for the standard of modern art, are no longer necessary ; nay, such oppression would be insupportable to the tone-artist ; he wants liberty. And in the same degree as this liberty was achieved, the directions which the ancient system gave for certain objects had necessarily to become inefficient. 358 Third Part. The Secular National Song.* We need hardly mention that by "national songs " we mean those melodies which have really lived among the people ; not those which more strictly, should be called patriotic songs, nor do we speak of those which one composer or another has invented in the manner of the people. Such manufactured national songs may have artistical merit (perhaps more than an actual national song), but they have not lived among the people, they have not become its property, they have not been attuned to the people's sense or voices ! Only where that has been done — where the song has ceased to be the work of an individual, a composition, where it has become the property, the organic word, the voice of the people — only there we see the national song before us. And as such it is the most vivid characteristic of a nation, one of the most invaluable vibrations, in which every nation unconsciously exhibits the enigma of its fexistence and of its sensations. This is the deep meaning of the national song, and by it it be- comes deeply significant to the musician, who is probably the most capable of taking in and comprehending the simple melody. Whatever the real national song teaches him of his art is true . and genuine ; perhaps not for general purposes, but always in the sense of the nation from which it originates. But for this very reason it must not be judged by general principles, but in the sense of its parents. We have always avoided the abstract application of made rules ; if a foi-mation does not correspond to general rules, we do not pronounce it wrong for that, but we search for the particular reasons of the deviation. The people who invented them have not known those nales, they have only unconsciously carried them within them. But present above all and nearest to their heaits was * This word does not exactly express the meaning of the author, but as the translator could not find a better one, and as the true meaning of it will become apparent to the reader in the course of his studies, the translator has thought it best to retain this word. 359 the feeling of the moment, of the conditions under which the song became their property. Here must we look for the nearest and truest reasons for the melody of the song, and the deviation from general law. Thus much of the interest which the national songs have for us. They are so important and so instructive that no musician should neglect to make himself familiar with them ; not to imi- tate them, (that would be vain) nor to employ them in his own works, (that would be little) but to enter more deeply into the soul of art. This occupation can be limited, as can every other work, to the mere performing, or meditating upon the form and' the con- tents of the song, or it can consist of an independent treatment, i. e, invention of an accompaniment, or perhaps the representation of a national song as an independent composition (without words, for instance upon the Piano, or by a combination of other instni- ments). For the national song, as such, is sung by the people, sometimes unaccompanied and monophonic, sometimes the singers construct, from it by ear, and without regard to rule or principle, a duophonic, or triphonie phrase ; often it is accompanied by a pe culiarly national instrument. If the musician, now, has to invent an accompaniment, he can do so, either in the style of the people, in which case his accom- paniment will be subordinate ; or he can accomplish a higher ob- ject, i. e., by means of his accompaniment, and by its manner, he can increase the expression of the song, and thus elevate the work itself, and the hearer, into a higher sphere. In the first case the song remains in its natural sphere, expressive of a popular na- tional word or sentiment. In the other case it becomes an inde- pendent work of art and can no longer be considered as a mere national song. To the latter class belongs the " collection of Scotch songs," by Beethoven. " A cyclus of songs to a distant friend," by the same author, might also be included here ; like- wise the arrangement by Liszt of Schubert's songs. We shall begin with the most simple, and make it a rule to consider the Pianoforte as accompaning instrument. 360 CHAPTER I. GENERAL CONCEPTION OF THE MELODY. Thk first task in the treatment of a national song is the desig- nation of its key ; for it can easily he imagined that among the people a song is sung in one key or another, just as it suits the singer. 1. CONSIDERATION OF VOICE-REGION. In this selection we must think above all of a proper position of tones for the voice. The national song is intended to he sung hy many, and must not exceed the ordinary compass of voices. Though it is impossihle to give the exact points to which the compass might extend, as one nation sings higher or lower than another, it will still he well to confine ourselves to the tenth : d~—f: a tone-chain which lies convenient for high voices and is at least in reach of the lower ones. 2. CHAKACTBK OF KEYS. The next important point is the character of the key which we select. Every musician knows, or ought to know, that every key, apart from height or depth, and apart from the peculiar character of different instruments, has a character of its own, now warm, now cool, now sad and gentle, now clear and firm, which character is transmitted to the listener. If we have now at all perceived this difference of character, it is hut natural that we should select, if possible, that key which corresponds best with the character of the song. 361 CHAPTER II. PIAN OF THE HAEMONY. The actual work of the composer begins but now, with the se- lection of the harmony and the modulation. Though we shall be guided by the same principles which assisted us in our former la^ bors, we shall, in two respects, go farther than in the choral. Firstly, the national songs in general differ more from each other than the chorals, for in the one we see a representation of all the various conditions of humaiiity in all their variety ; the various sensations are represented in the most peculiar, finest and sharpest features, while in the choral, everything is subordinate to the general form and character of devotion. Secondly, in the choral, we have in addition to the uniformity of rhythm a uniform distribution of harmony, — ^generally a chord for each measural part or syllable,^and in order to avoid under those circumstances monotony and weakness, wa have made our harmonies energetic, and our voices as melodious as possible. But this is altogether different in our secular songs. The variety of their contents and their predominating mood has given us a variety of rhythm, and has characterized each melody distinctly. We can, therefore, no longer speak of a uniform or impartial distribu- tion of chords. The harmony has no longer the obligation to in- demnify us by variety and vigor for the monotony of the rhythm, it intends only to support the melody of the song, and the accom- panying voices become subordinate to the melody. In the treatment of such melodies we must decide therefore, above all, upon 1. — The Measure or ike Quantity of the Harmony. But according to which law 1 — ^According to one already known to us. Already in the first chapter of the eighth part, we have learned to consider the chords as so many spaces in which the various voices 362 move about. In going from one chord to another, therefore, the voices merely move from one space into another. In the same manner we have considered the various keys through which we pass in the course of a composition as so many spaces, — but larger and more important than the former. It is clear, therefore, that we consider every step into another space as an important moment of the whole, which separates the contents of one space more or less distinctly from that of another. Consequently we must keep together as much as possible, in one harmon- ic or modulatonic space, those tones of the melody which be- long together. * The rhythmic-melodic construction of a song decides generally what tones belong together. To begin then with our labor, let us take the melody of the well-known, " Qod save the Queen ;" 473, p^ii^ ^^ itat The whole formation tells us at once that the melody consists of three sections of two measures each. In order to represent the progression of this melody in the most clear and simple manner, since it would be unnatural to force all the six tones of each sec- tion under one chord, — we will at least designate the end of each section with a harmonic point of rest. This would give us an ac- companiment like the following : 474. ^m^^^^^ ^3S3 ± J- f£p But we see already that there can be more than one division of spaces, and that the necessity of supporting the sectional points of the melody is not always alike pressing. Thus, in the above melody, we might have embraced the first two tones of the first and third measures, and the three tones of the fifth measure, in 363 one chord {ff, b, d, and d, /|, o, c); and vice versa, we might have given the tones of the second and fourth measures to two or three chords. The decision in such case depends upon the char- acter of the song, or the object of our treatment ; but it will al- ways be seen, that, the more changing of chords we permit, the more weighty, and the more tones we comprehend under few chords, the more light and animated will be the song. But returning to our national song we see, that however clear and simple the above treatment, it by no means corresponds to the weight of such a song. The following would be far more suitable : 475. ^m^ I I tT> m^^^ The Italian prayer " O sanctissima," Andante. , m^- 5;££ O sano- tis - si - ma ! pi - is - si- ma I Dul ^=p: m 221 iifriz --^t'.:^^ n - i^i a! Ma - ter a - ma - ta, In teme- =S^SEli =F ra - ta, - ra, - ra pro no bis. should be treated in like manner. The second and fourth measures had best remain on one chord. The second part would perhaps begin thus : 477. ^PS f^m- S=:: 4 -iJ- -J- . 1 'A -9- -•- -©- P =?2= m 364 2. — Number of Accompanying Voices.* Next to the chords we must decide upon the number of voices which are to accompany the song. The more tones we combine, the more full and heavy will be the mass of the accompaniment ; the less voices we employ, the more mobile and light will be the whole. The above is so clear that it will be comparatively easy to judge how many voices are requisite for one song or the other. Two voices, three, four, or five voices can be made effective if ju- diciously employed. Until now we have only considered what number of voices is in general more appropriate for this or the other song ; we have now to add two other considerations which were not requisite in the chorals : 1st, We shall soon perceive that in one and the same song there is sometimes a section which demands a stronger emphasis than another ; sometimes in consequence of the words, sometimes on account of the musical contents of the song itself. The mere change of forte and piano is often insufficient for such purpose ; even the peculiar treatment of the hannony will now and then be unable to accomplish it. But the alternate use of few and many voices will often produce the desired effect. Thus the following song : 478. ^^il^gH 35 ^^S^l :P5- H ^=^ ■0 — •- 3E3EE iii= :^m i^i^^pi * •— might be treated with full harmony in the longer tones, M-hile the shorter tones might be treated more lightly, perhaps thus : * As a matter of oourse we have no reference here to the number of singers, nor to the forte and piano of instruments, but merely to the number of voices constituting the harmony. 365 479. :£3E OFEF^; m I I H 'J i 1 I I i^-^ ■^ ==1-f^- eE£ -i^- £ E5 But we will remember the advice given on former occasions, (Book I., first part, chapter II.) and effect this change in the num ber of voices only at the beginning of new rhythmical sections. — In the chorals such change would be possible, and occasionally even effective, but as a general thing it is absolutely unnecessary, as it depends above all, upon the typical character of the choral, which, altogether independent from the number of voices, demands the first and only consideration. 2nd, We shall make use — particularly on instruments incar pable of forte and piano, or sustaining the tones, like the organ or pianoforte, or for the accomplishment of particular effects — ol the polyphony for single moments, while otherwise we proceed with one or two voices. As illustration we give here a well- known military song : 480. ^# P^T 5E g: a f M In such cases the decision depends upon the rhythmical construo tion or accents which the particular character of the words and melody demands. Every other direction is superfluous. 366 Occasionally the number of voices is reduced to make the ac- companiment more practicable. Finally we must consider 3. — The Form of the Harmony. Until now we have used the chords in different positions, &c., but always so that the tones belonging to them generally entered simultaneously. But in this very simultaneous sounding of three or more tones there was an unwieldiness and awkwardness which was long a stumbling-block to us, and which we must now try to overcome. The means for it were always at our command. We have seen already that the tones of a harmony can be introduced not merely simultaneously, but also one after the other ; in the first case the haraiony appears in harmonic form, in the latter case in melodic form. Between the two stand the well-known figures in which one or two voices of the harmony anticipate the others, like : 481. The melodic form of the harmony gives us many ingenious formations, which are called harmonic figurations, and which we shall now consider. 867 CHAPTER III. HAEMONIC FIGURATION Discovery of its Designs, ■ We know already that with the name " harmonic figurations" we designate the representation of the harmony in melodic form. The tones of a chord are not sounded simultaneously but one af- ter the other. But in what succession? Here are three tones 1- 2. 3. 4. 6. 6. 482. ^iig^g^g^ii t- i which give us already six different forms. Four tones give us twenty-four forms, independent of the variations which might be produced by change of rhythm. Even now we see that it is next to impossible to exhaust the foi-ms of harmonic figuration, and that we merely can give an insight into this element. First of all let us glance at the designs. 1. — Monophonic Designs. In No. 482 we have been made acquainted with the designs arising from three tones^ without taking into consideration tone- repetition and rhythm. Of course, every other three tones, or three differently-situated tones give us six other designs, and every four tones give us twenty-four designs. The nonachord in its primitive form would give us one hundred and twenty-five de- signs. If we add to this the rhythmical variety and tone-repeti- tion, a single design of No. 482. 483.: Eg i^^it= $^^^^^^m. 368 gives us endless numbers of other designs. In short this element is absolutely inexhaustible. 2. — Duophonie and Polyphonic Designs. In the above we have resolved a whole chord in melodic form. But we can retain a part of it, and figurate the other ; thus we have here 484. Ah i i=i aSsS-^^ i $ tlSWWW r r figurated four chords in such manner, that at a we retained the upper voice, at b the lower voice, and at c the upper and lower voices, while the middle voice is figurated. In the former cases we have made from a triphonic or tetraphonic chord a monopho- nic succession ; in this case we make a tetraphonic phrase duo- phonic or triphonic ; but in the figural voice there are contained three or two harmonic voices. But such duophonie or triphonic phrases can again be made tetraphonic or polyphonic by the addition of new voices : I 485. '^mm^^ ffi ^•E HH^P $ i ^ li^i^t m^ir^^Sjr^t^^^ m ^^m^ ^ r 369 It is clear, however, from the above, that such phrases, if re- duced to the harmonic form, are not triphonic or tetraphonic, but pentaphonic, hexaphonic. &c., and in reality present this appear- ance : 486. =i=S=r= =i=iC=5= =r=«="=?=n^ ^^^m 1B=P= We leave the student to practice such figuration. We have here only seized the nearest. It will not be difficult to find more. 370 CHAPTER IV. EXECUTION OF THE HAEMOMC nGURATIOK. It will require but few observations to guide us merely in the execution of the harmonic figuration. They fall into two halves, just as we consider them from, a harinonio or melodic point of view. A. THE HARMONIC POINT OF VIEW. The harmonic figuration is in reality nothing but an actual har mony, but represented partly or entirely in melodic form. Con- sequently it has to submit to all those rules which have guided us in our harmony in general. If, therefore, we start from a previ- ously fixed harmony, as in No. 482, or imagine at least such a harmony as in Nos. 484 and 487, we are involuntarily led to a proper observance of those rules. This will give rise, however, to some points worth mentioning, 1. — Retarded Resohition. Let us reconsider the figurations of No. 484 and their harmonic basis. 437., ^i r -•- -»- r r r -"- r -221 -a- In the simple harmony the septime chords are properly re- solved ; h goes to c, / descends to e. In the figuration, however, at A, the seventh goes not to e, but ascends to g. It is only af- terwards that c follows in the same voice, and finally e. There is a similar case at b. Are these tones treated wrongly ? No ; 371 the figural voice contains three harmonic voices, the tones of which do not enter simultaneously, but one after the other. This is called a " retarded resolution." The same takes place if there are suspensions in the harmony, as in the following : 488. It is undeniable that the immediate resolution gives the quick, est satisfaction, and is therefore the mildest formation. But the retarded resolution can exercise by its very retarding of one or more tones a peculiar charm, and is absolutely indispensable, in many cases, to the consistent execution of a figural design. 2. — Octave and Quint- Succession. The attentive reader will already have noticed that in No. 485, at A, c, D, and e, there have occurred octave-successions which in No. 486 have been made apparent. Thus we see here. 489. m- ^3-^53. ^ "■?~T n i at A, octave- and quint-successions which appear at b uncovered. Are such successions wrong ? No ! In harmonic respect they are by no means as distinct as those of our former harmonic forms ; for the figural voice hides and covers them with melodic bye-tones in such a manner, and is in itself such a mobile and flowing melody that the suspicious successions are only the consequences of the doubling of all the voices. But even if an actual faulty succession forms the basis of a figurated phrase ; for instance, here : 372 490. P imm T T 4M I I =^ the melodic form and the intermediate steps (here a sixth between every two fifths) would mitigate the bad effects of such succes- sions considerably. 3. — Passing- Tones. Though the passing-tones do not belong to the harmony, they enter simultaneously with it, and we have often considered them as actual tones of the haiTaony. Therefore it is evident that they can be introduced into the harmonic figuration as if they were essential tones of the harmony. This has been done in the fol- lowing little phrase : 491. B I -^r4 i -P =^z F| f->-r^^?--r-P=.i fipzpipi'^irprp^p; BE N -d- \ -I \ i =?2= The d in the first measure is a passing-tone ; the c of the second measure is first a suspension and becomes afterwards a passing- tone to the expected d. The same takes place in the third and fourth measures. / B.- -THE MELODIC POINT OF VIEW. Each figural voice represents, above all, a melody, and as far as its contents and its relations to the other voices permit, it 373 must follow the laws of melody. Of these laws there are two in particular which demand mention. 1. — Consistency of Execution. We have always endeavored to retain the designs and dii'ec- tions once seized, and we have not passed on to others without good reasoils — ^we will not depart from it now. If we have once seized a design, we must let it work to the test of its powers. We shall not depart from it without good reason, and we shall per- haps occasionally return to it. An unnecessary, aimless changing of design would only cause confusion and restlessness. 2. — Firm Connection. Each measure is a progression, closed in itself from tone to tone, in which the relation of each tone to the following is ex- pressed. The closer this relation of tones is, the more apparent does the relation become ; therefore have tones which succeed each other diatonically or chromatically, or which belong to the same harmony, the closest relation to each other. Therefore, in harmonic figuration, the melodic connection will be the stronger, the closer the tones of a chord lie to each other. Here, for instance, 492.. i 1^^^ M ^ spgii i the figure a will be the most firmly, the figure c the least firmly connected. The figure b stands between the two. It is more expansive than a, and less vague than c. These two merits might easily be combined by intermediate tones, as, for instance : -^^m ^. :j= 374 m 1 1 1 1 1 1 ^eS I III I ^ Thus far rests the internal connection of the figural melody upon the power or formation of the design. But the close union of the isolated tone-groups to a flowing figural voice is equally- important. This connection takes place, either as the fundamen- tal harmony indicates, or the last tone of the first group can be brought in diatonic connection with the first tonfi of tht^ second group. 375 CHAPTER V. THE EXERCISE OF HAEMONIC FIGUEATION IN PASSAGES AND GIVEN MELODBBS. It is time now to resume the practice of our new means. Per- haps this practice is not absolutely necessary for the mere accom- panying of national songs, but these exercises tend so much to the development of our musical powers, and willi be of so much advantage in later exercises, that we must not omit them. 1. — Passages reduced to Harmonic Figwration. This is a comparatively easy task, because the uniformity of the passage, and the liberty to select, close, and rhythmize ac- cording to our pleasure, cannot but greatly assist us. We shall need but few illustrations, and begin with the following : I I . ^:^L^--j--— -g- j_ j '_J I LU ^=n-r^fff ^»iWipW ■ _■ I Here are a few of the most simple beginnings : 495. i ^ "— •- l^i^ F-= F^ ^ M: r 376 At A we see the melody of the upper voice indicated by the first tones of the figural design. At b and c the melody is still visible, while here „. j^te^iA rT * t — if^ II ■ I ■ i it vanishes altogether. An extension of our chords would give us an enlarged arena for our designs and the carrying out of them. Here 497.A ^-^ ^^^^^^^ 3EEEJ£ M m P ^t=m g:J: Oon fuoco. i^^ - -] r ^ tS" sf- ^^^ s^ we have given a half-measure to each chord. Hen'e . Teneramente. 498. BES^z fi 1- X iz ^- we have no longer repeated the design slavishly exact, but intro- duced at the same time an accidental suspension. 377 2. — Accompaniment of Given Melodies. All our former melodies give us opportunities to practice on them the harmonic figuration. Only the irregular progression of these phrases makes the task somewhat difRcult; we must oc- casionally relinquish strict adhesion to the design, in order to keep up with the melody. In the following fragment Andante. 499. we see at A, B, and C the same accompaniment in three different designs. If this accompaniment threatens to overpower the mel- ody we can easily add an harmonic accompaniment. 500. Lfe^^ -*-h#- ^^^^fep|^ -t. If in the above we have figurated the bass, we can now attempt it with a middle voice. 501. i ^ ggj; m^^^m^ i *=?= 1 t i 378 The figuratfon of the upper voice, as might be expected, causes a greater or lesser deviation from the principal melody. But the placing of its tones on rhythmical chief-parts can soon balance this slight defect. 502. 1 1 1 Sh mm =l=f£ ' -J: The further practice of this figuration presents no difficulty, and we pass on at once, therefore, to the next chapter. 379 CHAPTER VI. PASSIKG-TONE AND BTE-TOITE. The harmonic figuration developes before us a picture of great mobility, but it suffers from the monotony and emptiness which are always the companions of the mere harmonic element, and which have driven us already to the invention of suspensions and passing-tones (Parts Eighth and Ninth). It lies near, therefore, to introduce these passing-tones in our harmonic figurations. Thus here. 503. ^= m i LLiLLT ^i=± T^=t¥ J. i^ '-^&w-T^:m frTT^ ■gS" ^ at c and d we have enriched the designs of a and b by means of diatonic and chromatic passing-tones, and have made them more connected. But it cannot always suit us to introduce the whole series of diatonic or chromatic intermediate tones, to fill out every third or fifth : 504. $ ^ a tifi If ^ But we must remember that the very step of a third or fifth was nothing but the progression from one degree to the third or fifth, with omission of the intermediate tones. Consequently we can omit any or all the intermediate tones in the above. 380 505. iip=ppi&=H=^^E *- Instead of the three intermediate tones of a third we need take but two, and the only question arising then would be, which are best omitted'? The object of the passing-tone is to lead us into the subsequent one, it must therefore lean towards the subsequent tone, join it closely, as it were. This is the case at a in the above. The passing-tones at b are less satisfactory, because they keep distant, as it were, from their actual goal. The passing- tones at c are in direct contradiction to the supposed key, and sound strange. With the same right we can retain but one of the passing-tones, and in that case we shall select the one nearest to the subsequent tone. B , . 506. P ft ¥ The one at a or b is better than the one at c ; for the c| does not lead to e, but to d. It is the same in descending. Of the intermediate tones between a tone and its third or fifth, below we can select or omit at pleasure. Of the following diatonic and chromatic passing-tones, 507. A , ^ J I I Bill .JJ 1. I y,h^^^l=k^:U -t:- t- we can chose these : "^■$ I I I I m^-d=i=R=H=J=iii=:R=fi:^i^ i±:^B^^SEe^pEpf3^ m But we must here add a few remarks. The pass is a flowing movement, having in its completeness a softening influence upon the melody, which, without it, must necessarily progress in wide steps. S81 In incomplete passes the whole influence of the pass is concen- ti'ated upon ^ - ^ u _ o_ D _ 509. ■* — B 1L stt: ^ the remaining tone, which; leads smoothly into the next one, while it has no connection with the preceding one. Such isolated tones of a pass are called HELP TONES. ' - '■ Embodymg them in our harmonic figurations we gain new tiiriei- successions, for instance : 510. They are so sitnple and satisfactory an addition that we can even begin with therd without preparation, 511. or introduce them simultaneously with the chord, without regard 512. 'm ^ p<«i -m-M i ^ ^^ ii ^ %^ to its contents, and without fearing, even, the effect of false-rela- tions (Jb against h\ in the above) provided always that the help- tone leads to a chord^tone, After this we need not hesitate to introduce descending help- tones in ascending passages, and vice versa, ascending help-tones in descending passages, 513. i -&- i 382 or to employ either or both in vague tone-chains of harmonic figuration. 514. i i^ffi li3Bi a^es^ a fiiL One step farther. It arises from the above that in the repeti- tion of a harmonic tone we can give it a help-tone from above as well as below (a), -^^^^fc and consequently we can also introduce the two in immediate succession (b). Each of the passing-tones finds its resolution in the chief-tone. Consequently we might omit the latter the first time, and unite the help-tones and let their resolution follow af- terward. '''■$ Seie^ r^ f £ as well as d are here resolved in c ; only that the resolution of the first tone is somewhat retarded. The attentive student will here perceive at once that all our musical ornaments, such as TBILLS, TUlftlS, DOUBLE TURNS, &C., are in reality nothing but an accumulation of help-tones. In the form of heIp4ones, too, passing-tones can be introduced in false relations. The introduction of them demands, however, some justification, and should not be permitted without sufficient reason. Here 383 517. M ^m^^ ijtihjt 1=^ ^ig ^^F at A, we see a e| against a cfc|, at b /| against /H. This is done to secure a flowing progression of the different voices. For the same reason we have here 518. •hf- ^^m taken g instead of y|. A similar passage from " Don Giovanni" 519. can be explained in like manner. Until now we have merely treated of the passing-tones by themselves. If we mix, now, the designs obtained from thein with a pure harmonic figuration ; for instance, 520. I ^ 5— -i — ^-•-« — ^ — -f — s-«-^ — ^ F^g — ^-»- T i I- we can see the resolution of the passing-tones and help-tones at once. But we have already seen in No. 516, that help-tones do not resolve immediately into a harmonic tone. We shall, therefore, not hesitate to lead the help-tones first i ito other harmonic tones, before the tone of the actual resolution appears. 521 P 1^^ ^^M 384 Not always, however, will such mixture be good, and least so when the two elements fall confusedly, one into the other. This would be the case if we were to remodel 520, for instance, in this manner : 522. m iffl. The design is clear enough in the first and last quarters ; but in the second and third the impression that the two help-tones, /I and S relate to g and d, is almost entirely effaced. Finally we must add that these real and apparent passing-tones and help-tones can occur simultaneously in two or more voices. This can lead to harmonic formations which were not in the least intended, and which, by persons fond of technical terms, are called Passing-chords or Transient chords. Their treatment requires no particular directions, as their origin will indicate the rules to be observed ; each help-tone — and there- fore the whole passing-chord consisting of such help-tones — ^must return to the originally-intended main tone or chord. Thus we find here 523 Y r A, within the chord c-e-g and 6b the groups £?jt,y|, 6,^t-J, rfjf, and a-rfj(-/jj ; at b we see actually all the four voices of a chord {b\)-c-e-g) proceed to help-tones which seem to form a chord of their own (6-(f j(/j(-a). The resolution of this accidental formation, however, tells us at once tha-t the chord is not a real one, for in that case its resolution would have been far different. at 385 CHAPTER YII. INTRODUCTION OF PASSES AND HELP-TONES INTO FIGURATION. Thb help-tones have stepped out, as it were, from the diatonic and chromatic passes, and thence have found their way into har- monic figuration. Their practice, therefore, must be attached to the diatonic and chromatic passes. This will have the additional advantage of reminding us of the application of the passes. The directions needed are but few, and the following phrase may serve as a basis : 524, m ^i -§- ^- 4- ■&- feE3i S ^ Ei^i sii ^t We begin our task with the P' '^' ^^ ^"f A,-^FIGCRATiaN OF THE UPPER VOICE. and. at first with the diatonic passes and help-tones. ■ ' '-J. ' ' ! 525. p E^E^J t^Sf^fati^iff W -^ -&2 I The first, fifth, and sixth measures need no explanation, as they contain nothing new. The movement in quarter notes of the first measure, induced us to continue it for another measure, and now it became absolutely necessary to continue it throughout the whole phrase. In the third measure we might have written three times e and then c, but the help-tone made it less monotonous. S8« Thus we have accidentally arrived at a figuration of a single tone, consisting of its repetition and a help-tone. Following up the' idea of figurating a single tone, we might give to No. 525 a more animated formation ; perhaps like this : 526. pgg^EJ^gi^ Let us turn now to the harmonic figuration ; let us introduce into the upper voice tones from the fundamental harmony. The nearest would probably be this : P"^ 527. ^E?: ES. ig^^^ i z^t^ ^IS^iS containing harmonic bye-tones and diatonic passes. And now we will proceed to the chromatic passes. Here 528. #^=r^p|?£^c^^ti^ ■ &o. we have arrived, for the first time, at a somewhat-varied rhythmi- zation. Merely passingly do we remember here the rich and powerful means which rhythm oflers us, and which until now were laying idle. We might combine the chromatic passes of No. 520 with the harmonic bye-tones and the uniform movement of No. 527. Ths would give us fonnations like this : 529. $^^^^ or of greater compass : 530. ■pj ^^ i^^gi^ m^^^m^m m 387 or in extended figuration : Ten. Dolce. 531 i^^ ?-• _^. t' *T&, e. E tJ:=.ti ^^ fie- Ten. t mm -^^^ or in a similar manner, but even more animated and marked : 532. and a thousand other designs and formations. B. FIGURATION OF THE BASS. Returning to No. 524 we find the melodic movement of the bass so meagre, that at first we hardly know what to do with it, except, perhaps, to give it a more animated ihythmization. i 33. WF i — '-^ i g= ^ -^■ g — d- I The introduction of a help-tone instead of a mere tone-repeti- 388 b34.ffi =P I f f -r ffj CTT :7T' tion (a), or with it (b), upon the second part of the mea&flre, oi upon the first (c), would do away, to a great degree, with this monotony. The design c would lead us, perhaps, to the following : i 535. m=a f -sj- 4- -M:. 5 J- * In order to show how rich a development a simple design like those in No. 534 can furnish,' we merely igive one here, 536. ^S w m^Ms'mM leaving it to the student to follow up this exercise. Were we at all inclined to change the melodic basis in the bass of No. 525, the harmonic figuration would ofl^er us the means of arriving at a richer foundation. At first we might sketch the bass in this manner : 537. i 5i J- ^^ J J ^ X 1 ^^^^^ and by means of the different passes, for instatice ; we would soon arrive at more interesting and extended foraaa tions. It is easily seen that the above figuration originated in 389 No. 537 ; not, however, without a change of the melodic basis, which in this case would have been : 539. Bi: ^^^^!^^ much nearer to No. 537 b, would have been a development like the following. 640. C. FIGURATION OF A MIDDLE VOICE. The little space at our command is here greatly in our way ; and we must therefore either lay the voices farther apart, or we must combine the two middle voices into one. The former pro- ceeding will call into existence formations like this : :^f?=Ji 541. i *jiji~(*~ e? A:^ It Mai ^-f- !flic LU ^m the latter would lead from formations like a to such as b and many others. _ !''_ 1 _i L-*^ l_l !_::: l_lJ liimpbh mn-!— £j — v^=^^- ^ 542, These directions will be sufficient to practice all the different forms of the pass in connection with the harmonic figuration, and stimulate the inventive faculties of the student. Yet we would recommend to the zealous pupil a last exercise, which in his future polyphonic labors will be of much advantage to him. We have reference to 390 THE APPLICATION OF HARMONIC FIGURATION, IN CONNECTION WITH PASSES, HELP-TONES, AND SUSPENSIONS TO HARMONIC PASSAGES. The task is an easy one, and a few illustrations will be suf- ficient. We return again to the passage 136. Here the bass 136.^ J ^^Efed T- -&- ff^ J. f r ■^ ^^^^^ -s- ^ ^ rr^ descends alternately a fourth, and the third voice, in like manner a third. The other voices proceed diatonically. Let us now fill the wider steps with diatonic passes. ::^ — (^ fei- ^ i^^ W^:^ "M^'r-i'T 543. P~ ^ a 3 iS Why have we, at A, introduced suspensions in the upper voice ? In order to avoid the consecutive fifths which the passes would otherwise have formed with the upper voice. At b we have sus- pended all three of the upper voices. Let us now attempt the introduction of passes in the upper voice ; as a matter of course they can only be chromatic. 391 $ -Ml =d= ^t^ 644. at ii zJzz:!^ J^ W=^^ . ^^^ ^ rS ^e=r^T ■tt^f^ ;^^^ Bi As a last illustration of the rich and varied developments which the industrious student can derive from the simplest designs, we give the following : 545. W et: -±^-^ r a«sj r ^lrr=fs^^ i The first four notes of the treble can be considered as the prin- cipal design, which will be found in a more or less similar form, in the tenor, alto, and bass. But- though we have given here a somewhat complicated illus- tration, the pupil must not fail to begin with the most simple designs. 392 CHAPTER Vm. APPLICATION OF THESE NEW MEANS TO ARTISTIC ACCOMPANIMENTS. We are at last fully prepared for every kind of accompaniment which the character of our national songs might demand. We can now represent the most volatile and flowing accompaniments in endless forms, as we formerly constructed accompaniments of full and firm chords,- only occasionally interspersed with hannonic by- tones &c., &c. (vide Nos. 475, 477, 479.) Casually we learn now, that some of the tones in No. 477, which we could not explain at the time, are nothing but help-tones. Our labor now is but trifling. We have the necessary means in hand ; we have practised their application, and it only depends now upon our selecting the right means for every particular task, to judge which form of accom- paniment or representation is most in keeping with the character of each song. The great similarity of many of our present forms, and the dif- ferent conceptions of which most or all of our songs are capable, makes it impossible to point to any one form as the only right one. Yet we can be guided by certain general principles which will always indicate to us the proper direction, and guard as against aberration. 1. A strictly harmonic accompaniment, like that of No. 475, produces the most firm, meaning, and heavy effect. 2. The richer the change of chords, the more interwoven those chords are, by means of suspensions, passes, &c. &c., the more conspicuous will be the character of this hafinonic accompaniment, (Nos. 476 and 479.) The milder and rarer the change of chords (No. 475,) or the more these chords are separated by rests (No. 480,) the lighter will be the accompaniment. 3. In juxtaposition to the harmonic accompaniment, we have 393 the harmonic figuration, the fundamental character of which is animation, lightness, grace, and a certain transparent con- nection of tones. 4. The farther apart these tones, the more extended the figures, the more rapid the movement, the more conspicuous will this fundamental character become ; the more simul- taneous voices share in this movement, (No. 485 d and b,) the more do we approach again to the fullness and firmness of massive motion. 5. Passing-tones or help-tones are apt to make the harmonic figuration more connected, full, melodibally satiated, as it were. 6. The more firmly the melodic connection of an accompany- ing voice has been developed by means of passing-tones, the more independent a melody will this voice become, and the more attention will it detract from the principal melody. After these observations we will construct our accompaniment for each song according to its contents ; we will even change the form of accompaniment, if prompted by the deviating ten- dency of single verses or parts. But in every case we will en- deavor to keep in view the general character of the song. It is necessary, also, to ascertain whether the melody is to be sung, or to be played in connection with the accompaniment. In the former case it is not necessary to place the melody in the accompaniment ; but it will be well to construct the accom- paniment so that, by itself^ it affords a certain satisfaction and contains at legist no disagreeable passages ; for instance, quart-successions to which the melody would form the sixth, 546. T=l i^ a^i :P!=F f-» §1 Accompanitnent. \,_4._ S-j_ 17* 394 irregular steps in the upper voice, &c. &c. But these considera- tions will be treated more fully in the chapter on the accompani- ment of vocal music. Here we shall confine ourselves principally to such treatments in which melody and accompaniment are per- fo;med on one instrument — the pianoforte. Let us begin our labors with the following song : ^^47. S: ^ which, in its simple construction, resembles our first periodical formations. As above, it is sung duophonically by the people. This treatment is perfectly in keeping with its object and charac- ter. If it were intended to be accompanied by the pianoforte, oi to be played without being sung, a few simple chords, supporting the rhythm, 548. would be sufficient. The first of these accompaniments would answer to the light verses, the second to the more serious and sad final verse, and the coda might designate this latter mood more characteristically by moans of a more developed harmony : 395 549. W^^ S3 ^ S3Ee!^ ■*^i ^^ ^: n 1 •-•-*-*»-H- If this form of accompaniment should be deemed too simple, if we were to give an indication of the suppressed emotion of the singer, we might form a more animated middle voice. This has been done here, in the most simple manner : Fiu animato. 550. t=^-M -sar-t 1 i_J 1 f— i P 1 • . -£«■. Ores Oi d^. :?— i L i?=it -T^ R-, 9J^ Nl_ I m^^ -^=^- ^e^3^5E r^^s^^a? I biy •r -g- ^ -a- Sg3s|- 396 The design consists of the second voice of the national song, combined with the fifth of the chord. It is deserted in the close of the thesis, and is indicated again at the end of the whole. The antithesis has made itself more independent from the design, and assumes a more complicated foi-m, which might have been differ- ent and simpler ; for instance : .KS- but which departs altogether from the simple character of a national song. Let us imagine one of these representations employed for the second verse, and we might give the third one a more anxious, excited character, though still resembling our first conception (No. 448 ;) perliaps ihus : 552. p _L „ P .^ 397 But if we were to depart still more from the character of rural simplicity, if the melody were to pass by lilce a mere recollection, we might surround it with accompanying reminisceiK'-es, -«- -«- 553. ^^= & Marc. c. espr. et^" IS: j^J 44^ f Fed.- piano. * -«-/-N-«-:^ — N-«- J^ J ^ '~^"5"I<2>"5" Maro. espr. I ^ II rt:^^F^>- r 1 -*--:8-:r 1 I L'-^L -pfp _dl?l 1 -'*-' I p ^ R--^- iF:=g: Fed. or Other nearer or more distant formations. Franz Liszt has been peculiarly fortunate in the production of such forms. 554. ^^^^^g^^pgi^ *===* -^^m^&- w^^t "^^^f^^ =^5Z^ ^ZlSl ->-- N- --»-#-f -+-—*- *-:E=K£Et^^S ^n^ii^^ iM^g 398 Finally, we will throw a hasty glance upon the above song. It is less simple than the former, but admits of many harmonic con- ceptions. We see in it two particularly conspicuous points : the pause in the third measure from the end, and the imperfect cadence of the second part, two measures previous ; for the rest is merely a repetition of the same. Both points have one and the same object, — the expression of the longing for her to whom the song is addressed. We shall have to make use of interrupted and imperfect cadences, in a manner which corresponds to this gentle, restless desire ; perhaps thus : |^^!S^ 555. aipi P -4^= Shall we harmonize the beginning thus ? ^^ 5tEJEE&^ a f=^ f=r 556. e ^-t m m P^N* ei f^-1 S=: -| h - I 399 It would appear too unsteady and assuming. The latter refers particularly to the painfully anxious chromatic progression of the bass. We should prefer a full and gentle figuration of simple harmonies : 557. " ^'iff^'iVr ^m^jj ^■-rjJ^^Tf E=3^^§^^ggag T^T m *^ 1f»-iS»-l7'i f T^ZlT iS-^iS^ and with the following measure we would return the first time to the beginning (as at a or p,) and the second time we would pass over to the second part, as at c. 558. 1IE=3 -■F- m :fe=F r ' ~^~rr ^m -•- r d---^J: m^ ^^tlu: h=f - 4Q0 Or, if we -conceived tjiis song in a more J^estless mood, we might form a more animated aecompaniment, perhaps thus: 659. ess ^^ 3^ it±i=E=3: r m We leave the student to practise these and other analyzations and exercises. 401 APPENDIX. THE FIGURAL PRELUDE. In the first chapter of the Fourth Part we have already men- tioned the prelude with which a piece of music can be introduced to the singers or listeners. Our prelude at that time was ex- tremely meagre, on account of lack of means ; and though we soon after gained new chords, and were able to construct more varied harmonic passages, yet we could not overcome the monotony and dryness of our first attempts, until we arrived at the harmonic figuration, with or without the passing tones and help-toties. It iS for this that we now return to the prelude, and even now we have to be limited to the most subordinate forms. Nor does this subject actually belong to this branch of musical theory. We consider it merely as an appendix, dispensable — it is true — but so easy of attainment, that we shall not hesitate to treat of it. The prelude is intended to prepare us for the key of the subse- quent composition, either by indicating it, or by actually sounding the essential harmonies, and in addition to these, perhaps other near related harmonies. Thus much we have leamecTalready at p. 120. Passages like this, 560. 402 or these, 561 BE m ^ 4 3 _(2_ -&- bt 4 3 t p yes £ -h^ b bs b 6 7 -z^e^:^ ■^ n p -e- are quite appropriate for purely harmonic preludes. We have already learned to develop such passages more firmly and melodiously, by means of suspensions and passes. We might therefore give to the prelude No. 560 this — 562. P =F= W=i^ ^=^ ^ ai If ^P i d W^WS' i s rx^—^^ T=^^^^ or any other form. But such formations are less appropriate for preludes, because the presumptuous development is not in keeping with the sim- plicity of the task and the hannonio foundation. 403 Here again we discover in the figural forms the proper means They mitigate the stiffness of the chords, and with all their unas. sumingness give us the possibility of volatile formations, without preventing us from elevating ourselves to more energetic, flowing and melodious ones ; and as they do away with the monotonous stiffness of the chords, they permit us at the time to remain longer with every single chord. Thus, by means of harmonic figuration, we might form from one single chord a prelude, 563. m^^=^ ^ ^ 8va. which, in its mobility and variati<3n of form, remunerates us most amply for its lack of harmonic variety. It would be already a progress if we employed the figuration for the dominant chord, and closed\ with the tonic triad, or if, after any one 'figurated chord we intrlpduoed the harmonies essen- tial to the designation of a key, as we have done here : 404 S64. Legglero. ^~—^ • m This, too, should be practised, first on paper, and then at the pianoforte. We can obtain a richer formation, and one of a higher order, by selecting an harmonic succession, in the manner of our first preludes, and afterwards carrying it out according to a fixed figural design. The following phrase : 565. i ffi u ■p=f=r=rT^^^i^ SfciiEg ^m ^ may serve as an illustration of such foundation. A. simple har- monic figuration — 566. m 405 ^pi^^^ls^^l ^^=f=g= ta^^^ ^ S ei ^^E^ f ^%%i gives it already mobility and variety, and it requires merely a steady progression, to obtain from it series and series of new formations, particularly after we have introduced passes, help- tones, change of design, and rhythmical form. We have made but sparing use of these means ; a single help-tone has been introduced in b ; and in c we have employed two designs (triplets and eighth-notes.) In continuing this, how- ever, as we have seen in a,) our designs would have to be modi- fied or divided, because the foundation assumes a more rapid progression after the third measure. In c, too, this would be necessary : we might omit the second design, and form the first thus ■ 406 567. ff 3e# W^ p^ ^m Thus much of this by no means diflficult exercise. Guided by it, the student may venture beyond the limits of the phrase, and exercise his invention in free harmonic formations, either on paper, or improvising on the pianoforte. APPENDIX AND NOTES TO MAEX'S THEORY MUSICAL COMPOSITION. BY E. GIRAC, OF THE OONSEETATOET OP PARIS NEW yOEK: PUBLISHED BY MASON BROTHERS. 23 PARK ROW. Entered, according to Act of Congress, in the year 1854, by MASON BROTHERS, In tbe Clerk's Office of the District Court for the Southern District of New York. INTEODUCTION. My object in writing the following Appendixes has been to con- dense and abridge matters which, in the author, are too prolix, and mingled with secondary considerations of the subject, which often- times obscure the practical rules. In instruction books, precepts ought to be unfolded with as much brevity as possible ; definitions be clear and comprehensive ; the developments strictly cionfined to points immediately connected with the rules or definitions. It is quite a different thing to write for learners, or learned. The latter will, no doubt, be satisfied with philosophical views, with reasonings and arguments skillfully linked one to another ; they will follow, with interest, thoughts developed with a wonderful abundance of ex- pressions, and sometimes with brilliant figures of speech. This does very well with readers conversant with the subject. But , the former will, after all, derive but little benefit from those evidences of learning, from that fecundity of thought and richness of expres- sion paraded by the writer. The practical man laying down a code of precepts must say to the pupil, ' this you have to practise, that you have to avoid.' He must still do better, he must show the pupil how to observe this, and how to avoid that, by numerous examples subjoined to every precept. So used to do Cherubini, perhaps the greatest theorist who ever existed : so did Reicha, the most practical man who was ever seated on the professor's pulpit. So did the early German theorists, such as Fuchs, Marpurg, Albrechtberger, and the Italian padre, Martini, and many others, of whom it would be too long to give here the names. Nothing is more apt to give an idea of the soundness of judgment of Beethoven, than the concise- ness with which he has developed the rules of Counterpoint and Fugue in his musical studies. The paucity of precepts contrasts wonderfully with the number of examples. In this, we think he was influenced by his master, Albrechtberger. These few lines serve to show in what spirit the Appendixes have been written. I have given compressed and short rules, but sup- IV ported and illustrated by numerous exercises, intended both to put the rules in practice, and to serve the student as models of work for himself. Though these Appendixes have been composed to be explanatory commentaries to the large treatise of Marx, yet they form a vi^hole in themselves, and from the treatment of the triad down to the pass- ing-notes, where they break off, they form a compendium of the matters contained in them, in which nothing necessary to the instruc- tion of the pupil has been omitted. They have another advantage ; they offer the teacher of harmony a text-book in which the funda- mental laws of harmony have been laid down, so that he will have no other task to perform than to direct and superintend the work of his pupil, being thus relieved from giving, himself) but very few directions. But how must these Appendixes be used ? In the following manner. The student will first read attentively, and endeavor to understand thoroughly the work of xMarx, from page 94 to 113. Next, he should put aside the author, and begin the Appendixes down to the chapter on the pedal-point. When reaching this part of my work, he will take the text of Marx, where the fundamental principles of the pedal are given (page 215). At the page 219, of the author, he must resort again to the Appendixes (page 128), in which the manner of framing a pedal apd some other developments are given. At this part of his work he will have to finish the Appendixes. I have confined my work to the suspensions, but they are fully developed, and more completely shown in the work of Marx. If the student be aptly possessed of the matters treated in the Appendixes, he will be able to understand and practise the chapter on passing-notes, and the following of our author. When reading through the Appendixes for the first time, the pupil will have to neglect those that are mere observations on the text, such as App. H, App. I, and App. K. When the Appendixes-v have been once read through, and studied carefully, the pupil will take the text a second time, and then read the Appendixes in connection with the text in the order in which they are referred to by numbers inserted in the book of our author. These directions are particularly addressed to students left to self-instruction, or amateurs living in the country, deprived of any assistance from professional men. As to pupils enjoying oral teaching, they will use both the text and my Appendixes, as directed by their teacher. A few words now on the exercises, especially for the benefit of students left to self-instruction. After reading the rules and explanations, the pupil should copy the base of the exercises coming after every rule or explanation, without looking at the upper parts. Particular care must be given to the figuring of the base. This being done, he will fill up the har- mony according to the figures written carefully under the base. Before commencing to fill up the harmony, he ought to read over and over again the rules on the three musical motions, and watch his work with utmost care, in order to avoid fifths and octaves either hidden or real. After it, he will compare his work with the upper parts written above the base in the Appendixes. If he discover faulty successions, or mistakes in contradiction to the figuring, he should recommence his task, until, by comparing it with the exercises, he finds no fault with his own arrangement. When studying the triads, which I consider the most difficult labor of the pupil, particu- lar attention ought to be paid to the connection of chords ; most of the faulty successions arise from breaking this connection. When the student has succeeded in writing his work correctly, (and to succeed in this, it is not necessary to arrange the parts just as they are in the Appendixes,) then he must create a base for himself, and fill up the harmony. In the discords, particular care is to be given to the preparation, when required ; next, to the resolution. These exercises are carefully figured. The figuring is that adopted in the Conservatory, and, generally, by the French school, of which it is necessary to give the pupil a proper notion and view. The triad is figured thus, s. The diminished triad, thus, -9-. The augmented triad, thus, fs or ^s. When the third of a chord or triad is suddenly altered by an ac- cidental, this accidental is placed above the figure s, thus, |, or |, or |, showing that the third is affected by it. The dominant triad is sometimes designated by the signature which constitutes the leading note in the minor key, thus, jf or i), according to the key. This applies only to minor keys. The doininant seventh, whatever may be the mode, is figured, %. The seventh, arising from the suppression of the fundamental in the dominant seventh, is figured thus, -?.. The diminished seventh is figured thus, -8-. All the other sevenths, major or minor, t. The major dominant ninth, §. The minor dominant ninth,"! "■'' ''?• The third is seldom figured, except when the dominant seventh resolves incompletely on the third of the tonic. The perfect fourth is figured «. The augmented, extended, or sharp fourth, +4. The diminished fourth, -t-. The sixth, both major and minor, e- But when the sixth is suddenly altered by signatures not belong- ing to the principal key, the accidental or signature is prefixed to the figure, thus, ijs or be. The diminished sixth, -a-. The augmented sixth is figured by prefixing the accidental which affects the sixth to the figure, thus, jje or !)6. The second, both major and minor, a. The second, arising from the third inversion of the dominant seventh, in both modes, is figured thus, +2. The augmented or extended second, thus, da or flz. I give this figuring as the one used in a great school, and applied to these Appendixes ; though, I confess, there is much that is arbi- trary in this, and I do not disapprove of any other method of figur- ing which may convey an exact notion of the harmony. But the pupil who studies alone, being necessitated to submit to. that of the exercises, it was incumbent upon me to make him acquainted with it. I have now given all the directions necessary, that the student may derive from these Appendixes all the advantages contemplated when they were written, and, I have no doubt, these advantages are certain, if the student be a careful observer of all the given directions. EM. GIRAC. New-York, My, 1854. APPENDIX A. TREATMENT OF THE TRIADS. The Triads, to be treated properly, require much skill and art. The preparation of the dissonant chords is not a difficult matter, and each of their constitutive tones is called to its proper place by the laws of their resolution. Here the pupil is left alone, having no other guide than the con- nection which may exist between the chords — a connection which he must look for, and the discovery of which depends entirely upon his care. Besides, there is a difficulty which he meets with at every step, and which must be carefully guarded against ; we mean the faulty successions of real or covered fifths or octaves. On pages 101 and 102, we have, by our author, been made acquainted with octave and fifth-successions ; on page 129, with covered fifths and covered octaves. We refer the pupil to them again. Our care, at present, will be to avoid these obnoxious suc- cessions. We also learned, on page 100, that the connection of chords consists in the mutual tones of the chords. In other words. Connection cf chords is the mutuality of their tones. But is there some method to follow in order to obtain this con- nection without mistake ? certainly there is ; it consists in the mo- tion of the fundamental tone in the base. The fundamental tone of a chord may descend a second, third, fourth, ffth, or sixth ; it may ascend a second, third, fourth, fifth, or sixth. These different motions of the fundamental tone of the chords are called by theorists, Progressions of the fwndamentod. They have, also, admitted two sorts of Progressions : the Regular, and the Irregular. The Progression by a third, fourth, a.nd fifth below, and its inver- sion of a sixth, fifth, and yburt/t above, is called the Regular Progres- sion. The Progression of a second below and a second above, and the corresponding seventh, is called Irregular Progression. The descending progression by a third, gives two mutual tones. The Progression, a fourth down, affords us one mutual tone. i ^ The Progression by a Jifth gives one mutual tone. i The same number of common tones is found in the inversion of these progressions ; that is, in the progressions of the fundamental sixth, ffth, and fourth above ; and they are equally good. As to the motion a third above, it cannot be used but under certain conditions, and no more than one progression of this kind is admissible. Such succession by thirds above as this, i &c. is not very desirable. The condition under which this progression is received, is this : the fundamental, after skipping a third above, must be brought downward a. fifth, and the third of the second triad may be made the leading tone of the third triad, as, i Hence, it would appear that this progression by a third above, is more satisfactory when leading from a major to a minor triad, which at its turn, is made the dominant of a transient minor key by the elevation of its third. All the regular progressions afford us some common tones. But the progression, a third and a fifth below, contains the fifth of the following chord. In such progression, we say that the fifth is 5 •prepared ; and whenever this preparation occurs, we ought to avail ourselves of it. Hence we will make it a rule, that all the tones which a chord lias in common with the following chord, must be pro. longed into it, as, -^ ^~ i In our following exercises we will designate the mutual tones of the chords by this sign -— ^ or ^—^ placed over or below them. Previous to our explanations of the irregular progression, we feel obliged to give a full account of the three harmonic motions, which have only been hinted at on pages 90 and 91. Theorists acknowledge three kinds of motions in harmony : the Direct or Parallel, Oilique, and Contrary. The Direct or Parallel motion takes place when two or more parts (never more th^n three) ascend or descend simultaneously, as, ^^=^b^^^ r-r-r-f- The Oblique motion takes place when one or more parts or voices keep on the same tone, whilst one or more ascend or descend. i X The Contrary motion takes place when one or more parts or voices lead in -opposite direction to one or more voices, moving at the same time : The first of these motions is especially admissable in two part compositions, but when used alone, it affords but few resources. The second is far richer than the first ; the contrary motion is the most serviceable, on account of the variety of combinations to which it gives rise. The power and beauty of harmony lie in the proper 6 arid skilful employment of these motions Combined together ; and from their motion, the theorists have fixed the following rules : 1st. Two fifths and two octaves, prohibited in the direct motion, are allowed in the contrary one. 2d. No more than three parts can move in direct motion ; and when they thus move, they are liable to give fifths or octaves. 3d. Four parts moving simultaneously in parallel motion, fall inevitably into faulty successions of fifths or octaves, and most of the time into both of them. Let us now come to the Irregular progression. Here the chords have not, and cannot have any common tone, and consequently there is no connection between them. For the distribution of the chord- tones, in such a progression, we are under the necessity of making use of the contrary motion in order to avoid the parallel succession of fifths or octaves. As an example of that progression, let us take the two triads/, a, c, and g, b, d, which in the staff will give us the following combination of notes : i It suffices to look at these chords to perceive that no common tone exists between them, and therefore no connection. On the other hand, if we consider the tones of the chord f, a, c, we discover that each of them goes up to meet the nearest tone of the chord g, h, d, that is, three parts move up in direct motion. Let us see if, accord- ing to the second rule of the motions, there be not here some of the errors mentioned in it. In effect, the treble part progresses from c to d, while the base part moves from / to g, and thus gives us two fifths in parallel motion. It is not in our power to avoid these fifths, since the tones are essential to both chords ; but we can avoid having them progress in parallel motion, by giving the chord-tones of the chord/, a, c, another construction, as in the following : i All now is right. We have obtained the Jifth o{ g, b, d, by causing the third of the chord / a, c, to descend to d, whilst the fundamental tone, /, goes up to g. But as we have adopted the four part writing in our exercises, we shall construct again our chords in this way : =A= i ^ which is equally satisfactory. It is worth the while to advise the pupil that, to avoid faulty suc- cessions, in many instances, it does? not suffice to take the contrary motion; much however depends upon the position of the chord- tones. Here, for example, if instead of placing the third of _/", a, c, in the outer regions of the harmony, we had placed it in the middle ones, another error awaited us. Thus here : ^m the third off, a, c, is given to the tenor, and the doubled fundamen- tal, to the treble. Both follow a descending motion, and progress simultaneously in fifths, the one covered (a, e), the other real {g, d) ; and yet we lead the parts in opposite directions. This we have avoided above, (at A,) by inverting the intervals. We deem it proper to enter upon these particulars to show the pupil every way of keeping from faulty successions, and with how much care he must guard against them. Finally, we cannot close our illustrations upon the subject of con- nection, without laying down a last observation, which is this : not to destroy, by an awkward arrangement of the chord tones, the con- nection which exists between the chords. Here, i =i= an improper use of the contrary motion, has not only destroyed the connection of the chords, but has led us into the very fault of cover- ed fifths and octaves, which we intended to avoid. As both chords have the tone c in common, the proper arrangement of the voices would have prompted us to tie them, by continuing c in the chord /, a, c, thus : i The connection being thus observed, all the other tones, C; move easily to the nearest intervals of the following chord, observation is of the greatest moment in filling up the harmony, Exercises on the Regulak Progressions. e, g, This No. 1. ^ 32: #: I is Ty No. 2. ^ ite: r -si- 5 55&6&55 5^5 In these examples we meet with a kind of fifths and octaves, which call the attention of the student. They are called hidden. A hidden fifth or octave is that which takes place between two parts, one of which proceeds upwards or downwards, one or more degrees, while the other skips to the same intervals. By filling up the skips, the hidden interval appears real to the eye, as. Real 5th. Hidden Bra. Real Sva. In Nos. 1 and 2 there are several instances of hidden fifths and octaves. There are instances of hidden octaves in No. 1, from measures 4 to 5, 5 to 6, Y to 8, and 9 to 10 ; in No. 2, from 2 to 3, 5 to 6, 8 to 9, and 9 to 10 ; in both between the base and one of the upper parts. Instances of hidden fifths are found from 1 to 2, between the tenor and treble ; from 6 to 7, and 7 to 8, between the base and one of the upper parts, in No. 2. But all these succes- sions are permitted whenever the upper part moves to the fifth or octave by a single step, and the lower part skips to the same inter- vals, as in Nos. 1 and 2. We direct the attention of the pupil to the second measure of No. 2, in which the connection is occasionally broken in order to raise the harmony. In the present instance, the raised parts lead in opposite direction to the base ; they move easily, and their progression is natural according to the rules on page 130. These conditions ought to be attended to whenever we break the connection of the chords for the sake of raising or depress- ing the pitch of the voices. The irregular progression is not so satisfactory to the ear as the regular one ; and for that reason, it cannot be carried on beyond two or three chords, except in the first inversion and in three-part- writing. We would say, too, that the ascending movement seems to be more suited for it than the descending. There are also cer- tain degrees of both scales in which it seems more admissible. Thus, in the major scale, from one to two, from four to five ; from two to three, from five to six. In the minor mode, irom four to five, and from five to six, and vice versa. The other degrees of the latter scale cannot be used in irregular progressions without breaking into the major mode. The following exercises will serve as illustrations of the foregoing remarks : Major Scale. No. 3. ■^^^ f=r^ -^-j- j-^-- T=T E^^l^^ -•— ^e- jhJTl r f T -J,- p ii§f 5 5 5 5 5 Minor Scale. 5 5 5-5 F^Tf ff T 1^ - ^ h h 55"? 555^5 5 5 j ipgs -§Z':3ZL Ef 10 In both exercises, the irregular progressions produce consecutive fifths by contrary motion, and, in both scales, go through the above- mentioned degrees. As the minor scales afford but few indigenous chords, it is always advisable, in their treatment, to get them, now and then, into the triads of the major mode. So we have done here, at the star (*), where the minor tonic joins the dominant triad of c. SEQUEBTCES, OE PASSAGES OF TRIADS. We call by this term certain motions of the fundamental lone, stepping according to an " adopted model." This model consists of a certain number of tones, which regulate the steps of all the fol- lowing, as : i &c. Here the first tone goes down five steps to the second, and the latter goes up a fourth to the third, and so on to the end. These sequences depend entirely on the will or fancy of the composer. They may occur in any strain of a piece of music or exercise ; the beginning,- middle, end, are equally suited for them. The one most commonly found is the above mentioned, which some theorists have styled Seventh-progression, as being thatof the chords of the seventh. No. 5. I i ^JJu J ' ^ ^ ^ gfe I * ,-~T"^ ^ d=t ^ r rc» » ^s ^ ^=i 11 =c i j-d _j-.i --9--» &Eid g g/ " ^!t"i£:rf: ■<9- f ■*■ -^ T^- — ^ F f f =^=^ ^ There are in No. 5 three instances of sequences, the model of which is indicated by this dotted curve • ' ' * • At a, b, c, too, the harmony is made to ascend to a higher pitch, in order to give the parts a regular position in the uniform steps of the progressions. At the stars, the diminished triad is led out of its usual way of resolution ; (this is always the case in these sequences or passages, in which the diminished triad, losing its own character, is assimilated to the common triads, and forced into the current of the surrounding fun- damentals ;) and this treatment is quite satifactory. One example more, and we shall have done with the progressions. No. 6. Mince Scale. ^ isssi ^m^^f^r^ §1 P i ^^p w m± fTTr ^rr^F p i: iscziS:: i 12 i^#f^p^ ^^==F P *